Merge branch 'rspamd-removal'
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.91"
49 .include ./local_params
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54 .macro copyyear
55 2018
56 .endmacro
57
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76 . --- index entry.
77
78 .macro option
79 .arg 5
80 .oindex "&%$5%&"
81 .endarg
82 .arg -5
83 .oindex "&%$1%&"
84 .endarg
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 .endtable
88 .endmacro
89
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96 .endmacro
97
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102 .macro irow
103 .arg 4
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -4
107 .arg 3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109 .endarg
110 .arg -3
111 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
112 .endarg
113 .endarg
114 .endmacro
115
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
120
121 .macro cindex
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 .arg 2
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126 .endarg
127 &</indexterm>&
128 .endmacro
129
130 .macro scindex
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 .arg 3
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135 .endarg
136 &</indexterm>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro ecindex
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 .endmacro
142
143 .macro oindex
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 .arg 2
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148 .endarg
149 &</indexterm>&
150 .endmacro
151
152 .macro vindex
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 .arg 2
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157 .endarg
158 &</indexterm>&
159 .endmacro
160
161 .macro index
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 .endmacro
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . output formats.
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172 .literal xml
173 <bookinfo>
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176 <date>
177 .fulldate
178 </date>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
182 .versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>
186 .copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 </bookinfo>
189 .literal off
190
191
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 .literal xml
200
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204 </indexterm>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225 </indexterm>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246 </indexterm>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303 </indexterm>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320 </indexterm>
321
322 .literal off
323
324
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368 contributors.
369
370
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374 .new
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 .wen
381
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 very wide interest.
390
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 information.
408
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411 .cindex "change log"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429 directory are:
430
431 .table2 100pt
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
440 .endtable
441
442 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
443 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
444 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
445
446
447
448 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
449 .cindex "web site"
450 .cindex "FTP site"
451 The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
452 available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
453 website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
454
455 .cindex "wiki"
456 .cindex "FAQ"
457 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
458 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
459 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
460 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
461 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
462 The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
463 provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
464
465 .cindex Bugzilla
466 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469 Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
470
471
472 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476 .table2 140pt
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481 .endtable
482
483 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488 via this web page:
489 .display
490 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491 .endd
492 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
493 lists.
494
495 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
496 .cindex "bug reports"
497 .cindex "reporting bugs"
498 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
499 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
500 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
501 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
502
503
504
505 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
506 .cindex "FTP site"
507 .cindex "HTTPS download site"
508 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
509 .cindex "distribution" "https site"
510 The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
511 .display
512 &*https://downloads.exim.org/*&
513 .endd
514 The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
515 We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
516
517 The content served at &'https://downloads.exim.org/'& is identical to the
518 content served at &'https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim'& and
519 &'ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim'&.
520
521 If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
522 follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
523 If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
524 here are top-level directories.
525
526 There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
527 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
528
529 Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
530 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
531 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
532 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
533 .display
534 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz_&
535 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
536 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
537 .endd
538 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
539 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
540 The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
541 most portable to old systems.
542
543 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
544 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
545 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
546 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
547 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
548 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
549 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
550 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
551 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
552 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
553 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
554
555 At time of last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
556 with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
557 of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
558 and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
559
560 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561 .display
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
563 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
564 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
565 .endd
566 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
567 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
568 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
569
570 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
571 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
572 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
573 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
574 .display
575 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
579 .endd
580 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
581 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
582
583
584 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
585 .ilist
586 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
587 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
588 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
589 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
590 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
591 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
592 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
593 .next
594 .cindex "domainless addresses"
595 .cindex "address" "without domain"
596 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
597 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
598 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
599 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
600 arrival.
601 .next
602 .cindex "transport" "external"
603 .cindex "external transports"
604 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
605 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
606 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
607 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
608 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
609 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
610 .next
611 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
612 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
613 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
614 other means.
615 .next
616 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
617 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
618 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
619 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
620 a number of common scanners are provided.
621 .endlist
622
623
624 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
625 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
626 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
627 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
628 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
629 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
630
631
632 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
633 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
634 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
635 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
636 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
637 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
638 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
639 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
640 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
641 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
642 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
643 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
644
645 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
646 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
647 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
648 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
649
650
651
652 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
653 .cindex "terminology definitions"
654 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
655 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
656 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
657 below) by a blank line.
658
659 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
660 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
661 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
662 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
663 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
664 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
665 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
666 rise to further bounce messages.
667
668 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
669 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
670 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
671 otherwise.
672
673 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
674 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
675 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
676 until a later time.
677
678 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
679 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
680 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
681
682 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
683 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
684 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
685 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
686 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
687 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
688 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
689 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
690
691 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
692 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
693 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
694 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
695 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
696 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
697 line.
698
699 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
700 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
701 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
702 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
703 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
704
705 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
706 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
707 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
708 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
709 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
710 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
711
712 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
713 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
714 message's envelope.
715
716 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
717 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
718 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
719 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
720 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
721
722 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
723 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
724 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
725 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
726 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
727
728 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
729 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
730 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
731 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
732 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
733 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
734
735
736
737
738
739
740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
742
743 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
744 .cindex "incorporated code"
745 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
746 .cindex "PCRE"
747 .cindex "OpenDMARC"
748 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
749
750 .ilist
751 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
752 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
753 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
754 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
755 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
756 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
757 .next
758 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
759 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
760 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
761 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
762 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
763 following statements:
764
765 .blockquote
766 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
767
768 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
769 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
770 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
771 version.
772 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
773 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
774 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
775 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
776 restrictions applied to it).
777 .endblockquote
778 .next
779 .cindex "SPA authentication"
780 .cindex "Samba project"
781 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
782 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
783 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
784 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
785 under the Gnu GPL.
786 .next
787 .cindex "Cyrus"
788 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
789 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
790 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
791 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
792 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
793 conditions expressed therein.
794
795 .blockquote
796 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
797
798 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
799 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
800 are met:
801
802 .olist
803 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
804 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
805 .next
806 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
807 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
808 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
809 distribution.
810 .next
811 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
812 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
813 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
814 details, please contact
815 .display
816 Office of Technology Transfer
817 Carnegie Mellon University
818 5000 Forbes Avenue
819 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
820 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
821 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
822 .endd
823 .next
824 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
825 acknowledgment:
826
827 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
828 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
829
830 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
831 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
832 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
833 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
834 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
835 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
836 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
837 .endlist
838 .endblockquote
839
840 .next
841 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
842 .cindex "X-windows"
843 .cindex "Athena"
844 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
845 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
846 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
847 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
848
849 .blockquote
850 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
851 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
852
853 All Rights Reserved
854
855 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
856 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
857 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
858 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
859 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
860 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
861 software without specific, written prior permission.
862
863 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
864 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
865 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
866 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
867 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
868 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
869 SOFTWARE.
870 .endblockquote
871
872 .next
873 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
874 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
875 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
876 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
877 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
878 source code.
879
880 .next
881 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
882 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
883 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
884 .endlist
885
886
887
888
889
890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
892
893 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
894 "Receiving and delivering mail"
895
896
897 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
898 .cindex "design philosophy"
899 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
900 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
901 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
902 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
903 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
904 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
905
906
907 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
908 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
909 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
910 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
911 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
912 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
913 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
914
915 .ilist
916 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
917 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
918 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
919 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
920 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
921 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
922 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
923 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
924 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
925 error code.
926 .next
927 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
928 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
929 .next
930 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
931 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
932 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
933 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
934 .next
935 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
936 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
937 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
938 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
939 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
940 .next
941 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
942 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
943 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
944 .next
945 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
946 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
947 runs at the start of every delivery process.
948 .endlist
949
950
951
952 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
953 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
954 .cindex "Sieve filter"
955 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
956 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
957 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
958 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
959 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
960 of filtering are available:
961
962 .ilist
963 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
964 by RFC 3028.
965 .next
966 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
967 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
968 .endlist
969
970 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
971
972
973
974 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
975 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
976 .cindex "format" "of message id"
977 .cindex "id of message"
978 .cindex "base62"
979 .cindex "base36"
980 .cindex "Darwin"
981 .cindex "Cygwin"
982 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
983 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
984 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
985 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
986 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
987 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
988 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
989 not always case-sensitive.
990
991 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
992 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
993 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
994 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
995 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
996 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
997 somewhat eccentric:
998
999 .ilist
1000 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1001 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1002 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1003 way of representing the date and time of day).
1004 .next
1005 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1006 received the message.
1007 .next
1008 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1009 .olist
1010 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1011 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1012 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1013 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1014 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1015 .next
1016 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1017 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1018 (1/100) of a second.
1019 .endlist
1020 .endlist
1021
1022 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1023 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1024 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1025 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1026 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1027
1028
1029 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1030 .cindex "receiving mail"
1031 .cindex "message" "reception"
1032 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1033 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1034 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1035 there are several possibilities:
1036
1037 .ilist
1038 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1039 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1040 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1041 .next
1042 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1043 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1044 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1045 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1046 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1047 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1048 .next
1049 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1050 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1051 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1052 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1053 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1054 .next
1055 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1056 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1057 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1058 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1059 .endlist
1060
1061
1062 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1063 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1064 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1065 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1066 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1067 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1068 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1069 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1070 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1071 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1072 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1073 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1074 users to change sender addresses.
1075
1076 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1077 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1078 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1079 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1080 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1081 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1082 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1083
1084 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1085 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1086 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1087 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1088 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1089 message is received.
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094
1095 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1096 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1097 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1098 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1099 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1100 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1101 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1102 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1103
1104 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1105 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1106 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1107 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1108 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1109 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1110 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1111 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1112 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1113 affect file system performance.
1114
1115 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1116 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1117 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1118 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1119 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1120
1121 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1122 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1123 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1124 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1125 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1126 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1127 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1128 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1129 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1130 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1131 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1132 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1133
1134
1135
1136 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1137 .cindex "message" "life of"
1138 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1139 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1140 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1141 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1142 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1143 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1144 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1145
1146 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1147 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1148 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1149 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1150 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1151 to be sent.
1152
1153 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1154 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1155 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1156 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1157 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1158
1159 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1160 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1161 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1162 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1163 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1164 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1165 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1166 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1167 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1168 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1169 systems.
1170
1171 .cindex "journal file"
1172 .cindex "file" "journal"
1173 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1174 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1175 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1176 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1177 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1178 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1179 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1180 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1181
1182 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1183 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1184 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1185 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1186 deliveries caused by crashes.
1187
1188
1189
1190 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1191 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1193 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1194 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1195 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1196 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1197 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1198 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1199
1200 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1201 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1202 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1203 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1204 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1205 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1206 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1207 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1208 the driver's features in general.
1209
1210 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1211 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1212 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1213 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1214 to be bounced.
1215
1216 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1217 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1218 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1219 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1220 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1221 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1222
1223 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1224 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1225 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1226 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1227 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1228 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1229
1230 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1231 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1232 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1233 configuration.
1234
1235 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1236 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1237 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1238 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1239 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1240 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1241 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1242 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1243 configured to fail the address.
1244
1245 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1246 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1247 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1248 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1249 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1250 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1251
1252 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1253 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1254 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1255 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1256 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1257 the address is bounced.
1258
1259
1260
1261 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1262 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1263 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1264 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1265 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1266 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1267 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1268 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1269
1270 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1271 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1272 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1273 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1274 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1275 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1276 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1277 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1278
1279
1280
1281
1282 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1283 .cindex "router" "running details"
1284 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1285 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1286 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1287 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1288 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1289 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1290 the following:
1291
1292 .ilist
1293 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1294 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1295 original address ceases,
1296 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1297 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1298 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1299 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1300 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1301 end of routing.
1302
1303 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1304 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1305 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1306 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1307 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1308 .next
1309 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1310 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1311 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1312 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1313 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1314 .next
1315 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1316 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1317 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1318 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1319 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1320 .next
1321 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1322 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1323 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1324 .next
1325 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1326 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1327 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1328 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1329 .next
1330 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1331 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1332 .endlist
1333
1334 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1335 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1336 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1337 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1338 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1339
1340 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1341 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1342 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1343 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1344 facility for this purpose.
1345
1346
1347 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1348 .cindex "case of local parts"
1349 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1350 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1351 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1352 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1353 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1354 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1355 routed addresses are shown.
1356
1357
1358
1359 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1360 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1361 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1362 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1363 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1364 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1365
1366 .ilist
1367 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1368 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1369 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1370 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1371 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1372 of any other conditions.
1373 .next
1374 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1375 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1376 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1377 address.
1378 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1379 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1380 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1381 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1382 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1383 .next
1384 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1385 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1386 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1387 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1388 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1389 .next
1390 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1391 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1392 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1393 .next
1394 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1395 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1396 .next
1397 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1398 of domains that it defines.
1399 .next
1400 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1402 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1403 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1404 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1405 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1406 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1407 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1408 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1409 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1410 .next
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1412 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1413 .vindex "&$home$&"
1414 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1415 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1416 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1417 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1418 remaining preconditions.
1419 .next
1420 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1421 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1422 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1423 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1424 could lead to confusion.
1425 .next
1426 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1427 set of addresses that it defines.
1428 .next
1429 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1430 specified files is tested.
1431 .next
1432 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1433 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1434 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1435 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1436 .endlist
1437
1438
1439 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1440 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1441 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1442 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1443 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1444 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1445 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1446
1447
1448
1449 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1450 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1451 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1452
1453 .ilist
1454 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1455 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1456 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1457 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1458 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1459 filtering'&.
1460 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1461 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1462
1463 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1464 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1465 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1466 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1467 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1468 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1469 filter.
1470 .next
1471 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1472 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1473 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1474 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1475 processed entirely independently of each other.
1476 .next
1477 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1478 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1479 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1480 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1481 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1482 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1483 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1484 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1485 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1486 .next
1487 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1488 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1489 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1490 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1491 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1492 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1493 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1494 addresses to the same domain.
1495 .next
1496 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1497 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1498 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1499 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1500 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1501 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1502 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1503 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1504 .next
1505 .cindex "queue runner"
1506 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1507 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1508 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1509 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1510 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1511 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1512 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1513 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1514 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1515 .next
1516 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1517 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1518 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1519 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1520 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1521 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1522 .next
1523 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1524 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1525 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1526 messages to other addresses.
1527 .next
1528 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1529 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1530 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1531 &'deferred'&.
1532 .next
1533 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1534 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1535 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1536 .endlist
1537
1538
1539
1540
1541 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1542 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1543 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1544 .cindex "queue runner"
1545 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1546 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1547 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1548 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1549 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1550 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1551 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1552 passed its retry time.
1553 You can run several queue runners at once.
1554
1555 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1556 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1557 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1558 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1559 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1560 as permanent.
1561
1562
1563
1564 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1565 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1566 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1567 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1568 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1569 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1570 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1571 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1572 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1573 also apply.
1574
1575 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1576 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1577 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1578 deferred,
1579 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1580 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1581 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1582 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1583 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1584 one connection.
1585
1586
1587
1588 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1589 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1590 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1591 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1592 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1593 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1594 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1595 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1596 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1597 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1598 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1599
1600 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1601 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1602 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1603 automatically.
1604
1605 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1606 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1607 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1608 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1609 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1610 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1611 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1612 of the list.
1613
1614
1615
1616 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1617 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1618 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1619 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1620 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1621 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1622 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1623 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1631
1632 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1633 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1634
1635 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1636 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1637 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1638 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1639
1640 .table2 140pt
1641 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1642 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1643 documented"
1644 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1645 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1646 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1647 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1648 instructions"
1649 .endtable
1650
1651 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1652 following subdirectories are created:
1653
1654 .table2 140pt
1655 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1656 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1657 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1658 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1659 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1660 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1661 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1662 .endtable
1663
1664 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1665 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1666 that may be useful to some sites.
1667
1668
1669 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1670 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1671 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1672 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1673 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1674 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1675 system.
1676 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1677 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1678 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1679 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1680 overridden if necessary.
1681 .cindex compiler requirements
1682 .cindex compiler version
1683 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1684
1685
1686 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1687 .cindex "PCRE library"
1688 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1689 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1690 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1691 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1692 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1693 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1694 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1695 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1696 If your operating system has no
1697 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1698 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1699 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1700
1701 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1702 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1703 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1704 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1705 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1706 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1707 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1708
1709 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1710 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1711 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1712 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1713 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1714 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1715 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1716 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1717
1718 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1719 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1720 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1721 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1722 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1723 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1724 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1725 Berkeley DB library.
1726
1727 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1728 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1729 possibilities:
1730
1731 .olist
1732 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1733 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1734 .next
1735 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1736 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1737 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1738 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1739 file name is used unmodified.
1740 .next
1741 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1742 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1743 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1744 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1745 .next
1746 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1747 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1748 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1749 .next
1750 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1751 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1752 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1753 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1754 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1755 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1756 .next
1757 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1758 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1759 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1760 operates on a single file.
1761 .endlist
1762
1763 .cindex "USE_DB"
1764 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1765 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1766 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1767 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1768 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1769 .code
1770 USE_DB=yes
1771 .endd
1772 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1773 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1774
1775 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1776 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1777 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1778 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1779 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1780 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1781
1782 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1783 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1784 in one of these lines:
1785 .code
1786 DBMLIB = -ldb
1787 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1788 .endd
1789 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1790 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1791 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1792 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1793 this example:
1794 .code
1795 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1796 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1797 .endd
1798 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1799 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1800
1801
1802
1803 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1804 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1805 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1806 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1807 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1808 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1809 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1810 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1811 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1812 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1813 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1814 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1815
1816 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1817 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1818 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1819 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1820 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1821 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1822
1823 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1824 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1825 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1826 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1827 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1828 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1829 be logged.
1830
1831 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1832 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1833 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1834 facilities, you need to set
1835 .code
1836 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1837 .endd
1838 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1839 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1840
1841
1842 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1843 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1844 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1845 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1846 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1847 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1848 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1849
1850 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1851 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1852 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1853 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1854 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1855 do this.
1856
1857
1858
1859 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1860 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1861 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1862 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1863 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1864 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1865 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1866 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1867 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1868 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1869
1870 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1871 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1872 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1873 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1874 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1875 .code
1876 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1877 .endd
1878 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1879
1880
1881
1882 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1883 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1884 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1885 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1886 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1887 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1888 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1889 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1890 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1891 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1892 line option).
1893
1894 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1895 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1896 implementing SSL.
1897
1898 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1899 .code
1900 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1901 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1902 .endd
1903 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1904 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1905 .code
1906 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1907 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1908 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1909 .endd
1910 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1911 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1912 .code
1913 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1914 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1915 .endd
1916 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1917 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1918 .code
1919 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1920 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1921 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1922 .endd
1923 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1924 library and include files. For example:
1925 .code
1926 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1927 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1928 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1929 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1930 .endd
1931 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1932 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1933 .code
1934 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1935 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1936 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1937 .endd
1938
1939 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1940 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1941 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1942
1943
1944
1945
1946 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1947
1948 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1949 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1950 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1951 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1952 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1953 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1954 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1955 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1956 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1957 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1958 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1959 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1960 you might have
1961 .code
1962 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1963 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1964 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1965 .endd
1966 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1967 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1968 .code
1969 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1970 .endd
1971 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1972 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1973 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1974 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1975 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1976 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1977 further details.
1978
1979
1980 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1981 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1982 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1983 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1984 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1985 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1986 library files.
1987
1988 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1989 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1990 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1991 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1992 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1993 Exim used to
1994 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1995 withdrawn.
1996
1997
1998
1999 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2000 .cindex "lookup modules"
2001 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2002 .cindex ".so building"
2003 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2004 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2005 on demand.
2006 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2007 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2008 dependencies.
2009 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2010
2011 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2012 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2013 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2014 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2015 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2016 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2017
2018 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2019 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2020 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2021 on demand:
2022 .code
2023 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2024 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2025 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2026 .endd
2027
2028
2029 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2030 .cindex "build directory"
2031 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2032 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2033 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2034 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2035 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2036 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2037 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2038
2039 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2040 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2041 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2042 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2043 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2044 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2045 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2046 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2047
2048 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2049 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2050 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2051
2052
2053
2054 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2055 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2056 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2057 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2058 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2059 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2060 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2061 .code
2062 FULLECHO='' make -e
2063 .endd
2064 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2065 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2066 given in addition to the short output.
2067
2068
2069
2070 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2071 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2072 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2073 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2074 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2075 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2076 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2077 order:
2078 .display
2079 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2080 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2081 &_Local/Makefile_&
2082 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2083 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2084 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2085 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2086 .endd
2087 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2088 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2089 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2090 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2091 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2092 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2093 and are often not needed.
2094
2095 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2096 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2097 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2098 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2099 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2100 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2101 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2102 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2103 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2104
2105
2106 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2107 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2108 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2109 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2110 default values are.
2111
2112
2113 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2114 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2115 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2116 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2117 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2118 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2119 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2120 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2121 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2122 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2123 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2124 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2125 containing the lines
2126 .code
2127 CC=cc
2128 CFLAGS=-std1
2129 .endd
2130 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2131 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2132
2133 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2134 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2135 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2136
2137
2138 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2139 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2140 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2141 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2142 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2143 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2144 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2145 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2146 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2147 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2148 .code
2149 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2150 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2151 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2152 .endd
2153 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2154 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2155 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2156 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2157 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2158 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2159 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2160 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2161 errors.
2162
2163 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2164 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2165 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2166 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2167 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2168 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2169 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2170 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2171 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2172 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2173 syntax. For instance:
2174 .code
2175 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2176 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2177 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2178 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2179 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2180 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2181 .endd
2182
2183 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2184 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2185 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2186 .code
2187 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2188 .endd
2189 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2190 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2191
2192 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2193 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2194 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2195 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2196 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2197 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2198 .code
2199 X11=/usr/X11R6
2200 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2201 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2202 .endd
2203 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2204 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2205 .code
2206 X11=/usr/openwin
2207 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2208 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2209 .endd
2210 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2211 definition of all three of these variables into your
2212 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2213
2214 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2215 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2216 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2217 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2218 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2219
2220 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2221 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2222 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2223 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2224 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2225 libraries.
2226
2227 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2228 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2229 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2230 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2231 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2232
2233
2234 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2235 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2236 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2237 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2238 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2239 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2240 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2241 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2242
2243
2244
2245 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2246 .cindex "building Eximon"
2247 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2248 where the files that are involved are
2249 .display
2250 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2251 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2252 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2253 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2254 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2255 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2256 .endd
2257 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2258 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2259 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2260 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2261 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2262 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2263 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2264 .ecindex IIDbuex
2265
2266
2267 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2268 .cindex "installing Exim"
2269 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2270 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2271 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2272 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2273 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2274 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2275 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2276 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2277 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2278 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2279 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2280 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2281
2282 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2283 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2284 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2285 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2286 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2287 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2288 alternative files, no default is installed.
2289
2290 .cindex "system aliases file"
2291 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2292 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2293 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2294 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2295 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2296 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2297 and outputs a comment to the user.
2298
2299 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2300 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2301 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2302 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2303 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2304
2305 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2306 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2307 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2308 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2309 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2310 over SMTP.
2311
2312 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2313 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2314 command such as
2315 .code
2316 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2317 .endd
2318 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2319 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2320 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2321 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2322 but this usage is deprecated.
2323
2324 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2325 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2326 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2327 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2328 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2329 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2330
2331 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2332 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2333 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2334 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2335 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2336 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2337 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2338
2339 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2340 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2341 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2342 command:
2343 .code
2344 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2345 .endd
2346 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2347 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2348 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2349 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2350 command:
2351 .code
2352 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2353 .endd
2354 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2355 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2356
2357 .ilist
2358 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2359 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2360 .next
2361 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2362 installed binary.
2363 .endlist
2364
2365 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2366 .code
2367 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2368 .endd
2369 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2370 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2371 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2372 .code
2373 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2374 .endd
2375
2376
2377
2378 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2379 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2380 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2381 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2382 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2383 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2384
2385 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2386 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2387 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2388
2389
2390
2391 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2392 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2393 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2394 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2395 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2396 necessary.
2397
2398
2399
2400
2401 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2402 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2403 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2404 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2405 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2406 .code
2407 exim -bV
2408 .endd
2409 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2410 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2411 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2412 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2413 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2414 example,
2415 .display
2416 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2417 .endd
2418 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2419 .display
2420 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2421 .endd
2422 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2423 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2424 user agent. For example:
2425 .code
2426 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2427 From: user@your.domain.example
2428 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2429 Subject: Testing Exim
2430
2431 This is a test message.
2432 ^D
2433 .endd
2434 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2435 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2436 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2437
2438 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2439 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2440 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2441 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2442 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2443 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2444 .display
2445 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2446 .endd
2447 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2448 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2449 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2450 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2451 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2452
2453 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2454 .cindex "lock files"
2455 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2456 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2457 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2458 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2459 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2460 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2461 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2462 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2463 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2464 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2465 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2466 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2467
2468 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2469 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2470 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2471 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2472 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2473 incoming SMTP mail.
2474
2475 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2476 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2477 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2478 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2479 production version.
2480
2481
2482 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2483 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2484 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2485 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2486 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2487 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2488 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2489 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2490 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2491 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2492 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2493 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2494 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2495
2496 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2497 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2498 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2499 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2500 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2501 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2502 as follows:
2503 .code
2504 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2505 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2506 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2507 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2508 .endd
2509 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2510 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2511 favourite user agent.
2512
2513 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2514 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2515 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2516 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2517 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2518 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2519
2520
2521
2522 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2523 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2524 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2525 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2526 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2527 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2528 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2529 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2530 configuration file.
2531
2532
2533
2534
2535 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2536 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2537 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2538 .code
2539 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2540 .endd
2541 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2542 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2543 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2544 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2545 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2546 .code
2547 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2548 .endd
2549 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2550
2551 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2552 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2553 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2554
2555
2556
2557
2558 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2559 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2560
2561 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2562 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2563 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2564 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2565 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2566 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2567 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2568 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2569 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2570
2571
2572 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2573 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2574 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2575 were present before any other options.
2576 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2577 standard output.
2578 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2579 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2580 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2581
2582 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2583 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2584 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2585 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2586 format.
2587
2588 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2589 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2590 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2591 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2592
2593 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2594 .cindex "queue runner"
2595 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2596 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2597 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2598
2599 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2600 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2601 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2602 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2603 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2604 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2605 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2606 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2607
2608
2609 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2610 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2611 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2612 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2613 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2614 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2615
2616 .ilist
2617 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2618 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2619 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2620 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2621 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2622 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2623
2624 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2625 .cindex "envelope sender"
2626 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2627 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2628 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2629 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2630 users to set envelope senders.
2631
2632 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2633 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2634 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
2635 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2636 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2637 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2638 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2639
2640 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2641 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2642 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2643 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2644 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2645 that are available to trusted users.
2646 .next
2647 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2648 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2649 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2650 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2651 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2652
2653 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2654 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2655 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2656 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2657
2658 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2659 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2660 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2661 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2662
2663 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2664 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2665 false.
2666 .endlist
2667
2668
2669 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2670 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2671 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2672 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2673
2674
2675
2676
2677 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2678 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2679 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2680 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2681 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2682 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2683 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2684 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2685
2686 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2687 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2688 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2689 . creates a man page for the options.
2690 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2691
2692 .literal xml
2693 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2694 .literal off
2695
2696
2697 .vlist
2698 .vitem &%--%&
2699 .oindex "--"
2700 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2701 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2702 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2703 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2704
2705 .vitem &%--help%&
2706 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2707 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2708 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2709 no arguments.
2710
2711 .vitem &%--version%&
2712 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2713 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2714 displayed.
2715
2716 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2717 &%-Am%&
2718 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2719 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2720 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2721 ignored by Exim.
2722
2723 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2724 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2725 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2726 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2727 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2728 clean; it ignores this option.
2729
2730 .vitem &%-bd%&
2731 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2732 .cindex "daemon"
2733 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2734 .cindex "queue runner"
2735 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2736 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2737 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2738
2739 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2740 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2741 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2742 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2743
2744 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2745 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2746 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2747 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2748
2749 When a listening daemon
2750 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2751 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2752 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2753 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2754 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2755 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2756 running as root.
2757
2758 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2759 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2760 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2761
2762 The SIGHUP signal
2763 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2764 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2765 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2766 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2767 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2768 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2769 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2770 because these are reread each time they are used.
2771
2772 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2773 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2774 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2775 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2776
2777 .vitem &%-be%&
2778 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2779 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2780 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2781 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2782 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2783 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2784 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2785
2786 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2787 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2788 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2789 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2790 test data. A line history is supported.
2791
2792 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2793 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2794 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2795 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2796 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2797 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2798 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2799
2800 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2801 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2802 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2803 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2804
2805 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2806 defined and macros will be expanded.
2807 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2808 available to admin users.
2809
2810 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2811 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2812 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2813 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2814 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2815 of a file. For example:
2816 .code
2817 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2818 .endd
2819 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2820 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2821 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2822 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2823 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2824 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2825 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2826 &%-be%&).
2827
2828 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2829 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2830 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2831 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2832 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2833 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2834 system filters are recognized.
2835
2836 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2837 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2838 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2839 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2840 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2841 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2842 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2843 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2844 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2845 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2846 supplied.
2847
2848 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2849 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2850 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2851 .code
2852 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2853 .endd
2854 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2855 variables that are used by the user filter.
2856
2857 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2858 .code
2859 # Exim filter
2860 # Sieve filter
2861 .endd
2862 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2863 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2864 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2865 redirection lists.
2866
2867 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2868 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2869 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2870 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2871
2872 When testing a filter file,
2873 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2874 .cindex "envelope sender"
2875 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2876 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2877 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2878 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2879 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2880 options).
2881
2882 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2883 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2884 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2885 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2886 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2887 &$qualify_domain$&.
2888
2889 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2890 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2891 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2892 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2893 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2894 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2895 actually being delivered.
2896
2897 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2898 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2899 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2900 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2901 prefix.
2902
2903 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2904 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2905 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2906 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2907 suffix.
2908
2909 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2910 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2911 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2912 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2913 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2914 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2915 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2916 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2917 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2918 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2919 after a full stop. For example:
2920 .code
2921 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2922 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2923 .endd
2924 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2925 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2926 conversion to the canonical form is
2927 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2928
2929 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2930 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2931 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2932 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2933 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2934
2935 &*Warning 1*&:
2936 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2937 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2938 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2939 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2940 connection.
2941
2942 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2943 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2944 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2945
2946 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2947 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2948 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2949 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2950 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2951 session were authenticated.
2952
2953 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2954 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2955 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2956
2957 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2958 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2959 specialized SMTP test program such as
2960 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2961
2962 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2963 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2964 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2965 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2966 updating the callout cache database.
2967
2968 .vitem &%-bi%&
2969 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2970 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2971 .cindex "building alias file"
2972 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2973 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2974 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2975 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2976 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2977 recognized.
2978
2979 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2980 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2981 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2982 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2983 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2984 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2985 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2986
2987 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2988 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
2989 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2990 .cindex "querying exim information"
2991 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2992 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2993 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2994 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2995 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2996
2997 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2998 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2999 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
3000 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3001 recognised DSCP names.
3002
3003 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3004 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3005 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3006 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3007 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3008 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3009 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3010 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3011 way to guarantee a correct response.
3012
3013 .vitem &%-bm%&
3014 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
3015 .cindex "local message reception"
3016 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3017 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3018 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3019 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3020 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3021 if no other conflicting option is present.
3022
3023 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3024 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3025 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3026 suppressing this for special cases.
3027
3028 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3029 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3030
3031 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3032 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3033 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3034
3035 The format
3036 .cindex "message" "format"
3037 .cindex "format" "message"
3038 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3039 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3040 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3041 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3042 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3043 .code
3044 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3045 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3046 .endd
3047 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3048 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3049 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3050 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3051 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3052
3053 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3054 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3055 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3056 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3057 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3058
3059 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3060 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3061 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3062 .cindex "malware scan test"
3063 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3064 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3065 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3066 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3067 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3068 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3069 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3070
3071 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3072 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3073 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3074 This option requires admin privileges.
3075
3076 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3077 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3078 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3079
3080 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3081 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3082 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3083 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3084 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3085 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3086 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3087 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3088 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3089
3090 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3091 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3092 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3093 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3094 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3095
3096 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3097 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3098 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3099 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3100
3101
3102 .vitem &%-bP%&
3103 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3104 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3105 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3106 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3107 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3108 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3109 arguments, for example:
3110 .code
3111 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3112 .endd
3113 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3114 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3115 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3116 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3117 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3118 users, the output is as in this example:
3119 .code
3120 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3121 .endd
3122 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3123 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3124
3125 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3126 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3127 backward compatibility.)
3128 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3129 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3130
3131 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3132 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3133 name will not be output.
3134
3135 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3136 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3137 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3138 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3139 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3140 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3141 written directly into the spool directory.
3142
3143 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3144 .code
3145 exim -bP +local_domains
3146 .endd
3147 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3148 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3149
3150 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3151 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3152 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3153 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3154 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3155 that driver are output. For example:
3156 .code
3157 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3158 .endd
3159 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3160 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3161 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3162 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3163 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3164 &%authenticators%&.
3165
3166 .cindex "environment"
3167 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3168 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3169 variables.
3170
3171 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3172 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3173 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3174 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3175 The output format is one item per line.
3176 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3177 the exit status will be nonzero.
3178
3179 .vitem &%-bp%&
3180 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3181 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3182 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3183 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3184 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3185 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3186 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3187 to allow any user to see the queue.
3188
3189 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3190 .code
3191 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3192 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3193 <other addresses>
3194 .endd
3195 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3196 .cindex "size" "of message"
3197 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3198 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3199 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3200 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3201 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3202 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3203 before the sender address.
3204
3205 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3206 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3207 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3208
3209 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3210 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3211 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3212 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3213 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3214 complete.
3215
3216
3217 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3218 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3219 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3220 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3221 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3222 of just &"D"&.
3223
3224
3225 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3226 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3227 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3228 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3229 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3230 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3231
3232
3233 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3234 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3235 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3236 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3237 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3238 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3239
3240 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3241 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3242 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3243
3244 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3245 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3246 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3247
3248
3249 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3250 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3251 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3252 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3253 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3254 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3255
3256
3257 .vitem &%-brt%&
3258 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3259 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3260 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3261 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3262 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3263 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3264 .code
3265 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3266 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3267 .endd
3268 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3269 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3270 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3271 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3272 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3273 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3274 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3275 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3276 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3277 .code
3278 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3279 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3280 .endd
3281
3282 .vitem &%-brw%&
3283 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3284 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3285 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3286 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3287 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3288 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3289 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3290 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3291
3292 .vitem &%-bS%&
3293 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3294 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3295 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3296 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3297 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3298 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3299 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3300 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3301 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3302 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3303
3304 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3305 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3306 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3307
3308 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3309 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3310 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3311 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3312
3313 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3314 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3315 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3316
3317 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3318 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3319 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3320 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3321 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3322
3323 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3324 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3325
3326 .vitem &%-bs%&
3327 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3328 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3329 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3330 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3331 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3332 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3333 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3334 messages to the MTA.
3335
3336 In
3337 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3338 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3339 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3340 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3341 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3342 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3343 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3344
3345 .cindex "inetd"
3346 The
3347 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3348 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3349 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3350 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3351 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3352 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3353 the listening daemon.
3354
3355 .vitem &%-bt%&
3356 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3357 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3358 .cindex "address" "testing"
3359 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3360 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3361 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3362 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3363 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3364
3365 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3366 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3367
3368 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3369 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3370 security issues.
3371
3372 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3373 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3374 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3375 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3376 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3377 program.
3378
3379 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3380 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3381 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3382 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3383
3384 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3385 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3386 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3387 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3388 always shown.
3389
3390 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3391 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3392 message,
3393 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3394 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3395 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3396 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3397 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3398 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3399 doing such tests.
3400
3401 .vitem &%-bV%&
3402 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3403 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3404 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3405 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3406 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3407 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3408 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3409
3410 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3411 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3412 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3413 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3414 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3415 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3416 dynamic testing facilities.
3417
3418 .vitem &%-bv%&
3419 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3420 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3421 .cindex "address" "verification"
3422 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3423 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3424 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3425 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3426 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3427 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3428
3429 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3430 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3431 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3432
3433 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3434 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3435
3436 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3437 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3438 security issues.
3439
3440 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3441 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3442 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3443 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3444 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3445
3446 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3447 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3448 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3449 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3450 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3451 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3452 to succeed.
3453
3454 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3455 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3456 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3457
3458 The
3459 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3460 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3461 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3462 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3463
3464 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3465 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3466 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3467 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3468
3469 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3470 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3471 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3472 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3473 might happen.
3474
3475 .vitem &%-bw%&
3476 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3477 .cindex "daemon"
3478 .cindex "inetd"
3479 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3480 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3481 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3482 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3483
3484 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3485 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3486 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3487 each port only when the first connection is received.
3488
3489 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3490 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3491
3492 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3493 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3494 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3495 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3496 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3497 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3498 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3499 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3500 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3501 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3502 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3503
3504 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3505 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3506 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3507 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3508 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3509 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3510 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3511 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3512 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3513
3514 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3515 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3516 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3517 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3518 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3519 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3520 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3521
3522 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3523 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3524 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3525 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3526 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3527 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3528 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3529
3530 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3531 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3532 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3533 configuration file.
3534
3535 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3536 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3537 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3538 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3539 specified by this option.
3540
3541
3542 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3543 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3544 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3545 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3546 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3547 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3548 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3549 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3550
3551 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3552 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3553 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3554 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3555 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3556 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3557 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3558
3559 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3560 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3561 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3562 synonymous:
3563 .code
3564 exim -DABC ...
3565 exim -DABC= ...
3566 .endd
3567 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3568 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3569 example:
3570 .code
3571 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3572 .endd
3573 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3574 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3575
3576
3577 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3578 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3579 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3580 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3581 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3582 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3583 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3584 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3585 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3586 return code.
3587
3588 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3589 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3590 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3591 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3592 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3593 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3594 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3595 are:
3596 .display
3597 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3598 &`auth `& authenticators
3599 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3600 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3601 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3602 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3603 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3604 &`filter `& filter handling
3605 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3606 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3607 &`ident `& ident lookup
3608 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3609 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3610 &`load `& system load checks
3611 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3612 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3613 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3614 &`memory `& memory handling
3615 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3616 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3617 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3618 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3619 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3620 &`retry `& retry handling
3621 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3622 &`route `& address routing
3623 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3624 &`tls `& TLS logic
3625 &`transport `& transports
3626 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3627 &`verify `& address verification logic
3628 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3629 .endd
3630 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3631 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3632 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3633 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3634 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3635 turn everything off.
3636
3637 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3638 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3639 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3640 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3641 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3642 rather than stderr.
3643
3644 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3645 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3646 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3647 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3648 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3649 run in parallel.
3650
3651 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3652 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3653 in processing.
3654
3655 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3656 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3657
3658 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3659 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3660 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3661 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3662 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3663 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3664
3665 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3666 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3667 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3668 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3669 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3670
3671 .vitem &%-E%&
3672 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3673 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3674 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3675 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3676 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3677 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3678 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3679 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3680 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3681
3682 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3683 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3684 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3685 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3686 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3687 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3688
3689 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3690 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3691 .cindex "sender" "name"
3692 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3693 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3694 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3695 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3696 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3697 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3698
3699 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3700 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3701 .cindex "sender" "address"
3702 .cindex "address" "sender"
3703 .cindex "trusted users"
3704 .cindex "envelope sender"
3705 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3706 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3707 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3708 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3709 users to use it.
3710
3711 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3712 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3713 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3714 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3715 domain.
3716
3717 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3718 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3719 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3720 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3721 examples of shell commands:
3722 .code
3723 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3724 exim -f "" user@domain
3725 .endd
3726 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3727 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3728 &%-bv%& options.
3729
3730 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3731 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3732 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3733 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3734
3735 White
3736 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3737 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3738 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3739 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3740 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3741 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3742
3743 .vitem &%-G%&
3744 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3745 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3746 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3747 .code
3748 control = suppress_local_fixups
3749 .endd
3750 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3751 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3752 in future.
3753
3754 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3755 this option.
3756
3757 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3758 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3759 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3760 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3761 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3762 headers.)
3763
3764 .vitem &%-i%&
3765 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3766 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3767 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3768 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3769 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3770 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3771 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3772
3773 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3774 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3775 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3776 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3777 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3778 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3779 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3780 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3781
3782 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3783
3784 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3785 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3786 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3787 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3788 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3789 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3790 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3791 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3792 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3793
3794 Retry
3795 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3796 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3797 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3798 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3799 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3800 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3801
3802 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3803 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3804 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3805 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3806
3807 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3808 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3809 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3810 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3811 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3812 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3813 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3814 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3815 can be used only by an admin user.
3816
3817 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3818 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3819 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3820 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3821 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3822 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3823 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3824 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3825 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3826 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3827 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3828
3829 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3830 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3831 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3832 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3833 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3834
3835 .vitem &%-MCD%&
3836 .oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3837 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3838 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3839 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3840
3841 .vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3842 .oindex "&%-MCG%&"
3843 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3844 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3845 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3846
3847 .vitem &%-MCK%&
3848 .oindex "&%-MCK%&"
3849 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3850 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3851 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3852
3853 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3854 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3855 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3856 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3857 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3858
3859 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3860 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3861 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3862 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3863 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3864 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3865 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3866 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3867
3868 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3869 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3870 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3871 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3872 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3873 connection.
3874
3875 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3876 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3877 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3878 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3879 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3880
3881 .vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3882 .oindex "&%-MCt%&"
3883 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3884 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3885 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3886 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3887
3888 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3889 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3890 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3891 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3892 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3893 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3894 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3895 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3896 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3897 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3898 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3899 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3900 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3901 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3902 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3903
3904 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3905 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3906 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3907 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3908 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3909 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3910 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3911 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3912 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3913 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3914
3915 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3916 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3917 .cindex "freezing messages"
3918 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3919 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3920 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3921 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3922 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3923 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3924 user.
3925
3926 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3927 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3928 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3929 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3930 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3931 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3932 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3933 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3934 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3935 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3936 user.
3937
3938 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3939 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3940 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3941 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3942 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3943 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3944 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3945
3946 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3947 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3948 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3949 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3950 .cindex "removing recipients"
3951 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3952 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3953 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3954 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3955 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3956 can be used only by an admin user.
3957
3958 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3959 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3960 .cindex "removing messages"
3961 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3962 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3963 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3964 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3965 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3966 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3967 placed on the queue.
3968
3969 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3970 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3971 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3972 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3973 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3974 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3975 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3976 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3977 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3978 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3979 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3980
3981 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3982 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3983 .cindex "thawing messages"
3984 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3985 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3986 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3987 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3988 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3989 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3990 by an admin user.
3991
3992 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3993 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3994 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3995 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3996 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3997 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3998
3999 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4000 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
4001 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4002 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4003 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4004 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4005 only by an admin user.
4006
4007 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4008 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
4009 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4010 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4011 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4012 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4013 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4014
4015 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4016 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
4017 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4018 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4019 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4020 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4021
4022 .vitem &%-m%&
4023 .oindex "&%-m%&"
4024 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4025 treats it that way too.
4026
4027 .vitem &%-N%&
4028 .oindex "&%-N%&"
4029 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4030 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4031 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4032 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4033 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4034 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4035 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4036 than &"=>"&.
4037
4038 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4039 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4040 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4041 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4042 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4043 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4044 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4045 for that message.
4046
4047 .vitem &%-n%&
4048 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4049 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4050 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4051 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4052 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4053
4054 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4055 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4056 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4057 Exim.
4058
4059 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4060 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4061 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4062 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4063 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4064 description above.
4065
4066 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4067 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4068 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4069 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4070 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4071 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4072 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4073 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4074
4075 .vitem &%-odb%&
4076 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4077 .cindex "background delivery"
4078 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4079 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4080 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4081 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4082 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4083 processes to finish.
4084
4085 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4086 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4087 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4088 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4089
4090 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4091 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4092 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4093 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4094
4095 .vitem &%-odf%&
4096 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4097 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4098 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4099 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4100 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4101 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4102 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4103
4104 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4105 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4106 during deliveries.
4107
4108 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4109 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4110
4111 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4112 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4113 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4114 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4115
4116
4117 .vitem &%-odi%&
4118 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4119 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4120 Sendmail.
4121
4122 .vitem &%-odq%&
4123 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4124 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4125 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4126 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4127 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4128 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4129 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4130 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4131 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4132 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4133 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4134 forces queueing.
4135
4136 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4137 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4138 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4139 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4140 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4141 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4142 configuration file is in effect.
4143
4144 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4145 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4146 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4147 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4148 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4149 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4150 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4151 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4152 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4153 &%-qq%& option.
4154
4155 .vitem &%-oee%&
4156 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4157 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4158 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4159 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4160 message.
4161
4162 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4163 Provided
4164 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4165 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4166 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4167 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4168
4169 .vitem &%-oem%&
4170 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4171 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4172 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4173 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4174 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4175 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4176
4177 .vitem &%-oep%&
4178 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4179 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4180 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4181 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4182 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4183 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4184
4185 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4186 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4187 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4188 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4189 effect as &%-oep%&.
4190
4191 .vitem &%-oew%&
4192 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4193 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4194 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4195 effect as &%-oem%&.
4196
4197 .vitem &%-oi%&
4198 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4199 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4200 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4201 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4202 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4203 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4204 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4205
4206 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4207 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4208 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4209
4210 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4211 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4212 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4213 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4214 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4215 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4216 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4217 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4218
4219 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4220 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4221 .code
4222 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4223 .endd
4224 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4225 followed by a colon and the port number:
4226 .code
4227 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4228 .endd
4229 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4230 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4231 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4232 whichever one is last.
4233
4234 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4235 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4236 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4237 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4238 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4239 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4240 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4241 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4242
4243 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4244 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4245 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4246 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4247 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4248 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4249 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4250 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4251
4252 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4253 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4254 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4255 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4256 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4257 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4258 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4259 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4260 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4261 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4262
4263 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4264 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4265 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4266 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4267 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4268 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4269 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4270
4271 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4272 .oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4273 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4274 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4275 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4276 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4277 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4278 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4279 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4280
4281 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4282 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4283 is sending the bounce.
4284
4285 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4286 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4287 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4288 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4289 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4290 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4291 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4292 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4293 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4294 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4295 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4296 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4297
4298 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4299 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4300 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4301 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4302 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4303 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4304 uses the name it is given.
4305
4306 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4307 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4308 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4309 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4310 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4311 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4312 used, when there is no default.
4313
4314 .vitem &%-om%&
4315 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4316 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4317 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4318 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4319 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4320
4321 .vitem &%-oo%&
4322 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4323 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4324 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4325 whatever that means.
4326
4327 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4328 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4329 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4330 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4331 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4332 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4333 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4334 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4335 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4336
4337 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4338 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4339 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4340 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4341 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4342 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4343 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4344
4345 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4346 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4347 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4348 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4349 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4350 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4351 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4352 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4353
4354 .vitem &%-ov%&
4355 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4356 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4357
4358 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4359 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4360 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4361 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4362 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4363 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4364 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4365 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4366 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4367 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4368
4369 .vitem &%-pd%&
4370 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4371 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4372 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4373 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4374 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4375 needed.
4376
4377 .vitem &%-ps%&
4378 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4379 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4380 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4381 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4382 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4383 started.
4384
4385 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4386 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4387 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4388 .display
4389 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4390 .endd
4391 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4392 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4393 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4394 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4395 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4396 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4397
4398 .vitem &%-q%&
4399 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4400 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4401 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4402 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4403 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4404 and &%-S%& options).
4405
4406 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4407 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4408 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4409 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4410 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4411 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4412 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4413
4414 If
4415 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4416 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4417 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4418 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4419 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4420 proceeding.
4421
4422 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4423 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4424 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4425 this to be repeated periodically.
4426
4427 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4428 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4429 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4430 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4431
4432 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4433 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4434 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4435
4436 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4437 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4438 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4439 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4440
4441 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4442 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4443 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4444 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4445 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4446 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4447 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4448 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4449 transports are run.
4450
4451 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4452 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4453 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4454 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4455 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4456 delivered down a single SMTP
4457 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4458 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4459 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4460 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4461 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4462 intermittently.
4463
4464 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4465 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4466 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4467 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4468 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4469 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4470 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4471
4472 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4473 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4474 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4475 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4476 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4477 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4478 their retry times are tried.
4479
4480 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4481 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4482 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4483 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4484 frozen or not.
4485
4486 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4487 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4488 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4489 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4490 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4491 for later delivery.
4492
4493 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4494 .oindex "&%-qG%&"
4495 .cindex queue named
4496 .cindex "named queues"
4497 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4498 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4499 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4500 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4501 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4502 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4503
4504 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4505 will specify a queue to operate on.
4506 For example:
4507 .code
4508 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4509 mailq -qGquarantine
4510 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4511 .endd
4512
4513 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4514 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4515 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4516 starting message id. For example:
4517 .code
4518 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4519 .endd
4520 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4521 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4522 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4523 .code
4524 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4525 .endd
4526 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4527 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4528 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4529 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4530 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4531 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4532
4533 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4534 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4535 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4536 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4537 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4538 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4539 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4540 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4541 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4542 .code
4543 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4544 .endd
4545 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4546 process every 30 minutes.
4547
4548 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4549 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4550
4551 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4552 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4553 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4554 compatibility.
4555
4556 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4557 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4558 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4559
4560 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4561 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4562 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4563 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4564 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4565 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4566 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4567 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4568 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4569
4570 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4571 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4572 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4573 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4574 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4575 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4576
4577 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4578 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4579 .code
4580 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4581 .endd
4582 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4583 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4584 applied to each queue run.
4585
4586 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4587 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4588 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4589 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4590 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4591 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4592 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4593 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4594 address will be skipped.
4595
4596 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4597 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4598 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4599 &'ff'& is present.
4600
4601 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4602 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4603 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4604 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4605 an arbitrary command instead.
4606
4607 .vitem &%-r%&
4608 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4609 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4610
4611 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4612 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4613 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4614 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4615 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4616 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4617 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4618 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4619
4620 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4621 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4622 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4623 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4624 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4625
4626 .vitem &%-t%&
4627 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4628 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4629 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4630 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4631 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4632 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4633 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4634 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4635 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4636 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4637
4638 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4639 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4640 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4641 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4642 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4643 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4644 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4645 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4646 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4647 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4648 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4649
4650 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4651 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4652 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4653 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4654 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4655 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4656
4657 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4658 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4659 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4660 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4661 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4662 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4663 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4664 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4665 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4666
4667 .vitem &%-ti%&
4668 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4669 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4670 compatibility with Sendmail.
4671
4672 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4673 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4674 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4675 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4676 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4677 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4678 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4679 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4680
4681
4682 .vitem &%-U%&
4683 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4684 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4685 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4686 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4687 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4688 set. Exim ignores this option.
4689
4690 .vitem &%-v%&
4691 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4692 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4693 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4694 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4695 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4696 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4697 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4698 unconditional.
4699
4700 .vitem &%-x%&
4701 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4702 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4703 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4704 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4705 this option.
4706
4707 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4708 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4709 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4710 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4711
4712 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4713 .oindex "&%-z%&"
4714 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4715 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4716 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4717 under most shells.
4718 .endlist
4719
4720 .ecindex IIDclo1
4721 .ecindex IIDclo2
4722
4723
4724 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4725 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4726 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4727 . creates a man page for the options.
4728 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4729
4730 .literal xml
4731 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4732 .literal off
4733
4734
4735
4736
4737
4738 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4740
4741
4742 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4743 "The runtime configuration file"
4744
4745 .cindex "run time configuration"
4746 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4747 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4748 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4749 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4750 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4751 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4752 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4753 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4754 control.
4755
4756 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4757 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4758 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4759 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4760 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4761 actually alter the string.
4762
4763 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4764 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4765 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4766 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4767 existing file in the list.
4768
4769 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4770 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4771 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4772 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4773 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4774 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4775 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4776 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4777 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4778 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4779 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4780
4781 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4782 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4783 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4784 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4785 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4786
4787 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4788 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4789 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4790 compromise the Exim user account.
4791
4792 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4793 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4794 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4795 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4796 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4797 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4798 configuration.
4799
4800
4801
4802 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4803 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4804 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4805 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4806 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4807 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4808 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4809 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4810 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4811 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4812 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4813
4814 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4815 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4816 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4817 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4818 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4819 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4820 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4821 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4822 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4823 &%-M%&).
4824
4825 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4826 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4827 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4828 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4829 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4830
4831 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4832 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4833 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4834 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4835 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4836 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4837
4838 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4839 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4840 necessarily be discarded.
4841 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4842 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4843 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4844 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4845 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4846 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4847
4848 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4849 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4850 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4851 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4852 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4853 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4854 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4855
4856 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4857 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4858 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4859
4860
4861
4862 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4863 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4864 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4865 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4866 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4867 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4868 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4869 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4870
4871 .ilist
4872 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4873 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4874 .next
4875 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4876 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4877 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4878 .next
4879 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4880 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4881 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4882 .next
4883 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4884 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4885 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4886 .next
4887 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4888 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4889 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4890 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4891 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4892 .next
4893 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4894 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4895 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4896 .next
4897 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4898 want to use this feature, you must set
4899 .code
4900 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4901 .endd
4902 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4903 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4904 .endlist
4905
4906 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4907 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4908 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4909 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4910
4911 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4912 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4913 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4914 and does not introduce a comment.
4915
4916 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4917 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4918 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4919 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4920 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4921
4922 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4923 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4924 change settings as required.
4925
4926 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4927 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4928 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4929 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4930 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4931 described.
4932
4933
4934
4935 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4936 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4937 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4938 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4939 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4940 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4941 using this syntax:
4942 .display
4943 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4944 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4945 .endd
4946 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4947 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4948 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4949 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
4950 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute file
4951 name is required.
4952
4953 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4954 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4955 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4956 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4957
4958 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4959 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4960 for example:
4961 .code
4962 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4963 .include /some/file
4964 .endd
4965 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4966 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4967 inclusion appears.
4968
4969
4970
4971 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4972 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4973 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4974 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4975 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4976 definition, and must be of the form
4977 .display
4978 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4979 .endd
4980 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4981 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4982 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4983 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4984 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4985
4986 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4987 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4988 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4989
4990 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4991 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4992 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4993 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4994 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4995 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4996 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4997 define
4998 .display
4999 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5000 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5001 .endd
5002 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5003 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5004 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5005 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5006 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5007 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5008
5009
5010 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5011 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5012 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5013 &'='&. For example:
5014 .code
5015 MAC = initial value
5016 ...
5017 MAC == updated value
5018 .endd
5019 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5020 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5021 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5022 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5023 .code
5024 MAC = initial value
5025 ...
5026 MAC == MAC and something added
5027 .endd
5028 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5029 from a number of other files.
5030
5031 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5032 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5033 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5034 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5035 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5036 file to be ignored.
5037
5038
5039
5040 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5041 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5042 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5043 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5044 .code
5045 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5046 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5047 .endd
5048 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5049 .code
5050 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5051 .endd
5052 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5053 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5054 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5055
5056
5057 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5058 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5059 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5060 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5061 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5062 (see below).
5063
5064 The following classes of macros are defined:
5065 .display
5066 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5067 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5068 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5069 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5070 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5071 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5072 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5073 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5074 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5075 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5076 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5077 .endd
5078
5079 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5080
5081
5082 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5083 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5084 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5085 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5086 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5087 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5088 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5089
5090 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5091 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5092 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5093 line. Thus:
5094 .code
5095 .ifdef AAA
5096 message_size_limit = 50M
5097 .else
5098 message_size_limit = 100M
5099 .endif
5100 .endd
5101 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5102 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5103 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5104 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5105 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5106
5107 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5108 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5109 in this line"& will always be true.
5110
5111 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5112 to clarify complicated nestings.
5113
5114
5115
5116 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5117 .cindex "common option syntax"
5118 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5119 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5120 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5121 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5122 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5123 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5124 space) and then the value. For example:
5125 .code
5126 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5127 .endd
5128 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5129 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5130 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5131 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5132 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5133 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5134 word &"hide"&. For example:
5135 .code
5136 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5137 .endd
5138 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5139 .code
5140 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5141 .endd
5142 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5143 all instances of the same driver.
5144
5145 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5146 that are found in option settings.
5147
5148
5149 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5150 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5151 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5152 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5153 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5154 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5155 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5156 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5157 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5158 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5159 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5160 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5161 .code
5162 queue_only
5163 queue_only = true
5164 .endd
5165 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5166 .code
5167 no_queue_only
5168 queue_only = false
5169 .endd
5170 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5171
5172
5173
5174
5175 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5176 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5177 .cindex "format" "integer"
5178 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5179 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5180 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5181 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5182 hexadecimal number.
5183
5184 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5185 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5186 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5187 When the values
5188 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5189 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5190 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5191 used.
5192
5193
5194 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5195 .cindex "integer format"
5196 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5197 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5198 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5199 Such options are always output in octal.
5200
5201
5202 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5203 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5204 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5205 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5206 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5207
5208
5209
5210 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5211 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5212 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5213 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5214 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5215
5216 .table2 30pt
5217 .irow &%s%& seconds
5218 .irow &%m%& minutes
5219 .irow &%h%& hours
5220 .irow &%d%& days
5221 .irow &%w%& weeks
5222 .endtable
5223
5224 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5225 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5226 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5227
5228
5229
5230 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5231 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5232 .cindex "format" "string"
5233 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5234 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5235 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5236 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5237 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5238 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5239 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5240 therefore equivalent:
5241 .code
5242 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5243 trusted_users = uucp:\
5244 # This comment line is ignored
5245 mail
5246 .endd
5247 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5248 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5249 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5250 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5251 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5252
5253 .table2 100pt
5254 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5255 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5256 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5257 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5258 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5259 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5260 character"
5261 .endtable
5262
5263 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5264 character, that character replaces the pair.
5265
5266 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5267 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5268 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5269 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5270 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5271 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5272
5273
5274 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5275 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5276 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5277 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5278 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5279 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5280 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5281 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5282 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5283 within a quoted configuration string.
5284
5285
5286 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5287 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5288 .cindex "format" "user name"
5289 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5290 .cindex "format" "group name"
5291 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5292 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5293 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5294 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5295
5296
5297 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5298 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5299 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5300 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5301 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5302 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5303 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5304 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5305 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5306 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5307 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5308
5309 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5310 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5311 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5312 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5313 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5314 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5315 example, the list
5316 .code
5317 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5318 .endd
5319 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5320
5321 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5322 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5323 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5324 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5325
5326 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5327 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5328 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5329 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5330 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5331 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5332 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5333 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5334 .code
5335 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5336 .endd
5337 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5338 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5339 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5340
5341 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5342 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5343 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5344 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5345 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5346 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5347 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5348 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5349 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5350 .code
5351 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5352 .endd
5353 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5354 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5355 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5356 the value in quotes. For example:
5357 .code
5358 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5359 .endd
5360 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5361 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5362 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5363 enclosing an empty list item.
5364
5365
5366
5367 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5368 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5369 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5370 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5371 .code
5372 senders = user@domain :
5373 .endd
5374 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5375 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5376 items, the second of which is empty:
5377 .code
5378 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5379 .endd
5380 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5381 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5382 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5383 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5384 .code
5385 senders = :
5386 .endd
5387 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5388 is at the end of the list.
5389
5390
5391
5392
5393 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5394 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5395 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5396 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5397 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5398 a sequence of lines like this:
5399 .display
5400 <&'instance name'&>:
5401 <&'option'&>
5402 ...
5403 <&'option'&>
5404 .endd
5405 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5406 followed by three options settings:
5407 .code
5408 localuser:
5409 driver = accept
5410 check_local_user
5411 transport = local_delivery
5412 .endd
5413 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5414 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5415 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5416 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5417 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5418 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5419
5420 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5421 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5422
5423 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5424 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5425 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5426 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5427 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5428 server.
5429
5430 .cindex "generic options"
5431 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5432 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5433 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5434 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5435 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5436 .cindex "private options"
5437 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5438 they all have default values.
5439
5440 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5441 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5442 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5443
5444 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5445 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5446 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5447 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5448 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5449 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5450 configuration lines:
5451 .code
5452 remote_smtp:
5453 driver = smtp
5454 .endd
5455 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5456 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5457 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5458 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5459 thus:
5460 .code
5461 special_smtp:
5462 driver = smtp
5463 port = 1234
5464 command_timeout = 10s
5465 .endd
5466 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5467 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5468 lines.
5469
5470 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5471 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5472 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5473 option.
5474
5475
5476
5477
5478
5479
5480 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5481 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5482
5483 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5484 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5485 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5486 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5487 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5488 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5489 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5490 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5491 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5492 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5493 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5494
5495
5496
5497 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5498 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5499 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5500 the line
5501 .code
5502 # primary_hostname =
5503 .endd
5504 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5505 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5506 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5507 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5508
5509 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5510 .code
5511 domainlist local_domains = @
5512 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5513 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5514 .endd
5515 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5516 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5517 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5518 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5519
5520 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5521 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5522 on the local host.
5523
5524 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5525 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5526 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5527 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5528 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5529 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5530
5531 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5532 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5533 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5534 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5535 domain is permitted.
5536
5537 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5538 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5539 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5540 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5541 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5542 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5543
5544 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5545 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5546 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5547
5548 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5549 .code
5550 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5551 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5552 .endd
5553 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5554 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5555 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5556 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5557 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5558 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5559 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5560 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5561 contents of a message to be checked.
5562
5563 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5564 .code
5565 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5566 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5567 .endd
5568 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5569 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5570 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5571 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5572
5573 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5574 .code
5575 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5576 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5577 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5578 .endd
5579 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5580 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5581 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5582 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5583 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5584 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5585 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5586
5587 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5588 .code
5589 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5590 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5591 .endd
5592 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5593 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5594 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5595 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5596 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5597 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5598 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5599 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5600 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5601 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5602 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5603 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5604 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5605 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5606 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5607 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5608 consequences).
5609 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5610 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5611 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5612 which should be used in preference to 587.
5613 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5614 these ports.
5615 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5616
5617 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5618 .code
5619 # qualify_domain =
5620 # qualify_recipient =
5621 .endd
5622 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5623 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5624 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5625 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5626 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5627 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5628
5629 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5630 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5631 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5632 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5633 .code
5634 # allow_domain_literals
5635 .endd
5636 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5637 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5638 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5639 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5640 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5641 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5642
5643 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5644 .code
5645 never_users = root
5646 .endd
5647 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5648 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5649 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5650 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5651 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5652 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5653 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5654 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5655
5656 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5657 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5658 line,
5659 .code
5660 host_lookup = *
5661 .endd
5662 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5663 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5664 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5665 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5666 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5667 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5668 unreachable.
5669
5670 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5671 1413 (hence their names):
5672 .code
5673 rfc1413_hosts = *
5674 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5675 .endd
5676 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5677 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5678 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5679 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5680 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5681 information, you can change this.
5682
5683 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5684 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5685 .code
5686 prdr_enable = true
5687 .endd
5688
5689 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5690 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5691 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5692 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5693 .code
5694 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5695 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5696 .endd
5697 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5698 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5699
5700 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5701 over the default:
5702 .code
5703 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5704 +tls_certificate_verified
5705 .endd
5706
5707 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5708 .code
5709 # percent_hack_domains =
5710 .endd
5711 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5712 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5713 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5714
5715 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5716 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5717 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5718 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5719 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5720 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5721 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5722 always bounce messages.
5723 .code
5724 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5725 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5726 .endd
5727 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5728 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5729 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5730 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5731 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5732
5733 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5734 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5735 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5736 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5737 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5738 not often needed).
5739 .code
5740 # split_spool_directory = true
5741 .endd
5742
5743 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5744 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5745 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5746 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5747 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5748 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5749 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5750 .code
5751 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5752 .endd
5753
5754 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5755 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5756 that are not 8-bit clean.
5757 .code
5758 # accept_8bitmime = false
5759 .endd
5760
5761 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5762 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5763 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5764 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5765 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5766 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5767 .code
5768 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5769 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5770 .endd
5771
5772
5773 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5774 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5775 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5776 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5777 It starts with the line
5778 .code
5779 begin acl
5780 .endd
5781 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5782 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5783 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5784
5785 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5786 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5787 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5788 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5789 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5790 result of the ACL processing.
5791 .code
5792 acl_check_rcpt:
5793 .endd
5794 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5795 ACL, and names it.
5796 .code
5797 accept hosts = :
5798 .endd
5799 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5800 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5801 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5802 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5803 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5804 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5805
5806 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5807 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5808 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5809 manner.
5810 .code
5811 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5812 domains = +local_domains
5813 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5814
5815 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5816 domains = !+local_domains
5817 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5818 .endd
5819 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5820 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5821 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5822 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5823 in Internet mail addresses.
5824
5825 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5826 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5827 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5828 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5829 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5830 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5831 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5832 policy of being as safe as possible.
5833
5834 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5835 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5836 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5837 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5838 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5839 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5840
5841 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5842 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5843 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5844 have to modify this rule.
5845
5846 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5847 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5848 common convention of local parts constructed as
5849 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5850 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5851 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5852 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5853 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5854 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5855
5856 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5857 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5858 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5859 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5860 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5861 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5862 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5863 .code
5864 accept local_parts = postmaster
5865 domains = +local_domains
5866 .endd
5867 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5868 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5869 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5870 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5871 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5872
5873 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5874 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5875 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5876 .code
5877 require verify = sender
5878 .endd
5879 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5880 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5881 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5882 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5883 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5884 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5885 discusses the details of address verification.
5886 .code
5887 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5888 control = submission
5889 .endd
5890 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5891 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5892 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5893 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5894 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5895 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5896 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5897 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5898 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5899 .code
5900 accept authenticated = *
5901 control = submission
5902 .endd
5903 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5904 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5905 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5906 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5907 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5908 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5909 .code
5910 require message = relay not permitted
5911 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5912 .endd
5913 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5914 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5915 .code
5916 require verify = recipient
5917 .endd
5918 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5919 fails, the address is rejected.
5920 .code
5921 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5922 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5923 # $dnslist_text
5924 # dnslists = black.list.example
5925 #
5926 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5927 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5928 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5929 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5930 .endd
5931 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5932 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5933 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5934 line.
5935 .code
5936 # require verify = csa
5937 .endd
5938 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5939 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5940 records.
5941 .code
5942 accept
5943 .endd
5944 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5945 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5946 .code
5947 acl_check_data:
5948 .endd
5949 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5950 of this ACL are commented out:
5951 .code
5952 # deny malware = *
5953 # message = This message contains a virus \
5954 # ($malware_name).
5955 .endd
5956 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5957 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5958 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5959 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5960 .code
5961 # warn spam = nobody
5962 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5963 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5964 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5965 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5966 .endd
5967 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5968 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5969 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5970 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5971 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5972 whatever the spam score.
5973 .code
5974 accept
5975 .endd
5976 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5977
5978
5979 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5980 .cindex "default" "routers"
5981 .cindex "routers" "default"
5982 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5983 by the line
5984 .code
5985 begin routers
5986 .endd
5987 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5988 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5989 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5990 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5991 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5992 .code
5993 # domain_literal:
5994 # driver = ipliteral
5995 # domains = !+local_domains
5996 # transport = remote_smtp
5997 .endd
5998 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5999 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6000 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6001 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6002 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6003 .code
6004 dnslookup:
6005 driver = dnslookup
6006 domains = ! +local_domains
6007 transport = remote_smtp
6008 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6009 no_more
6010 .endd
6011 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
6012 domains. This is specified by the line
6013 .code
6014 domains = ! +local_domains
6015 .endd
6016 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6017 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6018 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6019 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6020 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6021 passed on to the following routers.
6022
6023 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6024 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6025 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6026 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6027 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6028
6029 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6030 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6031 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6032 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6033 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6034 the address fails and is bounced.
6035
6036 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6037 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6038 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6039 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6040 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6041 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6042 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6043 out.
6044 .code
6045 system_aliases:
6046 driver = redirect
6047 allow_fail
6048 allow_defer
6049 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6050 # user = exim
6051 file_transport = address_file
6052 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6053 .endd
6054 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6055 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6056 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6057 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6058 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6059 the next router.
6060
6061 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6062 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6063 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6064 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6065 .code
6066 userforward:
6067 driver = redirect
6068 check_local_user
6069 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6070 # local_part_suffix_optional
6071 file = $home/.forward
6072 # allow_filter
6073 no_verify
6074 no_expn
6075 check_ancestor
6076 file_transport = address_file
6077 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6078 reply_transport = address_reply
6079 .endd
6080 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6081 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6082 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6083 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6084 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6085 namely:
6086 .code
6087 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6088 # local_part_suffix_optional
6089 .endd
6090 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6091 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6092 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6093 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6094 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6095 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6096 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6097
6098 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6099 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6100 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6101 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6102
6103 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6104 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6105 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6106 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6107 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6108 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6109 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6110
6111 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6112 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6113 There are two reasons for doing this:
6114
6115 .olist
6116 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6117 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6118 unnecessary work.
6119 .next
6120 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6121 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6122 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6123 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6124 this time.
6125 .endlist
6126
6127 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6128 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6129 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6130 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6131
6132 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6133 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6134 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6135 .code
6136 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6137 .endd
6138 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6139 transport.
6140 .code
6141 localuser:
6142 driver = accept
6143 check_local_user
6144 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6145 # local_part_suffix_optional
6146 transport = local_delivery
6147 .endd
6148 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6149 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6150 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6151 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6152 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6153
6154
6155 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6156 .cindex "default" "transports"
6157 .cindex "transports" "default"
6158 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6159 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6160 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6161 .code
6162 begin transports
6163 .endd
6164 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6165 .code
6166 remote_smtp:
6167 driver = smtp
6168 hosts_try_prdr = *
6169 .endd
6170 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6171 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6172 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6173 It is negotiated between client and server
6174 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6175 All other options are defaulted.
6176 .code
6177 local_delivery:
6178 driver = appendfile
6179 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6180 delivery_date_add
6181 envelope_to_add
6182 return_path_add
6183 # group = mail
6184 # mode = 0660
6185 .endd
6186 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6187 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6188 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6189 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6190 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6191 show how this can be done.
6192
6193 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6194 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6195 similarly-named options above.
6196 .code
6197 address_pipe:
6198 driver = pipe
6199 return_output
6200 .endd
6201 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6202 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6203 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6204 be returned to the sender.
6205 .code
6206 address_file:
6207 driver = appendfile
6208 delivery_date_add
6209 envelope_to_add
6210 return_path_add
6211 .endd
6212 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6213 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6214 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6215 .code
6216 address_reply:
6217 driver = autoreply
6218 .endd
6219 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6220 filter files.
6221
6222
6223
6224 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6225 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6226 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6227 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6228 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6229 introduced by the line
6230 .code
6231 begin retry
6232 .endd
6233 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6234 errors:
6235 .code
6236 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6237 .endd
6238 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6239 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6240 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6241 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6242 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6243
6244 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6245 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6246 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6247
6248
6249 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6250 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6251 .code
6252 begin rewrite
6253 .endd
6254 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6255 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6256
6257
6258
6259 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6260 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6261 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6262 .code
6263 begin authenticators
6264 .endd
6265 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6266 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6267 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6268 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6269 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6270 to support most MUA software.
6271
6272 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6273 .code
6274 #PLAIN:
6275 # driver = plaintext
6276 # server_set_id = $auth2
6277 # server_prompts = :
6278 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6279 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6280 .endd
6281 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6282 .code
6283 #LOGIN:
6284 # driver = plaintext
6285 # server_set_id = $auth1
6286 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6287 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6288 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6289 .endd
6290
6291 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6292 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6293 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6294 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6295 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6296 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6297 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6298 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6299
6300 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6301 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6302 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6303 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6304
6305 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6306 usercode and password are in different positions.
6307 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6308
6309 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6310
6311
6312
6313 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6314 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6315
6316 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6317
6318 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6319 .cindex "PCRE"
6320 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6321 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6322 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6323 regular expressions is discussed in
6324 online Perl manpages, in
6325 many Perl reference books, and also in
6326 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6327 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6328
6329 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6330 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6331 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6332 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6333 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6334 case-insensitive.
6335
6336 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6337 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6338 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6339 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6340 .code
6341 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6342 .endd
6343 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6344 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6345 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6346 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6347 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6348 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6349 matched.
6350
6351 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6352 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6353 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6354 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6355 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6356 match anywhere in the subject string.
6357
6358 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6359 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6360 .code
6361 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6362 .endd
6363 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6364 You need to use:
6365 .code
6366 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6367 .endd
6368 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6369 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6370
6371
6372
6373 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6374 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6375
6376 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6377 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6378 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6379 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6380 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6381 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6382
6383 .olist
6384 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6385 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6386 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6387 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6388 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6389 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6390 .next
6391 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6392 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6393 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6394 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6395 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6396 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6397 .endlist
6398
6399 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6400 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6401 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6402 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6403 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6404 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6405
6406 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6407 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6408 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6409 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6410 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6411 .code
6412 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6413 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6414 .endd
6415 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6416 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6417 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6418 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6419 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6420 .code
6421 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6422 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6423 .endd
6424 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6425 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6426
6427 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6428 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6429 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6430 .code
6431 domain1:
6432 domain2:
6433 .endd
6434 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6435 matches the list item.
6436
6437 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6438 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6439 .code
6440 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6441 .endd
6442 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6443 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6444 causes a second lookup to occur.
6445
6446 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6447 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6448 lookup is permitted.
6449
6450
6451 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6452 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6453 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6454 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6455
6456 .ilist
6457 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6458 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6459 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6460 .next
6461 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6462 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6463 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6464 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6465 .endlist
6466
6467 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6468 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6469 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6470 .code
6471 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6472 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6473 .endd
6474 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6475 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6476 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6477
6478
6479
6480
6481 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6482 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6483 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6484 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6485
6486 .ilist
6487 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6488 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6489 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6490 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6491 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6492 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6493 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6494 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6495 be found in several places:
6496 .display
6497 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6498 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6499 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6500 .endd
6501 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6502 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6503 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6504 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6505 .next
6506 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6507 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6508 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6509 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6510 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6511 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6512 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6513
6514 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6515 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6516 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6517 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6518 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6519 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6520 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6521 .next
6522 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6523 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6524 .cindex "sasldb2"
6525 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6526 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6527 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6528 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6529 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6530 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6531 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6532 .next
6533 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6534 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6535 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6536 .cindex "Courier"
6537 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6538 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6539 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6540 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6541 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6542 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6543 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6544 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6545 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6546 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6547 .next
6548 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6549 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6550 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6551 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6552 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6553 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6554 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6555 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6556 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6557 .next
6558 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6559 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6560 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6561 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6562 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6563 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6564 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6565 .code
6566 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6567 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6568 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6569 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6570 .endd
6571 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6572 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6573 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6574 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6575 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6576
6577 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6578 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6579 lookup types support only literal keys.
6580
6581 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6582 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6583 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6584 .next
6585 .cindex "linear search"
6586 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6587 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6588 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6589 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6590 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6591 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6592 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6593 in the file is used.
6594
6595 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6596 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6597 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6598 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6599 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6600 colon, for example:
6601 .code
6602 baduser: :fail:
6603 .endd
6604 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6605 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6606 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6607 wildcarding of any kind.
6608
6609 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6610 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6611 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6612 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6613 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6614 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6615 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6616 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6617 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6618
6619 .next
6620 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6621 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6622 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6623 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6624 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6625 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6626 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6627 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6628
6629 .next
6630 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6631 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6632 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6633 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6634 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6635 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6636 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6637 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6638 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6639
6640 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6641 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6642 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6643 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6644
6645 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6646 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6647
6648 .olist
6649 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6650 .code
6651 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6652 *fish data for anythingfish
6653 .endd
6654 .next
6655 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6656 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6657 .code
6658 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6659 .endd
6660 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6661 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6662 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6663 .code
6664 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6665 .endd
6666 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6667 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6668 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6669 .code
6670 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6671 .endd
6672
6673 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6674 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6675 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6676 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6677 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6678
6679 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6680 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6681 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6682 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6683 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6684
6685 .next
6686 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6687 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6688 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6689 example:
6690 .code
6691 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6692 .endd
6693 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6694 .endlist olist
6695
6696 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6697 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6698 be followed by optional colons.
6699
6700 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6701 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6702 lookup types support only literal keys.
6703 .endlist ilist
6704
6705
6706 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6707 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6708 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6709 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6710 many of them are given in later sections.
6711
6712 .ilist
6713 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6714 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6715 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6716 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6717 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6718 .next
6719 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6720 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6721 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6722 .next
6723 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6724 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6725 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6726 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6727 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6728 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6729 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6730 .next
6731 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6732 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6733 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6734 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6735 .next
6736 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6737 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6738 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6739 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6740 .next
6741 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6742 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6743 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6744 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6745 .next
6746 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6747 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6748 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6749 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6750 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6751 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6752 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6753 password value. For example:
6754 .code
6755 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6756 .endd
6757 .next
6758 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6759 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6760 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6761 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6762
6763 .next
6764 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
6765 .cindex lookup Redis
6766 &(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6767 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6768
6769 .next
6770 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6771 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6772 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6773 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6774
6775 .next
6776 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6777 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6778 .next
6779 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6780 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6781 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6782 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6783 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6784 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6785 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6786 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6787 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6788 .code
6789 require condition = \
6790 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6791 .endd
6792 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6793 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6794 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6795 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6796 .endlist
6797
6798
6799
6800 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6801 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6802 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6803 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6804 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6805 options such as a list of local domains.
6806
6807 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6808 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6809 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6810 or may give up altogether.
6811
6812
6813
6814 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6815 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6816 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6817 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6818 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6819 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6820 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6821 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6822
6823 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6824 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6825 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6826
6827 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6828 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6829 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6830
6831 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6832 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6833 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6834 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6835 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6836 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6837 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6838 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6839 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6840 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6841 .code
6842 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6843 .endd
6844 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6845 looks up these keys, in this order:
6846 .code
6847 jane@eyre.example
6848 *@eyre.example
6849 *
6850 .endd
6851 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6852 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6853 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6854 Exim move on to try the next key.
6855
6856
6857
6858 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6859 .cindex "partial matching"
6860 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6861 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6862 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6863 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6864 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6865 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6866 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6867 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6868 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6869 a key in a DBM file is
6870 .code
6871 *.dates.fict.example
6872 .endd
6873 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6874 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6875 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6876 file.
6877
6878 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6879 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6880 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6881
6882 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6883 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6884 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6885 partial matching keys
6886 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6887 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6888 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6889
6890 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6891 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6892 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6893 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6894 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6895 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6896 remains.
6897
6898 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6899 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6900 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6901 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6902 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6903 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6904 .code
6905 2250.dates.fict.example
6906 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6907 *.dates.fict.example
6908 *.fict.example
6909 .endd
6910 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6911 finishes.
6912
6913 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6914 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6915 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6916 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6917 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6918 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6919 .code
6920 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6921 .endd
6922 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6923 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6924 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6925 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6926 .code
6927 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6928 .endd
6929 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6930 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6931
6932 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6933 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6934 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6935
6936 .ilist
6937 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6938 .next
6939 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6940 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6941 .next
6942 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6943 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6944 for &"*"& on its own.
6945 .next
6946 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6947 .endlist
6948
6949
6950 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6951 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6952 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6953 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6954 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6955 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6956 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6957
6958 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6959 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6960 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6961 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6962 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6963
6964
6965
6966
6967 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6968 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6969 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6970 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6971 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6972 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6973 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6974
6975 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6976 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6977 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6978 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6979 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6980 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6981
6982 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6983 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6984 complete.
6985
6986
6987
6988
6989 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6990 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6991 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6992 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6993 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6994 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6995 .code
6996 [name=$local_part]
6997 .endd
6998 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6999 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7000 .code
7001 [name="$local_part"]
7002 .endd
7003 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7004 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7005 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7006 of the following form is provided:
7007 .code
7008 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7009 .endd
7010 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7011 .code
7012 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7013 .endd
7014 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7015 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7016 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7017
7018
7019
7020
7021 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7022 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7023 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7024 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7025 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7026 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7027 an expansion string could contain:
7028 .code
7029 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7030 .endd
7031 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7032 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7033 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7034 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7035
7036 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7037 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7038 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7039
7040 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7041 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7042 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7043 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7044 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7045 .code
7046 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7047 .endd
7048 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7049 white space is ignored.
7050 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7051 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7052 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7053
7054 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7055 When the type is PTR,
7056 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7057 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7058 .code
7059 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7060 .endd
7061 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7062 altered and nothing is added.
7063
7064 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7065 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7066 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7067 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7068 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7069 The field separator can be modified as above.
7070
7071 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7072 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7073 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7074 unless a field separator is specified.
7075 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7076 For SPF records the
7077 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7078 .code
7079 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7080 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7081 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7082 .endd
7083 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7084 white space is ignored.
7085
7086 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7087 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7088 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7089 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7090 specified.
7091 .code
7092 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7093 .endd
7094
7095 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7096 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7097 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7098 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7099 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7100 each followed by a comma,
7101 that may appear before the record type.
7102
7103 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7104 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7105 a defer-option modifier.
7106 The possible keywords are
7107 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7108 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7109 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7110 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7111 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7112 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7113 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7114 .code
7115 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7116 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7117 .endd
7118 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7119 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7120
7121 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7122 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7123 The possible keywords are
7124 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7125 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7126 with the lookup.
7127 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7128 is not labelled as authenticated data
7129 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7130 The default is &"never"&.
7131
7132 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7133
7134 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7135 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7136 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7137 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7138 (e.g. &"5s"&).
7139 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7140
7141 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7142 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7143 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7144
7145 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7146 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7147 .cindex DNS TTL
7148 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7149 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7150 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7151
7152
7153 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7154 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7155 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7156 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7157 the pseudo-type MXH:
7158 .code
7159 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7160 .endd
7161 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7162 returned.
7163
7164 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7165 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7166 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7167 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7168 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7169 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7170 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7171 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7172 .code
7173 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7174 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7175 .endd
7176 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7177 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7178 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7179
7180 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7181 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7182 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7183 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7184 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7185 such a list.
7186
7187 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7188 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7189 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7190 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7191 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7192 result of a successful lookup such as:
7193 .code
7194 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7195 .endd
7196 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7197 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7198 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7199
7200 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7201 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7202 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7203 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7204 .code
7205 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7206 .endd
7207
7208
7209 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7210 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7211 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7212 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7213 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7214 .code
7215 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7216 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7217 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7218 .endd
7219 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7220 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7221 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7222 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7223
7224 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7225 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7226 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7227
7228
7229
7230
7231 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7232 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7233 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7234 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7235 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7236 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7237 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7238 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7239 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7240 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7241 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7242 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7243 .code
7244 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7245 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7246 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7247 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7248 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7249 .endd
7250 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7251 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7252
7253 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7254 the way they handle the results of a query:
7255
7256 .ilist
7257 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7258 gives an error.
7259 .next
7260 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7261 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7262 .next
7263 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7264 from all of them are returned.
7265 .endlist
7266
7267
7268 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7269 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7270 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7271 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7272
7273
7274 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7275 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7276 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7277 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7278 .code
7279 data = ${lookup ldap \
7280 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7281 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7282 .endd
7283 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7284 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7285 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7286 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7287
7288 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7289 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7290 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7291
7292 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7293 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7294 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7295 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7296 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7297 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7298 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7299 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7300 &_exim.conf_&.
7301
7302
7303 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7304 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7305 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7306 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7307 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7308 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7309
7310 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7311 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7312 the string:
7313 .code
7314 * => \2A
7315 ( => \28
7316 ) => \29
7317 \ => \5C
7318 .endd
7319 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7320 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7321 .code
7322 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7323 .endd
7324 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7325 .code
7326 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7327 .endd
7328 yields
7329 .code
7330 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7331 .endd
7332 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7333 .code
7334 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7335 .endd
7336 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7337 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7338 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7339 .code
7340 , + " \ < > ;
7341 .endd
7342 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7343 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7344 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7345 .code
7346 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7347 .endd
7348 yields
7349 .code
7350 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7351 .endd
7352 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7353 .code
7354 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7355 .endd
7356 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7357 authentication below.
7358
7359
7360 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7361 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7362 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7363 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7364 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7365 by starting it with
7366 .code
7367 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7368 .endd
7369 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7370 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7371 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7372 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7373 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7374 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7375 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7376 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7377 failures, and timeouts.
7378
7379 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7380 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7381 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7382 doubled. For example
7383 .code
7384 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7385 .endd
7386 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7387 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7388 the local host) is used.
7389
7390 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7391 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7392 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7393 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7394 not available.
7395
7396 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7397 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7398 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7399 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7400 .code
7401 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7402 .endd
7403 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7404 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7405 .code
7406 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7407 .endd
7408 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7409 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7410 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7411 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7412 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7413 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7414 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7415 backup host.
7416
7417 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7418 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7419 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7420
7421 .ilist
7422 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7423 interface.
7424 .next
7425 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7426 .endlist
7427
7428
7429 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7430 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7431
7432
7433
7434 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7435 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7436 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7437 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7438 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7439 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7440 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7441 them. The following names are recognized:
7442 .display
7443 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7444 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7445 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7446 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7447 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7448 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7449 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7450 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7451 .endd
7452 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7453 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7454 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7455 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7456
7457 .cindex LDAP timeout
7458 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7459 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7460 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7461 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7462 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7463 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7464 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7465 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7466 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7467 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7468
7469 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7470 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7471
7472 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7473 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7474 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7475 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7476 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7477 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7478 alternate list (colon-separated).
7479
7480 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7481 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7482 .code
7483 ${lookup ldap
7484 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7485 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7486 {$value}fail}
7487 .endd
7488 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7489 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7490 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7491 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7492
7493 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7494 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7495 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7496
7497 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7498 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7499 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7500 quoting has two advantages:
7501
7502 .ilist
7503 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7504 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7505 .next
7506 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7507 .endlist
7508
7509 For example, a setting such as
7510 .code
7511 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7512 .endd
7513 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7514
7515 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7516 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7517 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7518 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7519 .code
7520 PASS=${quote:$3}
7521 .endd
7522 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7523 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7524 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7525
7526
7527
7528 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7529 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7530 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7531 as a sequence of values, for example
7532 .code
7533 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7534 .endd
7535 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7536 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7537 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7538 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7539 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7540 directory.
7541
7542 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7543 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7544 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7545 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7546
7547 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7548 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7549 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7550 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7551 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7552 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7553 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7554 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7555 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7556
7557 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7558 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7559 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7560 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7561 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7562
7563 .code
7564 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7565 value1.1,value1,,2
7566
7567 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7568 value two
7569
7570 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7571 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7572
7573 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7574 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7575
7576 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7577 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7578 .endd
7579 You can
7580 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7581 results of LDAP lookups.
7582 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7583 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7584 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7585 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7586 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7587 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7588
7589
7590
7591
7592 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7593 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7594 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7595 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7596 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7597 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7598 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7599 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7600 .code
7601 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7602 .endd
7603 might return the string
7604 .code
7605 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7606 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7607 .endd
7608 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7609 .code
7610 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7611 .endd
7612 would just return
7613 .code
7614 Martin Guerre
7615 .endd
7616 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7617 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7618 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7619
7620
7621
7622 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7623 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7624 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7625 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7626 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7627 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7628 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7629 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7630 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7631 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7632 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7633 .cindex lookup Redis
7634 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7635 and SQLite
7636 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7637 might be
7638 .code
7639 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7640 {$value}fail}
7641 .endd
7642 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7643 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7644 .code
7645 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7646 {$value}}
7647 .endd
7648 might be
7649 .code
7650 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7651 .endd
7652 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7653 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7654 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7655 .code
7656 Mister X
7657 .endd
7658 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7659 with a newline between the data for each row.
7660
7661
7662 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7663 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7664 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7665 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7666 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7667 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7668 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7669 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7670 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7671 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7672 .cindex lookup Redis
7673 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7674 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7675 or &%redis_servers%&
7676 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7677 information.
7678 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7679 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7680 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7681 For all but Redis
7682 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7683 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7684 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7685 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7686 .code
7687 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7688 .endd
7689 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7690 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7691 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7692 .code
7693 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7694 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7695 .endd
7696 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7697 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7698 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7699 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7700 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7701 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7702
7703 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7704 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7705 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7706 information.
7707 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7708 host, database number, and password.
7709 .olist
7710 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7711 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7712 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7713 .next
7714 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7715 .next
7716 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7717 .endlist
7718
7719 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7720 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7721 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7722 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7723
7724 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7725 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7726
7727 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7728 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7729 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7730 done by starting the query with
7731 .display
7732 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7733 .endd
7734 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7735 .olist
7736 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7737 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7738 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7739 taken from there.
7740 .next
7741 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7742 .endlist
7743 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7744 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7745 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7746
7747 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7748 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7749 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7750 like this:
7751 .code
7752 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7753 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7754 master/db/name/pw
7755 .endd
7756 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7757 .code
7758 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7759 .endd
7760 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7761 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7762 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7763 .code
7764 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7765 .endd
7766
7767
7768 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7769 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7770 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7771 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7772 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7773 the default value is &"exim"&.
7774 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7775 .display
7776 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7777 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7778 .endd
7779 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7780 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7781
7782 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7783 the queries.
7784
7785 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7786 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7787
7788 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7789 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7790 is zero because no rows are affected.
7791
7792
7793 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7794 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7795 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7796 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7797 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7798 looks like this:
7799 .code
7800 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7801 .endd
7802 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7803 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7804 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7805
7806 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7807 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7808 affected.
7809
7810 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7811 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7812 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7813 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7814 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7815 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7816 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7817 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7818 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7819 .code
7820 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7821 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7822 .endd
7823 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7824 .code
7825 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7826 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7827 .endd
7828 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7829 quote, which it doubles.
7830
7831 .cindex timeout SQLite
7832 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
7833 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7834 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7835 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7836 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7837 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7838 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7839 option.
7840
7841 .section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
7842 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
7843 .cindex "redis lookup type"
7844 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
7845 Examples:
7846 .code
7847 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
7848 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
7849 .endd
7850
7851 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
7852 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
7853 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
7854 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
7855 servers.
7856
7857 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
7858 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
7859 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
7860 reached.
7861
7862 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7863 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7864
7865
7866 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7867 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7868
7869 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7870 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7871 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7872 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7873 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7874 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7875 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7876 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7877 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7878
7879 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7880 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7881 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7882 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7883
7884 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7885 support all the complexity available in
7886 domain, host, address and local part lists.
7887
7888
7889
7890 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
7891 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7892 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
7893
7894 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
7895 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
7896
7897 The result of
7898 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7899 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7900 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7901 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7902 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7903
7904
7905 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7906 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7907 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7908
7909 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7910 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7911 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7912 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7913 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7914 .code
7915 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7916 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7917 .endd
7918 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7919 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7920 senders based on the receiving domain.
7921
7922
7923
7924
7925 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7926 .cindex "list" "negation"
7927 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7928 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7929 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7930 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7931 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7932 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7933
7934 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7935 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7936 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7937 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7938 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7939 .code
7940 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7941 .endd
7942 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7943 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7944 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7945 .code
7946 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7947 .endd
7948 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7949 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7950 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7951
7952 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7953 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7954 item.
7955
7956
7957
7958 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7959 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7960 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7961 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7962 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7963 file names are not allowed,
7964 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7965 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7966 lines:
7967
7968 .ilist
7969 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7970 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7971 .next
7972 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7973 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7974 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7975 .code
7976 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7977 .endd
7978 .endlist
7979
7980 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7981 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7982 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7983 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7984
7985 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7986 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7987 .code
7988 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7989 .endd
7990 and the file contains the lines
7991 .code
7992 !a.b.c
7993 *.b.c
7994 .endd
7995 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7996 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7997
7998
7999
8000 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
8001 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8002 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8003 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8004 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8005 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8006 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8007 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8008
8009 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8010 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
8011 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8012 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8013
8014
8015
8016
8017 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8018 .cindex "named lists"
8019 .cindex "list" "named"
8020 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8021 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8022 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8023 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8024 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8025 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8026 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8027 .code
8028 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8029 .endd
8030 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8031 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8032 configured with the line
8033 .code
8034 domains = +local_domains
8035 .endd
8036 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8037 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8038 .code
8039 dnslookup:
8040 driver = dnslookup
8041 domains = ! +local_domains
8042 transport = remote_smtp
8043 no_more
8044 .endd
8045 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8046 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8047 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8048 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8049 .code
8050 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8051 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8052 .endd
8053 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8054 .code
8055 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8056 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8057 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8058 .endd
8059 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8060 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8061 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8062 .code
8063 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8064 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8065 .endd
8066 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8067 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8068 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8069 .code
8070 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8071 .endd
8072 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8073 referenced lists if you can.
8074
8075 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8076 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8077 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8078 .code
8079 domains = +local_domains
8080 .endd
8081 on several of your routers
8082 or in several ACL statements,
8083 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8084 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8085 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8086 the same each time they are referenced.
8087
8088 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8089 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8090 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8091 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8092
8093
8094
8095 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8096 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8097 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8098 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8099 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8100 write
8101 .code
8102 ALIST = host1 : host2
8103 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8104 .endd
8105 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8106 .code
8107 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8108 .endd
8109 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8110 list, and write
8111 .code
8112 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8113 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8114 .endd
8115 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8116 .code
8117 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8118 .endd
8119
8120
8121 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8122 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8123 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8124 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8125 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8126 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8127 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8128 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8129 message. For example:
8130 .code
8131 domainlist special_domains = \
8132 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8133 .endd
8134 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8135 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8136 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8137 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8138 same list each time.
8139
8140 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8141 cache the result anyway. For example:
8142 .code
8143 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8144 .endd
8145 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8146 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8147
8148
8149
8150 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8151 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8152 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8153 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8154 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8155
8156 .ilist
8157 .cindex "primary host name"
8158 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8159 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8160 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8161 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8162 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8163 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8164 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8165 differ only in their names.
8166 .next
8167 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8168 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8169 .cindex "domain literal"
8170 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8171 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8172 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8173 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8174 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8175 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8176 .next
8177 .cindex "@mx_any"
8178 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8179 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8180 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8181 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8182 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8183 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8184 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8185 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8186 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8187 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8188 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8189
8190 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8191 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8192 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8193 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8194 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8195
8196 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8197 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8198 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8199 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8200 on a router). For example:
8201 .code
8202 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8203 .endd
8204 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8205 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8206
8207 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8208 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8209 contain negative items.
8210
8211 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8212 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8213 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8214 .code
8215 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8216 an.other.domain : ...
8217 .endd
8218 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8219 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8220 .code
8221 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8222 an.other.domain ? ...
8223 .endd
8224 .next
8225 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8226 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8227 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8228 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8229 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8230 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8231 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8232 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8233 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8234 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
8235
8236 .next
8237 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8238 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8239 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8240 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8241 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8242 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8243 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8244 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8245 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8246
8247 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8248 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8249 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8250 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8251 expression by expansion, of course).
8252 .next
8253 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8254 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8255 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8256 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8257 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8258 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8259 .code
8260 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8261 .endd
8262 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8263 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8264 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8265 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8266 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8267 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8268 other statements in the same ACL.
8269
8270 .next
8271 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8272 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8273 .code
8274 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8275 .endd
8276 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8277 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8278
8279 .next
8280 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8281 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8282 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8283 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8284 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8285 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8286 expansion variable.
8287 .next
8288 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8289 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8290 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8291 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8292 .code
8293 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8294 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8295 .endd
8296 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8297 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8298 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8299 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8300 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8301 .next
8302 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8303 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8304 between the pattern and the domain.
8305 .endlist
8306
8307 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8308 .code
8309 domainlist funny_domains = \
8310 @ : \
8311 lib.unseen.edu : \
8312 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8313 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8314 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8315 nis;domains.byname : \
8316 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8317 .endd
8318 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8319 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8320 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8321 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8322 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8323 patterns earlier.
8324
8325
8326
8327 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8328 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8329 .cindex "list" "host list"
8330 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8331 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8332 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8333 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8334 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8335 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8336 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8337
8338
8339 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8340 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8341 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8342 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8343 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8344 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8345 not used.
8346
8347 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8348 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8349 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8350
8351
8352
8353 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8354 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8355 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8356 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8357 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8358 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8359 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8360 concerns.)
8361
8362 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8363 inspecting its IP address:
8364
8365 .ilist
8366 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8367 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8368 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8369 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8370 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8371 with the IP address of the subject host.
8372
8373 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8374 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8375 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8376 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8377 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8378
8379 .next
8380 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8381 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8382 domain name, as just described.
8383
8384 .next
8385 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8386 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8387 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8388 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8389 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8390 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8391 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8392 that can never match a client host.
8393
8394 .next
8395 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8396 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8397 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8398 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8399 .code
8400 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8401 accept hosts = @[]
8402 .endd
8403 .next
8404 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8405 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8406 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8407 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8408 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8409 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8410 significant end of the address.
8411
8412 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8413 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8414 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8415 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8416 .code
8417 192.168.23.236/31
8418 .endd
8419 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8420 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8421 matches.
8422
8423 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8424 .code
8425 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8426 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8427 .endd
8428 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8429 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8430 For example:
8431 .code
8432 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8433 .endd
8434 could make use of a file containing
8435 .code
8436 172.16.0.0/12
8437 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8438 .endd
8439 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8440 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8441 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8442 .code
8443 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8444 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8445 .endd
8446 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8447 list.
8448 .endlist
8449
8450
8451
8452 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8453 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8454 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8455 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8456 address, the pattern takes this form:
8457 .display
8458 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8459 .endd
8460 For example:
8461 .code
8462 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8463 .endd
8464 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8465 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8466 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8467 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8468 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8469 returned by the lookup is not used.
8470
8471 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8472 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8473 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8474 patterns of this form:
8475 .display
8476 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8477 .endd
8478 For example:
8479 .code
8480 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8481 .endd
8482 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8483 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8484 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8485 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8486 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8487
8488 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8489 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8490 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8491 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8492 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8493 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8494 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8495 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8496 addresses are always used.
8497
8498 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8499 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8500 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8501 configurations.
8502
8503 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8504 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8505 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8506 case the IP address is used on its own.
8507
8508
8509
8510 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8511 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8512 .cindex "unknown host name"
8513 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8514 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8515 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8516 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8517 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8518 above.)
8519
8520 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8521 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8522 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8523 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8524 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8525 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8526 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8527
8528 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8529 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8530
8531 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8532 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8533 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8534 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8535 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8536 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8537 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8538 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8539 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8540
8541 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8542 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8543
8544 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8545 .cindex "alias for host"
8546 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8547 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8548
8549 .ilist
8550 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8551 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8552 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8553 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8554 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8555 expression.
8556 .next
8557 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8558 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8559 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8560 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8561 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8562 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8563 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8564 example,
8565 .code
8566 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8567 .endd
8568 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8569 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8570 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8571 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8572 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8573 .code
8574 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8575 .endd
8576 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8577 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8578 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8579 required.
8580 .endlist
8581
8582
8583
8584
8585 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8586 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8587 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8588 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8589 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8590 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8591
8592 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8593 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8594
8595 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8596 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8597 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8598 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8599 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8600 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8601 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8602 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8603 not recognized in an indirected file).
8604
8605 .ilist
8606 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8607 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8608 .code
8609 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8610 .endd
8611 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8612 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8613
8614 .next
8615 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8616 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8617 example:
8618 .code
8619 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8620 192.168.4.5
8621 .endd
8622 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8623 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8624 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8625 .endlist
8626
8627 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8628 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8629 list.
8630
8631 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8632 "SECTmixwilhos"
8633 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8634
8635 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8636 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8637 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8638
8639 .ilist
8640 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8641 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8642 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8643 .code
8644 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8645 .endd
8646 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8647 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8648 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8649 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8650 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8651 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8652 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8653
8654 .next
8655 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8656 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8657 .code
8658 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8659 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8660 .endd
8661 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8662 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8663 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8664 this section.
8665 .endlist
8666
8667
8668 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8669 "SECTtemdnserr"
8670 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8671 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8672 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8673 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8674 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8675 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8676 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8677 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8678 host lists such as whitelists.
8679
8680
8681
8682 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8683 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8684 .cindex "unknown host name"
8685 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8686 If a pattern is of the form
8687 .display
8688 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8689 .endd
8690 for example
8691 .code
8692 dbm;/host/accept/list
8693 .endd
8694 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8695 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8696 is not used.
8697
8698 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8699 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8700 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8701 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8702 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8703 lookup, both using the same file.
8704
8705
8706
8707 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8708 If a pattern is of the form
8709 .display
8710 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8711 .endd
8712 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8713 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8714 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8715 .code
8716 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8717 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8718 .endd
8719 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8720 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8721 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8722 operator.
8723
8724 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8725 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8726 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8727
8728 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8729 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8730 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8731 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8732 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8733 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8734
8735
8736
8737
8738
8739 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8740 .cindex "list" "address list"
8741 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8742 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8743 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8744 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8745 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8746 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8747 using this option setting:
8748 .code
8749 senders = :
8750 .endd
8751 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8752 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8753 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8754 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8755
8756 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8757 example:
8758 .code
8759 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8760 .endd
8761 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8762 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8763 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8764 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8765 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8766 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8767 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8768 .code
8769 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8770 *@+hostile_domains:\
8771 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8772 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8773 .endd
8774 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8775 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8776 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8777 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8778 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8779
8780 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8781 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8782 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8783 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8784 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8785 .code
8786 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8787 .endd
8788
8789 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8790 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8791 senders:
8792
8793 .ilist
8794 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8795 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8796 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8797 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8798 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8799 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8800 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8801 .code
8802 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8803 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8804 .endd
8805 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8806 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8807
8808 .next
8809 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8810 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8811 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8812 example:
8813 .code
8814 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8815 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8816 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8817 .endd
8818 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8819 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8820 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8821 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8822
8823 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8824 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8825 panic log.
8826 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8827 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8828 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8829 default. For example, with this lookup:
8830 .code
8831 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8832 .endd
8833 the file could contains lines like this:
8834 .code
8835 user1@domain1.example
8836 *@domain2.example
8837 .endd
8838 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8839 that are tried is:
8840 .code
8841 nimrod@jaeger.example
8842 *@jaeger.example
8843 *
8844 .endd
8845 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8846 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8847
8848 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8849 .code
8850 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8851 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8852 .endd
8853 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8854 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8855 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8856 .endlist
8857
8858
8859 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8860 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8861 always fails.
8862
8863
8864 .ilist
8865 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8866 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8867 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8868 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8869 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8870 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8871 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8872 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8873 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8874
8875 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8876 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8877 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8878 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8879 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8880 with
8881 .code
8882 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8883 .endd
8884 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8885 .code
8886 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8887 .endd
8888 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8889
8890 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8891 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8892 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8893 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8894 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8895 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8896 .code
8897 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8898 spammer3 : spammer4
8899 .endd
8900 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8901 doubling.
8902
8903 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8904 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8905 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8906 might have entries like
8907 .code
8908 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8909 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8910 *: ^\d{8}$
8911 .endd
8912 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8913 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8914 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8915 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8916
8917 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8918 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8919 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8920
8921 .next
8922 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8923 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8924 can only return a single list of local parts.
8925 .endlist
8926
8927 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8928 in these two examples:
8929 .code
8930 senders = +my_list
8931 senders = *@+my_list
8932 .endd
8933 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8934 example it is a named domain list.
8935
8936
8937
8938
8939 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8940 .cindex "case of local parts"
8941 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8942 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8943 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8944 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8945 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8946 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8947 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8948 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8949 default.
8950
8951 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8952 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8953 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8954 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8955 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8956 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8957 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8958 case-independent.
8959
8960 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8961 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8962 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8963 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8964 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8965 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8966 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8967 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8968
8969
8970
8971 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8972 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8973 .cindex "local part" "list"
8974 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8975 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8976 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8977 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8978 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8979 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8980 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8981 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8982
8983 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8984 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8985 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8986 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8987 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8988 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8989 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8990 types.
8991 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8992
8993
8994
8995
8996 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8997 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8998
8999 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9000 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9001 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9002 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9003
9004 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9005 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9006 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9007 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9008 escape character, as described in the following section.
9009
9010 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9011 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9012 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
9013 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9014 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9015 reasons.
9016
9017
9018
9019 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9020 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9021 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9022 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9023 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9024 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9025 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9026 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9027
9028 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9029 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9030 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9031 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9032 .code
9033 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9034 .endd
9035 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9036 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9037 string.
9038
9039
9040
9041 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9042 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9043 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9044 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9045 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9046 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9047 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9048 encoding.
9049
9050 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9051 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9052 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9053
9054
9055 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9056 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9057 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9058 .oindex "&%-be%&"
9059 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9060 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9061 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9062 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9063 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9064 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9065 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9066 and &%nhash%&.
9067
9068 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9069 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9070 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9071
9072 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
9073 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9074 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9075 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
9076 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9077 .code
9078 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9079 .endd
9080 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9081 Exim message identifier. For example:
9082 .code
9083 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9084 .endd
9085 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9086 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9087
9088
9089 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9090 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9091 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9092 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9093 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9094 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9095 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9096 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9097 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9098 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9099 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9100 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9101 being expanded.
9102
9103
9104
9105
9106 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9107 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9108 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9109 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9110 white space is significant.
9111
9112 .vlist
9113 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9114 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9115 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9116 .code
9117 $local_part
9118 ${domain}
9119 .endd
9120 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9121 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9122 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9123 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9124 given, the expansion fails.
9125
9126 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9127 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9128 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9129 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9130 .code
9131 ${lc:$local_part}
9132 .endd
9133 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9134 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9135 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9136 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9137 string easier to understand.
9138
9139 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9140 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9141 expansion item below.
9142
9143
9144 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9145 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9146 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9147 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9148 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9149 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9150 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9151 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9152 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9153 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9154 the result of the expansion.
9155 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9156 the expansion result is an empty string.
9157 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9158
9159
9160 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9161 .cindex authentication "results header"
9162 .cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9163 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9164 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9165 &'Authentication-Results"'&
9166 header line.
9167 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9168 will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9169 Methods that might be present in the result include:
9170 .code
9171 none
9172 iprev
9173 auth
9174 spf
9175 dkim
9176 .endd
9177
9178 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9179 .code
9180 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9181 .endd
9182 This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9183
9184
9185 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9186 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9187 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9188 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9189 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9190 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9191 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9192 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9193 .display
9194 &`version `&
9195 &`serial_number `&
9196 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9197 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9198 &`notbefore `& time
9199 &`notafter `& time
9200 &`sig_algorithm `&
9201 &`signature `&
9202 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9203 &`ocsp_uri `& list
9204 &`crl_uri `& list
9205 .endd
9206 If the field is found,
9207 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9208 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9209 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9210 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9211
9212 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9213 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9214 extracted is used.
9215
9216 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9217
9218 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9219 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9220 not quite
9221 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9222 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9223 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9224 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9225 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9226 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9227 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9228 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9229
9230 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9231 take an optional modifier of "int"
9232 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9233 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9234 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9235
9236 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9237 newline-separated by default,
9238 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9239 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9240 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9241
9242 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9243 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9244 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9245 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9246 if so the element tags are omitted.
9247
9248 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9249
9250 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9251 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9252 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
9253 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9254 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9255 .code
9256 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9257 .endd
9258 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9259 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9260 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9261
9262 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9263 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9264 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9265 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9266 must have the following type:
9267 .code
9268 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9269 .endd
9270 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9271 function should return one of the following values:
9272
9273 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9274 into the expanded string that is being built.
9275
9276 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9277 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9278
9279 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9280 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9281
9282 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9283
9284 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9285 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9286 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9287
9288
9289 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9290 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9291 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9292 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9293 removed.
9294 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9295 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9296 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9297
9298 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9299 appear, for example:
9300 .code
9301 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9302 .endd
9303 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9304 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9305
9306 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9307 search failure.
9308 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9309 search success.
9310
9311 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9312 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9313
9314
9315 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9316 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9317 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9318 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9319 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9320 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9321 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9322 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9323 .display
9324 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9325 .endd
9326 .vindex "&$value$&"
9327 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9328 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9329 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9330 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9331 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9332 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9333 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9334 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9335 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9336
9337 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9338 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9339 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9340 yield &"2001"&:
9341 .code
9342 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9343 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9344 .endd
9345 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9346 appear, for example:
9347 .code
9348 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9349 .endd
9350 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9351 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9352
9353
9354 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9355 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9356 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9357 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9358 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9359 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9360 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9361 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9362 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9363 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9364 <&'string3'&> as before.
9365
9366 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9367 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9368 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9369 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9370 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9371 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9372 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9373 provided. For example:
9374 .code
9375 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9376 .endd
9377 yields &"42"&, and
9378 .code
9379 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9380 .endd
9381 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9382 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9383
9384
9385 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9386 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9387 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9388 .vindex "&$item$&"
9389 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9390 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9391 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9392 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9393 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9394 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9395 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9396 .code
9397 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9398 .endd
9399 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9400 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9401
9402
9403 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9404 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9405 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9406 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9407 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9408 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9409
9410 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9411 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9412 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9413 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9414 .code
9415 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9416 .endd
9417 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9418 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9419 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9420 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9421 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9422 .code
9423 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9424 .endd
9425 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9426 letters appear. For example:
9427 .display
9428 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9429 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9430 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9431 .endd
9432
9433 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9434 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9435 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9436 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9437 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9438 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9439 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9440 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9441 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9442 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9443 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9444 .vindex "&$lheader_$&"
9445 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9446 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9447 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9448 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9449 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9450 .code
9451 $header_reply-to:
9452 .endd
9453 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9454 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9455 lines) may be present.
9456
9457 The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
9458 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9459
9460 .ilist
9461 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9462 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9463 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9464
9465 .next
9466 .cindex "list" "of header lines"
9467 &%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
9468 are multiple headers with a given name.
9469 Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
9470 list-processing facilities can be used.
9471 The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
9472 the content is &"raw"&.
9473
9474 .next
9475 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9476 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9477 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9478 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9479 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9480 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9481 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9482 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9483
9484 .next
9485 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9486 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9487 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9488 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9489 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9490 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9491 .endlist ilist
9492
9493 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9494 command of the following form:
9495 .code
9496 headers charset "UTF-8"
9497 .endd
9498 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9499 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9500 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9501 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9502 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9503 ISO-8859-1.
9504
9505 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9506 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9507 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9508 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9509
9510 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9511 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9512 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9513 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9514 router or transport are not accessible.
9515
9516 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9517 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9518 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9519 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9520 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9521 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9522 point they are added.
9523 When any of the above ACLs ar
9524 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9525
9526 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9527 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9528 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9529 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9530 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9531 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9532 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9533 header.)
9534
9535 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9536 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9537 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9538 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9539 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9540 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9541 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9542 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9543
9544
9545 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9546 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9547 .cindex &%hmac%&
9548 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9549 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9550 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9551 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9552 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9553 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9554 present. For example:
9555 .code
9556 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9557 .endd
9558 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9559 produces:
9560 .code
9561 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9562 .endd
9563 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9564 an Exim configuration:
9565 .code
9566 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9567 .endd
9568 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9569 .code
9570 headers_add = \
9571 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9572 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9573 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9574 .endd
9575 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9576 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9577 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9578 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9579 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9580 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9581
9582
9583 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9584 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9585 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9586 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9587 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9588 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9589 .code
9590 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9591 .endd
9592 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9593 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9594 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9595 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9596 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9597
9598 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9599 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9600 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9601 .code
9602 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9603 .endd
9604 you can use
9605 .code
9606 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9607 .endd
9608
9609
9610
9611 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9612 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
9613 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9614 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9615 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9616 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9617
9618
9619
9620 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9621 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9622 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9623 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9624 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9625 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9626 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9627 some of the braces:
9628 .code
9629 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9630 .endd
9631 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9632 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9633 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9634
9635
9636 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9637 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9638 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9639 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9640 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9641 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9642 apart from an optional leading minus,
9643 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9644
9645 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9646 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9647
9648 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9649 If the number is negative, the fields are
9650 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9651 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9652 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9653
9654 If the modulus of the
9655 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9656 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9657
9658 For example:
9659 .code
9660 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9661 .endd
9662 yields &"42"&, and
9663 .code
9664 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9665 .endd
9666 yields &"result: 42"&.
9667
9668 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9669 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9670 extracted is used.
9671 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9672
9673
9674 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9675 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9676 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9677 described in the next item.
9678
9679 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9680 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9681 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9682 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9683 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9684 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9685 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9686 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9687 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9688
9689 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9690 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9691 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9692 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9693 out by the system administrator.
9694
9695 .vindex "&$value$&"
9696 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9697 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9698 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9699 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9700 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9701 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9702 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9703 original lookup fails.
9704
9705 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9706 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9707 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9708 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9709 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9710 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9711 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9712 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9713
9714 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9715 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9716 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9717 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9718
9719 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9720 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9721 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9722 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9723
9724 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9725 .code
9726 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9727 .endd
9728 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9729 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9730 .code
9731 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9732 {$value}fail}
9733 .endd
9734
9735
9736 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9737 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9738 .vindex "&$item$&"
9739 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9740 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9741 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9742 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9743 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9744 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9745 .code
9746 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9747 .endd
9748 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9749 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9750 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9751
9752 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9753 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9754 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9755 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9756 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9757 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9758 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9759 .code
9760 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9761 .endd
9762 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9763 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9764 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9765 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9766 example,
9767 .code
9768 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9769 .endd
9770 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9771
9772
9773
9774 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9775 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9776 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9777 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9778 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9779 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9780 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9781 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9782
9783 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9784 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9785 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9786 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9787 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9788 not its contents.
9789
9790 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9791 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9792 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9793
9794 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9795 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9796
9797
9798 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9799 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9800 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9801 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9802 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9803 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9804 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9805 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9806
9807 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9808 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9809 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9810 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9811 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9812 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9813 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9814 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9815 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9816 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9817
9818 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9819 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9820 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9821 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9822
9823 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9824 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9825 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9826 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9827 is the expansion of the third argument.
9828
9829 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9830 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9831 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9832
9833 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9834 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9835 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9836 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9837 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9838 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9839 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9840 newlines are left in the string.
9841 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9842 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9843 the string expansion fails.
9844
9845 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9846 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9847
9848
9849
9850 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9851 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9852 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9853 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9854 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9855 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9856 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9857 examples:
9858 .code
9859 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9860 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9861 .endd
9862 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9863 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9864 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9865 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9866 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9867 example:
9868 .code
9869 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9870 .endd
9871 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9872 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9873 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9874 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
9875 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9876 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9877 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9878 .code
9879 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9880 .endd
9881
9882 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
9883 and must be present if the argument is given.
9884 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
9885 Two option types is currently recognised: shutdown and tls.
9886 The first defines whether (the default)
9887 or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
9888 Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
9889 .code
9890 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
9891 .endd
9892 .new
9893 The second, tls, controls the use of TLS on the connection. Example:
9894 .code
9895 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:tls=yes}}
9896 .endd
9897 The default is to not use TLS.
9898 If it is enabled, a shutdown as descripbed above is never done.
9899 .wen
9900
9901 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9902 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9903 turns them into spaces:
9904 .code
9905 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9906 .endd
9907 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9908 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9909 addition, the following errors can occur:
9910
9911 .ilist
9912 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9913 .next
9914 Failure to connect the socket;
9915 .next
9916 Failure to write the request string;
9917 .next
9918 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9919 .endlist
9920
9921 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9922 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9923 errors occurs. For example:
9924 .code
9925 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9926 {socket failure}}
9927 .endd
9928 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9929 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9930 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9931 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9932 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9933
9934 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9935 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9936
9937
9938 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9939 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9940 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9941 .vindex "&$value$&"
9942 .vindex "&$item$&"
9943 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9944 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9945 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9946 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9947 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9948 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9949 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9950 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9951 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9952 .code
9953 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9954 .endd
9955 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9956 can be found:
9957 .code
9958 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9959 .endd
9960 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9961 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9962 expansion items.
9963
9964 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9965 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9966 expansion item above.
9967
9968 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9969 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9970 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9971 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9972 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9973 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9974 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9975 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9976 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9977
9978 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9979 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9980 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9981 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9982 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9983 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9984 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9985 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9986 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9987 character.
9988
9989 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9990 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9991 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9992 .vindex "&$value$&"
9993 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9994 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9995 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9996 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9997 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9998 &$value$&.
9999
10000 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10001 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10002 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10003 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10004
10005 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10006 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10007 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10008 troubleshoot:
10009 .code
10010 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10011 log_message = Output of id: $value
10012 .endd
10013 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10014 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10015 .code
10016 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10017 .endd
10018
10019 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
10020 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10021 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10022 .code
10023 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10024 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10025 ...
10026 endif
10027 .endd
10028 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10029 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10030 commands.
10031
10032 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10033 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10034 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10035 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10036
10037 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10038 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10039
10040
10041 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10042 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10043 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10044 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10045 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10046 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10047 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10048 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10049 .code
10050 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10051 .endd
10052 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10053 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10054 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10055 .code
10056 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10057 .endd
10058 yields &"defabc"&, and
10059 .code
10060 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10061 .endd
10062 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10063 the regular expression from string expansion.
10064
10065
10066
10067 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10068 .cindex sorting "a list"
10069 .cindex list sorting
10070 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10071 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10072 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
10073 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10074 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10075 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10076 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10077 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10078 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10079 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10080 to give values for comparison.
10081
10082 The item result is a sorted list,
10083 with the original list separator,
10084 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10085
10086 Examples:
10087 .code
10088 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10089 .endd
10090 sorts a list of numbers, and
10091 .code
10092 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10093 .endd
10094 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10095
10096
10097 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10098 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10099 .cindex "substring extraction"
10100 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10101 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10102 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10103 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10104 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10105 .code
10106 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10107 .endd
10108 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10109 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10110 omitted.
10111
10112 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10113 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10114 length required. For example
10115 .code
10116 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10117 .endd
10118 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10119 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10120 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10121 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
10122
10123 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10124 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
10125 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10126 .code
10127 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10128 .endd
10129 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10130 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10131 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10132 .code
10133 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10134 .endd
10135 yields an empty string, but
10136 .code
10137 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10138 .endd
10139 yields &"1"&.
10140
10141 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10142 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
10143 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10144 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10145 .code
10146 ${substr_-1:abcde}
10147 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10148 .endd
10149 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10150
10151
10152
10153 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10154 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10155 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10156 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10157 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
10158 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10159 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10160 replacement list. For example
10161 .code
10162 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10163 .endd
10164 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10165 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10166 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10167 place.
10168 .endlist
10169
10170
10171
10172 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10173 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10174 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10175 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10176 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10177 following operations can be performed:
10178
10179 .vlist
10180 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10181 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10182 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10183 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10184 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10185 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10186
10187
10188 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10189 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10190 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10191 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10192 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10193 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10194 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10195 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10196 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10197
10198 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10199 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10200 character. For example:
10201 .code
10202 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10203 .endd
10204 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10205 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10206 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10207 separator explicitly:
10208 .code
10209 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10210 .endd
10211
10212 Compare the &*address*& (singular)
10213 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10214 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
10215 processing lists.
10216
10217 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10218 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10219 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10220 email address separator. For the example header line:
10221 .code
10222 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10223 .endd
10224 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10225 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10226 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10227 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10228 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10229 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10230 quoted.
10231 .code
10232 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10233 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10234 user@example.com
10235 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10236 Last:user@example.com
10237 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10238 user@example.com
10239 .endd
10240
10241 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10242 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10243 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10244 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10245 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10246 Only lowercase letters are used.
10247
10248 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10249 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10250 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10251 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10252 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10253
10254 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10255 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10256 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10257 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10258 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10259 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10260 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
10261 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
10262 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10263
10264 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10265 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10266 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10267 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10268 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10269 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10270 string.
10271
10272 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10273 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10274 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10275 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10276 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10277 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10278
10279 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10280 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10281
10282
10283 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10284 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10285 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10286 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10287 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10288
10289
10290 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10291 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10292 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10293 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10294 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10295
10296
10297 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10298 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10299 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10300 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10301 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10302 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10303 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10304
10305 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10306 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10307 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10308 If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10309 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10310 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10311
10312
10313 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10314 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10315 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10316 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10317 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10318 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10319 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10320 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10321 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10322 C programming language):
10323 .table2 70pt 300pt
10324 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10325 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10326 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10327 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10328 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10329 .irow "" "xor (^)"
10330 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10331 .endtable
10332 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10333 space is permitted before or after operators.
10334
10335 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10336 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10337 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10338 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10339 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10340
10341 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10342 or 1024*1024*1024,
10343 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10344 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10345
10346 .display
10347 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10348 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10349 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10350 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10351 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10352 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10353 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10354 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10355 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10356 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10357 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10358 .endd
10359
10360 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10361 .code
10362 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10363 condition = \
10364 ${if and { \
10365 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10366 { \
10367 < \
10368 {$recipients_count} \
10369 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10370 } \
10371 }{yes}{no}}
10372 .endd
10373 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10374 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10375
10376
10377 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10378 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10379 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10380 example,
10381 .code
10382 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10383 .endd
10384 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10385 and then re-expands what it has found.
10386
10387
10388 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10389 .cindex "Unicode"
10390 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10391 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10392 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10393 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10394 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10395 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10396 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10397 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10398 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10399
10400 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10401 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10402 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10403 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10404 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10405 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10406 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10407
10408
10409 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10410 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10411 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10412 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10413 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10414 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10415 .code
10416 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10417 .endd
10418 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10419 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10420
10421
10422
10423 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10424 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10425 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10426 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10427 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10428 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10429
10430
10431
10432 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10433 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10434 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10435 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10436 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10437 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10438 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10439
10440
10441 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10442 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10443 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10444 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10445 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10446 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10447 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10448
10449 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10450 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10451 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10452 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10453 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10454 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10455 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10456 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10457 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10458
10459
10460 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10461 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10462 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10463 .cindex "lower casing"
10464 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10465 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10466 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10467 .code
10468 ${lc:$local_part}
10469 .endd
10470
10471 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10472 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10473 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10474 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10475 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10476 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10477 .code
10478 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10479 .endd
10480 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10481 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10482 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10483
10484
10485 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10486 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10487 .cindex "list" "item count"
10488 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10489 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10490 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10491
10492
10493 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10494 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10495 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10496 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10497 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10498 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10499 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10500 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10501 matching list is returned.
10502
10503
10504 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10505 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10506 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10507 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10508 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10509 empty.
10510
10511
10512 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10513 .cindex "masked IP address"
10514 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10515 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10516 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10517 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10518 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10519 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10520 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10521 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10522 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10523 .code
10524 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10525 .endd
10526 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10527 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10528 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10529 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10530 .code
10531 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10532 .endd
10533 returns the string
10534 .code
10535 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10536 .endd
10537 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10538
10539
10540 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10541 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10542 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10543 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10544 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10545 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10546 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10547
10548 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10549 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10550
10551
10552 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10553 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10554 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10555 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10556 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10557 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10558 .code
10559 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10560 .endd
10561 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10562
10563
10564 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10565 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10566 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10567 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10568 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10569 is an empty string or
10570 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10571 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10572 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10573 respectively For example,
10574 .code
10575 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
10576 .endd
10577 becomes
10578 .code
10579 "ab\"*\"cd"
10580 .endd
10581 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10582 variable or a message header.
10583
10584 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10585 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10586 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10587 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10588 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10589 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10590 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10591
10592
10593 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10594 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10595 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10596 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10597 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10598 .code
10599 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10600 .endd
10601 returns
10602 .code
10603 two%20%5C2A%20two
10604 .endd
10605 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10606 yields an unchanged string.
10607
10608
10609 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10610 .cindex "random number"
10611 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10612 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10613 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10614 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10615 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10616 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10617 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10618 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10619 random().
10620
10621
10622 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10623 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10624 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10625 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10626 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10627 for DNS. For example,
10628 .code
10629 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10630 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10631 .endd
10632 returns
10633 .code
10634 4.2.0.192
10635 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10636 .endd
10637
10638
10639 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10640 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10641 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10642 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10643 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10644 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10645 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10646 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10647 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10648 characters
10649 .code
10650 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10651 .endd
10652 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10653 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10654 characters.
10655
10656
10657 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10658 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10659 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10660 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10661 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10662 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10663 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10664 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10665
10666 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10667 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10668 to use this operator as well.
10669
10670
10671
10672 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10673 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10674 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10675 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10676 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10677 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10678 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10679
10680
10681 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10682 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10683 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10684 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10685 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10686 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10687 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10688
10689 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10690 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10691
10692
10693 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10694 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10695 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10696 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10697 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10698 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
10699 and returns
10700 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10701
10702 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10703 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10704
10705
10706 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10707 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10708 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
10709 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
10710 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
10711 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
10712 and returns
10713 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10714
10715 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
10716 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
10717 with 256 being the default.
10718
10719 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
10720 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
10721 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
10722 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
10723
10724
10725 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10726 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10727 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10728 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10729 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10730 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10731 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10732 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10733 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10734 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10735 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10736 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10737 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10738
10739 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10740 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10741 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10742
10743 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10744 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10745 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
10746
10747
10748
10749 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10750 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10751 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10752 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10753 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10754 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10755
10756
10757 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10758 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10759 .cindex "substring extraction"
10760 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10761 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10762 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10763 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10764 .code
10765 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10766 .endd
10767 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10768 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10769
10770 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10771 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10772 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10773 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10774 seconds.
10775
10776 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10777 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10778 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10779 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10780 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10781 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10782 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10783
10784 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10785 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10786 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10787 .cindex "upper casing"
10788 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10789 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10790 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10791
10792 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10793 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10794 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10795 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10796 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10797 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10798 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10799
10800 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10801 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10802 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10803 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
10804 .cindex expansion UTF-8
10805 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
10806 .cindex EAI
10807 .cindex internationalisation
10808 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10809 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10810 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10811 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10812 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
10813 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
10814 .endlist
10815
10816
10817
10818
10819
10820
10821 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10822 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10823 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10824 while expanding strings:
10825
10826 .vlist
10827 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10828 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10829 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10830 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10831 condition.
10832
10833 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10834 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10835 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10836 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10837 are:
10838 .display
10839 &`= `& equal
10840 &`== `& equal
10841 &`> `& greater
10842 &`>= `& greater or equal
10843 &`< `& less
10844 &`<= `& less or equal
10845 .endd
10846 For example:
10847 .code
10848 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10849 .endd
10850 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10851 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10852 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10853 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10854 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10855 zero.
10856
10857 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10858 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10859 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10860
10861
10862 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10863 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10864 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10865 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10866 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10867 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10868 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10869 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10870 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10871 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10872 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10873 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10874 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10875 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10876
10877 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10878 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10879 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10880 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10881 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10882 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10883 false if zero.
10884 An empty string is treated as false.
10885 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10886 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10887 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10888
10889 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10890 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10891 For example:
10892 .code
10893 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10894 .endd
10895
10896
10897 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10898 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10899 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10900 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10901 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10902 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10903 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10904 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10905
10906 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10907
10908 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10909 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10910 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10911 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10912 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10913 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10914 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10915 included in the binary.
10916
10917 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10918 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10919 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10920 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10921 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10922 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10923 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10924 string in LDAP form is:
10925 .code
10926 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10927 .endd
10928 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10929 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10930 .code
10931 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10932 .endd
10933 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10934 supported:
10935
10936 .ilist
10937 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10938 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10939 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10940 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10941 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10942 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10943 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10944 comparison fails.
10945
10946 .next
10947 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10948 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10949 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10950 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10951 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10952 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10953
10954 .next
10955 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10956 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10957 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10958 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10959 whatever its length.
10960
10961 .next
10962 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10963 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10964 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10965 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10966 .endlist
10967 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10968 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10969 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10970 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10971 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10972 support &[crypt16()]&.
10973
10974 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10975 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10976 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10977 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10978 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10979
10980 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10981 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10982 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10983
10984 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10985 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10986 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10987 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10988 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10989
10990 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10991 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10992 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10993 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10994 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10995 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10996 .code
10997 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10998 .endd
10999 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11000 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11001
11002 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11003 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11004 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11005 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11006 exists in the message. For example,
11007 .code
11008 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11009 .endd
11010 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11011 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11012
11013 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11014 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11015 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11016 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11017 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11018 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11019 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11020 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11021 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
11022
11023 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11024 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11025 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11026 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11027 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11028 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11029 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11030 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11031
11032 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11033 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11034 .cindex "first delivery"
11035 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11036 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11037 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11038 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11039
11040
11041 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11042 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11043 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11044 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11045 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11046 .vindex "&$item$&"
11047 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11048 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11049 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11050 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11051 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11052 .ilist
11053 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11054 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11055 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11056 .next
11057 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11058 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11059 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11060 .endlist
11061 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11062 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11063 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11064 list separator is changed to a comma:
11065 .code
11066 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11067 .endd
11068 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
11069 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11070
11071 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11072
11073
11074 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11075 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11076 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11077 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11078 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11079 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11080 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11081 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11082 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11083 case-independent.
11084
11085 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11086 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11087 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11088 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11089 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11090 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11091 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11092 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11093 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11094 case-independent.
11095
11096 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11097 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11098 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11099 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11100 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11101 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11102 is true.
11103
11104 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11105 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11106 .code
11107 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11108 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11109 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11110 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11111 .endd
11112
11113 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11114 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11115 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11116 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11117 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11118 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11119 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11120 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11121 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11122 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11123 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11124
11125 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11126 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11127 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11128 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11129 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11130
11131 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11132 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11133 check.
11134 This is no longer the case.
11135
11136 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11137 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11138 .code
11139 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11140 .endd
11141 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11142
11143 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11144 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11145 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11146 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11147 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11148 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11149 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11150 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11151 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11152 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11153 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11154 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11155 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11156 this can be used.
11157
11158
11159 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11160 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11161 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11162 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11163 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11164 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11165 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11166 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11167 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11168 case-independent.
11169
11170 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11171 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11172 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11173 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11174 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11175 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11176 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11177 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11178 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11179 case-independent.
11180
11181
11182 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11183 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11184 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11185 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11186 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11187 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11188 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11189 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11190 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11191 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11192 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11193 For example,
11194 .code
11195 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11196 .endd
11197 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11198 backslashes is also required.
11199
11200 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11201 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11202 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11203 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11204 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11205 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11206
11207 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11208 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11209 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11210 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11211 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11212 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11213 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11214 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11215
11216 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11217 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11218 See &*match_local_part*&.
11219
11220 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11221 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11222 See &*match_local_part*&.
11223
11224 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11225 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11226 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11227 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11228 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11229 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11230 .code
11231 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11232 .endd
11233 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11234
11235 .ilist
11236 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11237 .next
11238 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11239 .next
11240 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11241 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11242 in a single test such as
11243 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11244 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11245 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11246 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11247 .code
11248 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11249 .endd
11250 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11251 .next
11252 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11253 .next
11254 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11255 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11256 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11257 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11258 masks. For example:
11259 .code
11260 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11261 .endd
11262 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11263 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11264 address mask, for example:
11265 .code
11266 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11267 .endd
11268 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11269 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11270 .code
11271 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11272 .endd
11273 .endlist ilist
11274
11275 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11276 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11277
11278 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11279
11280 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11281 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11282 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11283 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11284 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11285 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11286 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11287 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11288 example is:
11289 .code
11290 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11291 .endd
11292 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11293 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11294 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11295 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11296 .code
11297 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11298 .endd
11299 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11300 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11301 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11302 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11303 caselessly.
11304
11305 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11306 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11307
11308 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11309 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11310 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11311 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11312
11313 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11314 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11315 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11316 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11317 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11318 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11319 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11320 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11321 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11322 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11323 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11324 .code
11325 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
11326 .endd
11327 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11328 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11329
11330 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11331 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11332 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11333 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11334 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11335 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11336 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11337
11338 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11339 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11340 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11341 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11342 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11343 .code
11344 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11345 .endd
11346 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11347 .code
11348 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11349 .endd
11350 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11351 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11352 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11353 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
11354 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
11355 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
11356 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
11357 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
11358
11359
11360 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11361 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11362 .cindex "Cyrus"
11363 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11364 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11365 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11366 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11367 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11368 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11369
11370 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11371 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11372 building Exim. For example:
11373 .code
11374 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11375 .endd
11376 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11377 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11378 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11379 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11380
11381 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11382 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11383 configuration, you might have this:
11384 .code
11385 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11386 .endd
11387 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11388 .code
11389 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11390 .endd
11391 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11392 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11393 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11394 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11395 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11396 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11397
11398
11399 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11400 .cindex "Radius"
11401 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11402 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11403 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11404 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11405 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11406 support.
11407
11408 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11409 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11410 this library, you need to set
11411 .code
11412 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11413 .endd
11414 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11415 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11416 .code
11417 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11418 .endd
11419 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11420 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11421 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11422
11423 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11424 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11425 the authentication is successful. For example:
11426 .code
11427 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11428 .endd
11429
11430
11431 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11432 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11433 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11434 .cindex "Cyrus"
11435 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11436 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11437 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11438 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11439 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11440 by a process that is not running as root.
11441
11442 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11443 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11444 building Exim. For example:
11445 .code
11446 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11447 .endd
11448 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11449 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11450 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11451
11452 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11453 two are mandatory. For example:
11454 .code
11455 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11456 .endd
11457 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11458 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11459 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11460 .endlist vlist
11461
11462
11463
11464 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11465 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11466 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11467 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11468 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11469 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11470 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11471
11472
11473 .vlist
11474 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11475 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11476 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11477 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11478 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11479 For example,
11480 .code
11481 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11482 .endd
11483 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11484 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11485 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11486
11487 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11488 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11489 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11490 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11491 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11492 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11493 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11494 parsed but not evaluated.
11495 .endlist
11496 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11497
11498
11499
11500
11501 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11502 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11503 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11504 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11505 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11506
11507 .vlist
11508 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11509 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11510 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11511 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11512 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11513 In the expansion condition case
11514 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11515 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11516 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11517 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11518 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11519 matching condition.
11520
11521 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11522 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11523 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11524 any unused variables being made empty.
11525
11526 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11527 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11528 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11529 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11530 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11531 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11532 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11533 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11534 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11535 during subsequent delivery.
11536
11537 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11538 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11539 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11540 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11541 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11542 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11543 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11544 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11545 delivery.
11546
11547 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11548 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11549 this variable has the number of arguments.
11550
11551 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11552 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11553 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11554 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11555 be preserved by coding like this:
11556 .code
11557 warn !verify = sender
11558 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11559 .endd
11560 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11561 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11562 failure.
11563
11564 .vitem &$address_data$&
11565 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11566 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11567 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11568 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11569 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11570 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11571 user filter files.
11572
11573 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11574 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11575 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11576 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11577 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11578 from the child's routing.
11579
11580 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11581 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11582 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11583 address.
11584
11585 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11586 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11587 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11588
11589 .vitem &$address_file$&
11590 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11591 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11592 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11593 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11594 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11595 .code
11596 /home/r2d2/savemail
11597 .endd
11598 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11599 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11600 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11601 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11602 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11603 to the relevant file.
11604
11605 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11606 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11607 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11608 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11609
11610 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11611 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11612 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11613 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11614
11615 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11616 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11617 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11618 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11619 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11620 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11621 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11622 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11623 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11624
11625 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11626 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11627 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11628 command line option.
11629 This second case also sets up inforamtion used by the
11630 &$authresults$& expansion item.
11631
11632 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11633 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11634 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11635 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11636 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11637 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11638 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11639 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11640 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11641 the ACL's as well.
11642
11643
11644 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11645 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11646 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11647 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11648 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11649 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11650 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11651 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11652 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11653 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11654 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11655
11656 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11657 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11658 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11659 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11660 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11661
11662
11663 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11664 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11665 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11666 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11667 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11668 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11669 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11670 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11671 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11672 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11673 an undefined mechanism.
11674
11675 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11676 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11677 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11678 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11679 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11680 the ACL malware condition.
11681
11682 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11683 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11684 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11685 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11686 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11687 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11688
11689 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11690 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11691 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11692 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11693 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11694 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11695 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11696
11697 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11698 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11699 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11700 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11701 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11702
11703 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11704 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11705 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11706 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11707 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11708
11709 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11710 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11711 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11712 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11713 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11714 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11715 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11716
11717 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11718 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11719 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11720 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11721 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11722 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11723 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11724
11725 .vitem &$callout_address$&
11726 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
11727 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
11728 address that was connected to.
11729
11730 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11731 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11732 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11733 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11734 compilations of the same version of the program.
11735
11736 .vitem &$config_dir$&
11737 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11738 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11739 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11740 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11741 &$config_dir$& is ".".
11742
11743 .vitem &$config_file$&
11744 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
11745 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11746
11747 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
11748 Results of DKIM verification.
11749 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11750
11751 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11752 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11753 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11754 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11755 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11756 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
11757 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11758 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11759 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11760 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11761 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11762 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11763 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11764 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11765 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11766 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11767 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11768 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
11769 &$dkim_key_length$&
11770 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11771 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11772
11773 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11774 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11775 When a message has been received this variable contains
11776 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11777 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11778
11779 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11780 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11781 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11782 &$dnslist_value$&
11783 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11784 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11785 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11786 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11787 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11788 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11789 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11790 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11791 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11792
11793 .vitem &$domain$&
11794 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11795 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11796 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11797 case for &$domain$&.
11798
11799 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11800 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11801 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11802 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11803
11804 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11805 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11806 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11807 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11808 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11809 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11810
11811 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11812 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11813 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11814
11815 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11816
11817 .ilist
11818 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11819 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11820 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11821 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11822 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11823 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11824 the &(smtp)& transport.
11825
11826 .next
11827 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11828 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11829 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11830 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11831
11832 .next
11833 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11834 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11835 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11836 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11837 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11838 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11839
11840 .next
11841 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11842 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11843 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11844 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11845 .endlist
11846
11847
11848 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11849 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11850 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11851 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11852 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11853 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11854 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11855 used.
11856
11857 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11858 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11859 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11860 to nothing.
11861
11862 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11863 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11864 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11865
11866 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11867 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11868 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11869
11870 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11871 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11872 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11873
11874 .vitem &$exim_version$&
11875 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11876 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11877 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11878 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11879 There may be other characters following the minor version.
11880
11881 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11882 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11883 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11884 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11885 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11886
11887 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11888 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11889 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11890 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11891 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11892
11893 .vitem &$home$&
11894 .vindex "&$home$&"
11895 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11896 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11897 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11898 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11899 by a setting on the transport itself.
11900
11901 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11902 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
11903 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
11904
11905 .vitem &$host$&
11906 .vindex "&$host$&"
11907 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11908 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11909 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11910 to local and remote transports.
11911
11912 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11913 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11914 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11915 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11916 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11917 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11918 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11919 is connected.
11920
11921 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11922 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11923 client is connected.
11924
11925
11926 .vitem &$host_address$&
11927 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11928 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11929 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11930 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11931
11932 .vitem &$host_data$&
11933 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11934 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11935 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11936 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11937 .code
11938 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11939 message = $host_data
11940 .endd
11941 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11942 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11943 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11944 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11945 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11946 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11947 variables is set to &"1"&.
11948
11949 .ilist
11950 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11951 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11952
11953 .next
11954 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11955 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11956 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11957 .endlist ilist
11958
11959 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11960 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11961 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11962 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11963 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11964 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11965 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11966 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11967 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11968 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11969
11970 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
11971 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
11972 &$authresults$& expansion item.
11973
11974
11975 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11976 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11977 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11978
11979 .vitem &$host_port$&
11980 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11981 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11982 for an outbound connection.
11983
11984 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
11985 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
11986 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
11987 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
11988 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
11989 to &$spool_directory$& later.
11990
11991 .vitem &$inode$&
11992 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11993 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11994 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11995 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11996 a unique name for the file.
11997
11998 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11999 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12000 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
12001
12002 .vitem &$interface_port$&
12003 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12004 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
12005
12006 .vitem &$item$&
12007 .vindex "&$item$&"
12008 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12009 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12010 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12011 empty.
12012
12013 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
12014 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12015 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12016 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12017 lookup.
12018
12019 .vitem &$load_average$&
12020 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
12021 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12022 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12023 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12024
12025 .vitem &$local_part$&
12026 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12027 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12028 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12029 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12030 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12031
12032 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12033 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12034 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12035 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12036 once.
12037
12038 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12039 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12040 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12041 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12042 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12043 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12044
12045 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12046 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12047 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
12048 &$address_pipe$&).
12049
12050 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12051 local part of the recipient address.
12052
12053 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12054 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12055 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12056
12057 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12058 the addresses
12059 .code
12060 "abc:xyz"@test.example
12061 abc\:xyz@test.example
12062 .endd
12063 the value of &$local_part$& is
12064 .code
12065 abc:xyz
12066 .endd
12067 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12068 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12069 have:
12070 .code
12071 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12072 .endd
12073 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12074 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12075 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12076
12077 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
12078 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12079 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12080 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12081 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12082 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12083 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12084
12085 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12086 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12087 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12088 variable expands to nothing.
12089
12090 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12091 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12092 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12093 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12094 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12095
12096 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12097 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12098 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12099 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12100 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12101
12102 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12103 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12104 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12105 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12106
12107 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12108 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12109 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12110
12111 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12112 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12113 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12114 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12115 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12116 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12117 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12118 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12119
12120 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12121 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12122 This contains the expanded value of the
12123 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12124 been read.
12125
12126 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12127 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12128 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12129 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12130 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12131 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12132
12133 .vitem &$log_space$&
12134 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12135 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12136 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12137 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12138 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12139 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12140
12141
12142 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12143 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12144 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12145 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12146 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12147 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12148 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12149 and &"yes"& if it was.
12150 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12151 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12152 as authenticated data.
12153
12154 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12155 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12156 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12157 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12158 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12159 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12160 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12161 variable is empty.
12162
12163 .vitem &$malware_name$&
12164 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12165 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12166 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12167 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12168
12169 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12170 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12171 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
12172 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
12173 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12174 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12175 character(s).
12176 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12177
12178 .vitem &$message_age$&
12179 .cindex "message" "age of"
12180 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
12181 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12182 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12183 delivery attempt.
12184
12185 .vitem &$message_body$&
12186 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12187 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12188 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12189 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
12190 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12191 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12192 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12193 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12194 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12195
12196 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12197 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12198 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12199 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12200 zeros are always converted into spaces.
12201
12202 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
12203 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12204 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12205 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12206 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12207 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12208 &$message_body$&.
12209
12210 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12211 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12212 .cindex "message body" "size"
12213 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12214 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12215 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12216 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12217 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12218
12219 If the spool file is wireformat
12220 (see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12221 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12222
12223 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12224 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12225 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12226 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12227 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12228 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12229 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12230 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12231
12232 .vitem &$message_headers$&
12233 .vindex &$message_headers$&
12234 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12235 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12236 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12237 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12238
12239 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12240 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12241 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12242 contents of header lines is done.
12243
12244 .vitem &$message_id$&
12245 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12246
12247 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
12248 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12249 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12250 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12251 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12252 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12253 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12254 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12255 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12256 from the body is not counted.
12257
12258 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12259 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12260 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12261 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12262 header and the body).
12263
12264 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12265 .code
12266 deny message = Too many lines in message header
12267 condition = \
12268 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12269 .endd
12270 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12271 message has not yet been received.
12272
12273 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12274
12275 .vitem &$message_size$&
12276 .cindex "size" "of message"
12277 .cindex "message" "size"
12278 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12279 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12280 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12281 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12282 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12283 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12284 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12285 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12286 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12287
12288 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12289 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12290 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12291 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12292
12293 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12294 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12295 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12296 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12297
12298 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12299 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12300 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12301
12302 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12303 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12304 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12305 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12306 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12307 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12308 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12309 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12310 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12311 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12312
12313 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12314 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12315 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12316
12317 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12318 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12319 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12320 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12321 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12322 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12323 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12324 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12325 the original address.
12326
12327 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12328 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12329 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12330 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12331 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12332
12333 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12334 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12335 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12336
12337 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12338 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12339 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12340 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12341 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12342 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12343 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12344 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12345 normally the gid of the Exim user.
12346
12347 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
12348 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12349 .cindex "sender" "uid"
12350 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12351 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12352 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12353 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12354 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12355 user.
12356
12357 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12358 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12359 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12360 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12361
12362 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12363 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12364 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12365 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12366
12367 .vitem &$pid$&
12368 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12369 .vindex "&$pid$&"
12370 This variable contains the current process id.
12371
12372 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12373 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12374 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12375 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12376 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12377 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12378 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12379 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12380 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12381 variable"& error if encountered.
12382
12383 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12384 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12385 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12386 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12387 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12388 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12389 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12390
12391
12392 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12393 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12394 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12395 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12396 &$proxy_session$&
12397 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12398 or SOCKS5 support.
12399 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12400
12401 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12402 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12403 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12404 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12405
12406 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12407 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12408 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12409 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12410
12411 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12412 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12413 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12414 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12415
12416 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12417 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12418 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12419 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12420
12421 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12422 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12423 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12424
12425 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12426 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12427 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12428 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12429
12430 .vitem &$queue_name$&
12431 .vindex &$queue_name$&
12432 .cindex "named queues"
12433 .cindex queues named
12434 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12435
12436 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12437 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12438 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12439 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12440 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12441
12442 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12443 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12444 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12445 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12446 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12447 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12448
12449 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12450 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12451 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12452 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12453 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12454
12455 .vitem &$received_count$&
12456 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12457 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12458 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12459 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12460 delivering.
12461
12462 .vitem &$received_for$&
12463 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12464 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12465 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12466 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12467 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12468
12469 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12470 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12471 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12472 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12473 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12474 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12475 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12476 option.
12477
12478 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12479 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12480 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12481 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12482 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12483 time.
12484 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12485
12486 .vitem &$received_port$&
12487 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12488 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12489
12490 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12491 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12492 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12493 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12494 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12495 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12496 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12497 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12498 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12499
12500 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12501 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12502 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12503 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12504 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12505 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12506
12507 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12508 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12509 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12510
12511 .vitem &$received_time$&
12512 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12513 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12514 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12515
12516 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12517 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12518 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12519 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12520 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12521 .display
12522 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12523 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12524 .endd
12525 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12526 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12527 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12528 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12529
12530 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12531 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12532 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12533 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12534
12535 .ilist
12536 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12537 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12538
12539 .next
12540 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12541
12542 .next
12543 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12544 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12545 MAIL).
12546
12547 .next
12548 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12549 .next
12550
12551 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12552 .endlist
12553
12554 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12555 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12556
12557 .vitem &$recipients$&
12558 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12559 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12560 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12561 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12562 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12563 cases:
12564
12565 .olist
12566 In a system filter file.
12567 .next
12568 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12569 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12570 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12571 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12572 .next
12573 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12574 .endlist
12575
12576
12577 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12578 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12579 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12580 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12581 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12582 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12583
12584
12585 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12586 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12587 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12588 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12589
12590 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12591 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12592 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12593 these variables contain the
12594 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12595
12596
12597 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12598 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12599 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12600 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12601 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12602 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12603 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12604
12605 .vitem &$return_path$&
12606 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12607 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12608 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12609 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12610 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12611 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12612 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12613 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12614 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12615 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12616 envelope sender.
12617
12618 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12619 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12620 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12621
12622 .vitem &$router_name$&
12623 .cindex "router" "name"
12624 .cindex "name" "of router"
12625 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12626 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12627
12628 .vitem &$runrc$&
12629 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12630 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12631 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12632 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12633 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12634 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12635 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12636 another.
12637
12638 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12639 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12640 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12641 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12642 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12643 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12644 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12645 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12646
12647 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12648 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12649 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12650 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12651 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12652 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12653
12654 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12655 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12656 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12657 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12658 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12659 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12660 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12661 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12662
12663 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12664 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12665 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12666
12667 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12668 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12669 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12670
12671 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12672 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12673 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12674 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12675 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12676 this:
12677 .display
12678 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12679 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12680 .endd
12681 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12682 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12683 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12684 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12685
12686 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12687 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12688 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12689 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12690 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12691 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12692 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12693 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12694 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12695 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12696 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12697 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12698 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12699
12700 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12701 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12702 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12703 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12704 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12705
12706 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12707 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12708 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12709 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12710 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12711 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12712
12713 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12714 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12715 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12716 this variable contains that
12717 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12718
12719 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12720 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12721 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12722 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12723 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12724 &$authenticated_id$&.
12725
12726 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12727 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12728 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12729 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12730 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12731 resolver library states that both
12732 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12733 other times, this variable is false.
12734
12735 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12736 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12737 library, by setting:
12738 .code
12739 dns_dnssec_ok = 1
12740 .endd
12741
12742 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12743 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12744
12745 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12746 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12747
12748 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
12749 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
12750 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
12751 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
12752
12753
12754 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12755 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12756 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12757 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12758 other means, this variable is empty.
12759
12760 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12761 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12762 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12763 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12764 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12765 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12766 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12767
12768 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12769 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12770 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12771 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12772
12773 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12774 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12775 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12776 is set to &"1"&.
12777
12778 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12779 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12780 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12781 following are true:
12782
12783 .ilist
12784 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12785 .next
12786 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12787 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12788 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12789 .next
12790 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12791 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12792 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12793 .next
12794 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12795 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12796 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12797 .next
12798 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12799 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12800 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12801 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12802 .code
12803 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12804 .endd
12805 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12806 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12807 .endlist
12808
12809
12810 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12811 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12812 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12813 number that was used on the remote host.
12814
12815 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12816 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12817 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12818 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12819 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12820 called Exim.
12821
12822 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12823 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12824 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12825 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12826
12827 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12828 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12829 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12830 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12831 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12832 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12833 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12834 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12835 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12836 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12837 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12838 the parentheses.
12839
12840 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12841 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12842 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12843 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12844 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12845
12846 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12847 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12848 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12849 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12850 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12851
12852 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12853 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12854 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12855 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12856 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12857 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12858 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12859
12860 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12861 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12862 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12863 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12864 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12865
12866 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12867 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12868 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12869 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12870 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12871 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12872
12873 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12874 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12875 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12876 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12877 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12878 .code
12879 MAIL FROM:<>
12880 MAIL FROM: <>
12881 .endd
12882 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12883 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12884 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12885 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12886
12887 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12888 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12889 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12890 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12891 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12892 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12893 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12894
12895 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
12896 .cindex SMTP "command history"
12897 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
12898 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
12899 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
12900 are remembered.
12901
12902 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12903 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12904 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12905 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12906 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12907 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12908 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12909 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12910 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12911 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12912 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12913
12914 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12915 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12916 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12917 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12918 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12919 message is junk mail.
12920
12921 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12922 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12923 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12924 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12925
12926 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
12927 &$spf_received$& &&&
12928 &$spf_result$& &&&
12929 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
12930 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
12931 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
12932 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
12933
12934 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12935 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12936 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12937
12938 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12939 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12940 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12941 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12942 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12943 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12944
12945 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12946 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12947 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12948 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12949 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12950 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12951 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12952 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12953 .code
12954 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12955 .endd
12956 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12957
12958
12959 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12960 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12961 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12962 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12963 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12964 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12965
12966 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12967 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12968 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12969 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12970 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12971 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12972 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12973 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12974
12975 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12976 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12977 the outbound.
12978
12979 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12980 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12981 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12982 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12983 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12984 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12985
12986 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12987 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12988 .cindex certificate variables
12989 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12990 inbound connection when the message was received.
12991 It is only useful as the argument of a
12992 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12993 or a &%def%& condition.
12994
12995 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
12996 when a list of more than one
12997 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
12998
12999 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13000 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13001 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13002 inbound connection when the message was received.
13003 It is only useful as the argument of a
13004 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13005 or a &%def%& condition.
13006 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13007 which is not the leaf.
13008
13009 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13010 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13011 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13012 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13013 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13014 or a &%def%& condition.
13015
13016 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13017 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13018 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13019 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13020 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13021 or a &%def%& condition.
13022 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13023 which is not the leaf.
13024
13025 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13026 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13027 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13028 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13029
13030 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13031 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13032 the outbound.
13033
13034 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13035 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13036 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13037 outbound SMTP connection was made,
13038 and &"0"& otherwise.
13039
13040 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13041 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13042 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13043 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13044 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13045 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13046 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13047 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13048 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13049
13050 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13051 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13052 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13053
13054 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13055 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13056 This variable is
13057 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13058 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13059 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13060 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13061
13062 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13063 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13064 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13065
13066 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13067 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13068 When a message is received from a remote client connection
13069 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13070 .code
13071 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
13072 1 No response to request
13073 2 Response not verified
13074 3 Verification failed
13075 4 Verification succeeded
13076 .endd
13077
13078 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13079 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13080 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13081 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13082 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13083
13084 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13085 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13086 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13087 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13088 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13089 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13090 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13091 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13092 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13093 which is not the leaf.
13094
13095 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13096 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13097 the outbound.
13098
13099 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13100 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13101 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13102 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13103 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13104 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13105 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13106 which is not the leaf.
13107
13108 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13109 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13110 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13111 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13112 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13113 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13114 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13115 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13116 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13117 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13118 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13119
13120 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13121 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13122 the outbound.
13123
13124 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13125 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13126 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13127 During outbound
13128 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13129 the transport.
13130
13131 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13132 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13133 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13134
13135 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13136 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13137 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13138 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13139
13140 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13141 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13142 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13143
13144 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13145 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13146 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13147
13148 .vitem &$tod_full$&
13149 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13150 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13151 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13152 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13153 values for those that are behind (west).
13154
13155 .vitem &$tod_log$&
13156 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13157 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
13158 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13159
13160 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13161 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13162 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13163 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13164 flag.
13165
13166 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
13167 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13168 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13169 -0500.
13170
13171 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13172 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13173 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13174 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13175
13176 .vitem &$transport_name$&
13177 .cindex "transport" "name"
13178 .cindex "name" "of transport"
13179 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13180 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13181
13182 .vitem &$value$&
13183 .vindex "&$value$&"
13184 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13185 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13186 &*reduce*& expansion.
13187
13188 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
13189 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13190 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13191 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13192 Otherwise, empty.
13193
13194 .vitem &$version_number$&
13195 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
13196 The version number of Exim.
13197
13198 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13199 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13200 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13201 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13202
13203 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13204 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13205 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13206 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13207 .endlist
13208 .ecindex IIDstrexp
13209
13210
13211
13212 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13213 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13214
13215 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13216 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13217 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13218 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13219 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13220 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13221 the line
13222 .code
13223 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
13224 .endd
13225 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13226
13227
13228 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13229 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13230 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13231 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13232 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13233 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13234 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13235 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13236 a newly created Perl interpreter.
13237
13238 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13239 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13240 should usually be something like
13241 .code
13242 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13243 .endd
13244 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13245 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13246 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13247 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13248 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13249 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13250 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13251 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13252 two ways:
13253
13254 .ilist
13255 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13256 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13257 a startup when Exim is entered.
13258 .next
13259 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13260 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13261 .endlist
13262
13263 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13264 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13265
13266 .ilist
13267 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13268 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13269 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13270 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13271 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13272 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13273 defaults to false.
13274
13275
13276 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13277 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13278 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13279 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13280 forms:
13281 .code
13282 ${perl{foo}}
13283 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
13284 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13285 .endd
13286 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13287 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13288 with an error message of the form
13289 .code
13290 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13291 .endd
13292 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13293 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13294 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13295 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13296 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13297 that was passed to &%die%&.
13298
13299
13300 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13301 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13302 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13303 the Perl code
13304 .code
13305 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13306 .endd
13307 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13308 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13309 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13310
13311 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13312 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13313 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13314 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13315
13316 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13317 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13318 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13319 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13320 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13321 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13322 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13323
13324
13325 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13326 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13327 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13328 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13329 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13330 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13331 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13332 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13333 avoided, but the output is lost.
13334
13335 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13336 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13337 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13338 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13339 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13340 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13341 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13342 .code
13343 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13344 .endd
13345 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13346 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13347 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13348 as the first subroutine argument.
13349 .ecindex IIDperl
13350
13351
13352 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13353 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13354
13355 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13356 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13357 "Starting the daemon"
13358 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
13359 .cindex "interface" "listening"
13360 .cindex "network interface"
13361 .cindex "interface" "network"
13362 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13363 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13364 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13365 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13366 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13367 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13368 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13369 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13370 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13371 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13372 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13373
13374 .olist
13375 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13376 and ports to listen on.
13377 .next
13378 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13379 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13380 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13381 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13382 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13383 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13384 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13385 as an error situation.
13386 .next
13387 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13388 for the outgoing connection.
13389 .endlist
13390
13391
13392 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13393 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13394 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13395 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13396 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13397
13398 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13399 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13400 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13401 chapter describes how they operate.
13402
13403 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13404 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13405
13406
13407
13408 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13409 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13410 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13411 following options:
13412
13413 .ilist
13414 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13415 or service names.
13416 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13417 .next
13418 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13419 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13420 .endlist
13421
13422 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13423 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13424 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13425 colons. For example:
13426 .code
13427 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13428 192.168.23.65 ; \
13429 ::1 ; \
13430 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13431 .endd
13432 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13433 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13434
13435 .olist
13436 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13437 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13438 .code
13439 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13440 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13441 .endd
13442 .next
13443 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13444 with a colon separator, for example:
13445 .code
13446 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13447 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13448 .endd
13449 .endlist
13450
13451 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13452 default setting contains just one port:
13453 .code
13454 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13455 .endd
13456 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13457 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13458 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13459 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13460 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13461
13462
13463
13464 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13465 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13466 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13467 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13468 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13469 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13470 .code
13471 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13472 .endd
13473 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13474 .code
13475 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13476 .endd
13477 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13478
13479
13480
13481 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13482 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13483 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13484 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13485 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13486 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13487 exim.
13488
13489 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13490 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13491 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13492 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13493 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13494 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13495 .code
13496 -oX 1225
13497 .endd
13498 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13499 whereas
13500 .code
13501 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13502 .endd
13503 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13504 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13505 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13506
13507
13508
13509 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13510 .cindex "submissions protocol"
13511 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13512 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13513 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13514 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13515 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
13516 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
13517 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
13518 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
13519 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
13520 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
13521 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
13522 the 465 TCP ports.
13523
13524 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
13525 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
13526 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
13527
13528 The common use of this option is expected to be
13529 .code
13530 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13531 .endd
13532 per RFC 8314.
13533 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
13534 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
13535
13536 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13537 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13538 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13539 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13540 connections via the daemon.)
13541
13542
13543
13544
13545 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13546 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13547 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13548 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13549 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13550 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13551 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13552 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13553 .code
13554 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13555 .endd
13556 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13557 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13558 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13559 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13560 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13561 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13562 .code
13563 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13564 .endd
13565 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13566 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13567 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13568 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13569 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13570
13571 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13572 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13573 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13574 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13575 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13576 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13577 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13578 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13579 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13580 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13581 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13582 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13583
13584 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13585 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13586 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13587 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13588 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13589
13590
13591
13592 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13593 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13594 .code
13595 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13596 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13597 .endd
13598 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13599 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13600 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13601 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13602
13603 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13604 .code
13605 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13606 .endd
13607 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13608 .code
13609 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13610 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13611 .endd
13612 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13613 IPv4 loopback address only:
13614 .code
13615 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13616 .endd
13617 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13618 .code
13619 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13620 .endd
13621 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13622
13623
13624
13625 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13626 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13627 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13628 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13629 treated as local.
13630
13631 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13632 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13633 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13634 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13635
13636 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13637 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13638 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13639 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13640 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13641 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13642 used for listening. Consider this example:
13643 .code
13644 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13645 192.168.53.235 ; \
13646 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13647
13648 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13649 .endd
13650 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13651 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13652 Exim is routing.
13653
13654 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13655 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13656 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13657 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13658 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13659 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13660 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13661 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13662
13663
13664
13665 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13666 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13667 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13668 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13669 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13670 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13671 details.
13672
13673
13674
13675
13676 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13677 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13678
13679 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13680 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13681 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13682 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13683
13684 .ilist
13685 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13686 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13687 .next
13688 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13689 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13690 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13691 .next
13692 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13693 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13694 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13695 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13696 settings.
13697 .endlist
13698
13699 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13700 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13701 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13702 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13703 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13704 listed in more than one group.
13705
13706 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13707 .table2
13708 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13709 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
13710 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13711 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13712 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13713 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13714 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13715 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13716 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13717 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
13718 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13719 .endtable
13720
13721
13722 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13723 .table2
13724 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13725 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13726 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13727 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13728 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13729 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13730 .endtable
13731
13732
13733
13734 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13735 .table2
13736 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13737 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
13738 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13739 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13740 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13741 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13742 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13743 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13744 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13745 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13746 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13747 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13748 .endtable
13749
13750
13751
13752 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13753 .table2
13754 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
13755 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13756 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13757 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13758 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13759 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13760 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13761 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13762 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13763 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13764 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13765 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
13766 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13767 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13768 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13769 .endtable
13770
13771
13772
13773 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13774 .table2
13775 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13776 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13777 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13778 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13779 .endtable
13780
13781
13782
13783 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13784 .table2
13785 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13786 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13787 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13788 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13789 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13790 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13791 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13792 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13793 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13794 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13795 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13796 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13797 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13798 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13799 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13800 .endtable
13801
13802
13803
13804 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13805 .table2
13806 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13807 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13808 .endtable
13809
13810
13811
13812 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13813 .table2
13814 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13815 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13816 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
13817 .endtable
13818
13819
13820
13821 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13822 .table2
13823 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13824 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13825 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13826 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13827 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13828 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13829 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13830 .endtable
13831
13832
13833
13834 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13835 .table2
13836 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13837 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13838 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13839 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13840 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13841 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13842 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13843 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13844 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13845 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13846 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13847 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13848 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13849 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13850 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13851 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13852 connection"
13853 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13854 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13855 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13856 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13857 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13858 .endtable
13859
13860
13861
13862 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13863 .table2
13864 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13865 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13866 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13867 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13868 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13869 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13870 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13871 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13872 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13873 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13874 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13875 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13876 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13877 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13878 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13879 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13880 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13881 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13882 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13883 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13884 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13885 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13886 words""&"
13887 .row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
13888 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13889 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13890 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13891 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13892 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13893 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13894 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13895 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13896 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13897 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13898 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13899 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
13900 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13901 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13902 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13903 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13904 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13905 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13906 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13907 .endtable
13908
13909
13910
13911 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13912 .table2
13913 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13914 item"
13915 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13916 item"
13917 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13918 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13919 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13920 .endtable
13921
13922
13923
13924 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13925 .table2
13926 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13927 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13928 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13929 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13930 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13931 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13932 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13933 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13934 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13935 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13936 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13937 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13938 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13939 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13940 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13941 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13942 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13943 .endtable
13944
13945
13946
13947 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13948 .table2
13949 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13950 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13951 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13952 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13953 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13954 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13955 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13956 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13957 .endtable
13958
13959
13960
13961 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13962 .table2
13963 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13964 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13965 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13966 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13967 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13968 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13969 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13970 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13971 .endtable
13972
13973
13974
13975
13976 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13977 .table2
13978 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13979 .endtable
13980
13981
13982
13983
13984
13985 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13986 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13987
13988 .table2
13989 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13990 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13991 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13992 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13993 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13994 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13995 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13996 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13997 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13998 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13999 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14000 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14001 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14002 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14003 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14004 connection"
14005 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14006 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14007 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14008 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14009 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14010 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14011 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14012 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14013 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14014 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14015 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14016 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14017 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14018 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14019 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14020 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14021 .endtable
14022
14023
14024
14025 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14026 .table2
14027 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14028 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14029 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14030 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14031 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14032 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14033 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14034 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14035 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14036 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14037 .endtable
14038
14039
14040
14041 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14042 .table2
14043 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14044 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14045 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14046 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14047 words""&"
14048 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14049 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14050 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14051 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14052 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14053 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14054 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14055 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14056 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14057 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14058 .endtable
14059
14060
14061
14062 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
14063 .table2
14064 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14065 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14066 directory"
14067 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14068 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14069 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14070 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14071 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14072 .endtable
14073
14074
14075
14076 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14077 .table2
14078 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14079 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14080 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14081 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14082 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14083 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14084 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14085 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14086 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14087 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14088 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14089 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14090 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14091 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14092 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14093 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14094 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14095 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14096 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14097 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14098 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14099 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14100 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14101 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14102 .endtable
14103
14104
14105
14106 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14107 .table2
14108 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14109 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14110 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14111 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14112 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14113 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14114 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14115 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14116 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14117 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14118 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14119 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14120 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14121 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14122 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14123 .endtable
14124
14125
14126
14127 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14128 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14129 &dagger;.
14130
14131 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14132 .cindex "8BITMIME"
14133 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14134 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14135 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14136 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14137 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14138 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14139 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14140
14141 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14142 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14143 It now defaults to true.
14144 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14145 .display
14146 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14147 .endd
14148
14149 To log received 8BITMIME status use
14150 .code
14151 log_selector = +8bitmime
14152 .endd
14153
14154 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14155 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14156 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14157 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14158 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14159 further details.
14160
14161 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14162 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14163 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14164 SMTP messages.
14165
14166 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14167 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14168 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14169 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14170 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14171
14172 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14173 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14174 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14175 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14176 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14177
14178 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14179 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14180 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14181 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14182
14183 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14184 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14185 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14186 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14187 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14188
14189 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14190 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14191 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14192 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14193 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14194 This option defines the ACL that,
14195 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14196 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14197 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14198 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14199
14200 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14201 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14202 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14203 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14204 of a received message.
14205 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14206
14207 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14208 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14209 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14210 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14211
14212 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14213 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14214 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14215 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14216
14217 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14218 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14219 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14220 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14221 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14222
14223
14224 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14225 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14226 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14227 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14228
14229 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14230 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14231 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14232 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14233 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14234
14235 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14236 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14237 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14238 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14239 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14240
14241 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14242 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14243 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14244 ends without a QUIT command being received.
14245 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14246
14247 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14248 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14249 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14250 further details.
14251
14252 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14253 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14254 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14255 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14256
14257 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14258 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14259 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14260 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14261
14262 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14263 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14264 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14265 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14266
14267 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14268 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14269 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14270 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14271
14272 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
14273 .cindex "environment" "set values"
14274 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14275 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14276 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14277
14278 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14279 .cindex "admin user"
14280 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14281 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14282 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14283 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14284 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14285 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14286 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14287
14288 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14289 .cindex "domain literal"
14290 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14291 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14292 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14293 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14294
14295 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14296 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14297 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14298 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14299 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14300 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14301 the local host's IP addresses.
14302
14303
14304 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14305 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14306 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14307 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14308 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14309 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14310 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14311 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14312 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14313
14314 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14315 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14316 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14317 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14318 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14319 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
14320 experiment if they wish.
14321
14322 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14323 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14324 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
14325 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
14326 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14327 suitable setting is:
14328 .code
14329 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14330 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14331 .endd
14332 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14333 .code
14334 dns_check_names_pattern =
14335 .endd
14336 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14337
14338
14339 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14340 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14341 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14342 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14343 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14344 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14345 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14346 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14347 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14348 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14349 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14350
14351 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14352 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14353 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14354 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14355 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14356 which Exim advertises AUTH.
14357
14358 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14359 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14360 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14361 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14362 .code
14363 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14364 .endd
14365 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14366 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14367 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14368 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14369
14370
14371 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
14372 .cindex "thawing messages"
14373 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
14374 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14375 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14376 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14377 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14378 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14379
14380 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14381 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14382 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14383
14384
14385 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
14386 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14387 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14388 .code
14389 sophie:/var/run/sophie
14390 .endd
14391 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14392 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14393
14394
14395 .option bi_command main string unset
14396 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
14397 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14398 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14399 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14400 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14401
14402
14403 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
14404 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14405 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14406 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14407 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14408 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14409
14410
14411 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
14412 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14413 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14414 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14415
14416 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14417 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14418 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14419 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14420 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14421 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14422 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14423 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14424 point at which the error was detected are returned.
14425 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14426
14427 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14428 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14429 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14430 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14431 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14432 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14433 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14434 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14435 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14436 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14437
14438 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14439 during reception of a message.
14440 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14441
14442 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14443
14444
14445 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14446 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14447 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14448 &%bounce_return_body%&.
14449
14450
14451 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14452 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14453 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14454 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14455 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14456 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14457 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14458 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14459 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14460
14461 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14462 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14463 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14464 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14465 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14466 messages.
14467
14468 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14469 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14470 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14471 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14472 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14473 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14474 connection. A typical setting might be:
14475 .code
14476 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14477 .endd
14478 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14479 .code
14480 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14481 .endd
14482 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14483 address.
14484
14485 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14486 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14487 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14488 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14489 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14490 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14491
14492
14493 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14494 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14495 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14496 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14497
14498
14499 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14500 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14501 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14502 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14503
14504
14505 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14506 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14507 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14508 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14509
14510
14511 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14512 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14513 callout verification. The default value is
14514 .code
14515 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14516 .endd
14517 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14518
14519
14520 .option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14521 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14522
14523
14524 .option check_log_space main integer 10M
14525 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14526
14527 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14528 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14529 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14530 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14531 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14532 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14533 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14534 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14535 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14536 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14537
14538
14539 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14540 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14541
14542
14543 .option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14544 .cindex "checking disk space"
14545 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14546 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14547 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14548 message is accepted.
14549
14550 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14551 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14552 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14553 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14554 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14555 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14556 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14557 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14558
14559
14560 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14561 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14562 .code
14563 check_spool_space = 100M
14564 check_spool_inodes = 100
14565 .endd
14566 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14567 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14568 transit.
14569
14570 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14571 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14572 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14573
14574 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14575 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14576 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14577 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14578 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14579 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14580
14581 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14582 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14583 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14584
14585 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14586 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14587 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14588
14589 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
14590 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
14591 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
14592 may wish to deliberately disable them.
14593
14594 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14595 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
14596 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
14597 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
14598 these hosts.
14599 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
14600
14601 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
14602 .cindex "restricting access to features"
14603 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
14604 administrative user.
14605 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
14606
14607 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
14608 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
14609 .cindex memory debugging
14610 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
14611 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
14612 it should normally be left as default.
14613
14614 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14615 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14616 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14617 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14618 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14619 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14620
14621 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14622 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14623 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14624 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14625 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14626 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14627 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14628
14629 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14630 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14631
14632 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14633 .cindex "warning of delay"
14634 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14635 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
14636 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14637 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14638 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14639 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14640 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14641 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14642 with
14643 .code
14644 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14645 .endd
14646 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14647 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14648 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14649 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14650 .code
14651 delay_warning = 6h
14652 .endd
14653 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14654 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14655 .code
14656 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14657 .endd
14658 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14659 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14660 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14661
14662 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14663 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14664 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14665 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14666 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14667 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14668 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14669 not sent. The default is:
14670 .code
14671 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14672 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14673 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14674 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14675 } {no}{yes}}
14676 .endd
14677 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14678 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14679 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14680 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14681
14682 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14683 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14684 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14685 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14686 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14687 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14688 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14689 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14690
14691 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14692 .cindex "load average"
14693 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14694 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14695 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14696 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14697 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14698
14699
14700 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14701 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14702 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14703 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14704 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14705 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14706 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14707 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14708
14709 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14710 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14711 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14712 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14713 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14714 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14715 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14716 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14717
14718 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14719 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14720 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14721 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14722
14723
14724 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14725 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14726 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14727 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14728 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14729 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14730 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14731
14732
14733 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14734 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14735 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14736 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14737 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14738 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
14739
14740
14741 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14742 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14743 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14744 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14745 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14746 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14747 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14748 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14749 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14750 by a setting such as this:
14751 .code
14752 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14753 .endd
14754 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14755 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14756 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14757 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14758 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14759 options are applied after this global option.
14760
14761 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14762 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14763 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14764 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14765 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14766 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14767 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14768 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14769 value of this option. The default pattern is
14770 .code
14771 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14772 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14773 .endd
14774 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14775 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14776 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14777 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14778 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14779 empty string.
14780
14781 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14782 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14783 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14784
14785 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14786 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14787 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14788 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14789
14790 .new
14791 .option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
14792 .cindex DNS "CNAME following"
14793 This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
14794 not do it internally.
14795 As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
14796 If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
14797
14798 The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
14799 thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
14800 given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
14801 .wen
14802
14803
14804 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14805 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14806 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14807 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14808 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14809 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14810
14811 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14812
14813
14814 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14815 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14816 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14817 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
14818 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14819 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14820 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14821 domain matches this list.
14822
14823 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14824 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14825 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14826
14827
14828 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14829 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14830 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14831 .cindex "DNS" timeout
14832 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14833 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14834 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14835 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14836 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14837 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14838 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14839 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14840 to set in them.
14841 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14842
14843
14844 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14845 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14846
14847
14848 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14849 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14850 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14851 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14852 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14853 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14854 match with this expanded domain list.
14855
14856 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14857 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14858 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14859 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14860 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14861 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14862
14863 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14864 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14865 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14866
14867 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14868 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14869 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14870 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14871 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14872
14873 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14874 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14875 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14876 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14877 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
14878 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14879 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14880 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14881 on.
14882
14883 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14884
14885 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
14886 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
14887 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
14888
14889
14890 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14891 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14892 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14893 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14894
14895 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14896 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14897 .cindex "DSN" "success"
14898 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14899 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14900 and accepted from, these hosts.
14901 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14902 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14903 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14904 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14905 are sent.
14906
14907 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14908 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14909 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14910 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14911 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14912 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14913 .code
14914 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14915 .endd
14916 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14917 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14918
14919 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14920 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14921 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14922 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14923 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14924 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14925 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14926 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14927 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14928
14929
14930 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14931 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14932 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14933 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14934 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14935 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14936 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14937 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14938 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14939
14940 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14941 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14942 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14943 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14944 are examined. For example:
14945 .code
14946 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14947 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14948 postmaster@mydomain.example
14949 .endd
14950 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14951 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14952 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14953 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14954 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14955 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14956 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14957
14958
14959 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14960 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14961 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14962 .display
14963 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14964 .endd
14965 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14966 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14967 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14968 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14969 overrides the default.
14970
14971 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14972 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14973 and warning messages. For example:
14974 .code
14975 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14976 .endd
14977 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14978 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14979 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14980 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14981 not used.
14982
14983
14984 .option event_action main string&!! unset
14985 .cindex events
14986 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
14987 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
14988
14989
14990 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14991 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14992 .cindex "Exim group"
14993 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14994 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14995 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14996 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14997 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14998 security issues.
14999
15000
15001 .option exim_path main string "see below"
15002 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
15003 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
15004 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
15005 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
15006 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
15007 other place.
15008 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
15009 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
15010 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
15011 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
15012
15013
15014 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
15015 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
15016 .cindex "Exim user"
15017 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15018 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
15019 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
15020 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
15021
15022 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
15023 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
15024 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15025 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15026
15027
15028 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15029 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15030 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15031 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15032
15033
15034 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15035 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15036
15037 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15038 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15039 .oindex "&%-t%&"
15040 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15041 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15042 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15043 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15044 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15045 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15046 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15047 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15048 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15049 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15050 addresses.
15051
15052
15053 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
15054 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15055 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15056 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15057 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15058 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15059 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15060 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15061 retries.
15062
15063 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15064 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15065 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15066 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15067
15068
15069
15070 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15071 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15072 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15073 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15074 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15075 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15076 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15077 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15078 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15079 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15080 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15081 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15082 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15083 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15084 logging that you require.
15085
15086
15087 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15088 .cindex "HP-UX"
15089 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15090 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15091 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15092 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15093 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15094 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15095 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15096 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15097
15098 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15099 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15100 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15101 user's name.
15102
15103 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15104 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15105 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15106 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15107 .code
15108 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15109 gecos_name = $1
15110 .endd
15111
15112 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
15113 See &%gecos_name%& above.
15114
15115
15116 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15117 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15118 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15119 implementations of TLS.
15120
15121
15122 .option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15123 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15124 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15125
15126 See
15127 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15128 for documentation.
15129
15130
15131
15132 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
15133 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15134 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15135 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15136 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15137 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15138
15139
15140
15141 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15142 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15143 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15144 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15145 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15146 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15147 sections are rejected.
15148
15149
15150 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15151 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15152 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15153 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15154 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15155 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15156 zero means &"no limit"&.
15157
15158
15159
15160
15161 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15162 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15163 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15164 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15165 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15166 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15167 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15168 if you want to do semantic checking.
15169 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15170 set.
15171
15172
15173 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15174 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15175 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15176 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15177 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15178 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15179 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15180 .code
15181 helo_allow_chars = _
15182 .endd
15183 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15184
15185
15186 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15187 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15188 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15189 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15190 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15191 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15192 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15193 do.
15194
15195
15196 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15197 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15198 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15199 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15200 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15201 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15202 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15203 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15204 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15205 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15206 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15207 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15208
15209 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15210 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15211 EHLO command either:
15212
15213 .ilist
15214 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15215 .next
15216 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15217 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15218 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15219 calling host address, or
15220 .next
15221 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15222 .endlist
15223
15224 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15225 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15226 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15227
15228 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15229 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15230 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15231
15232 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15233 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15234 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15235 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15236 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15237 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15238 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15239 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15240 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15241 error.
15242
15243 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15244 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15245 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15246 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
15247 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15248 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15249 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15250 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15251 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15252
15253 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15254 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15255 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15256 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15257 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15258
15259 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15260 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15261 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15262 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15263
15264
15265 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15266 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15267 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15268 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15269 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15270 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15271 default configuration file contains
15272 .code
15273 host_lookup = *
15274 .endd
15275 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15276 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15277
15278 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15279 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15280 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15281
15282 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15283 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15284 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15285 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15286 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15287 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15288
15289
15290 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15291 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15292 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15293 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15294 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15295 if you want.
15296
15297 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15298 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15299 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15300 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15301
15302
15303
15304 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15305 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15306 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15307 as soon as the connection is made.
15308 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15309 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15310 connections immediately.
15311
15312 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15313 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15314 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15315 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15316 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15317
15318
15319 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15320 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15321 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15322 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15323 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15324 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15325 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15326 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15327 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15328 .code
15329 hosts_connection_nolog = :
15330 .endd
15331 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15332
15333
15334
15335 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15336 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15337 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15338 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15339
15340
15341 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15342 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15343 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
15344 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15345 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15346 records
15347 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15348 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15349
15350 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15351 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15352 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15353 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15354 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15355 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15356 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15357
15358
15359 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15360 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15361 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15362 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15363 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15364
15365
15366
15367 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15368 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15369 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
15370 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15371 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15372 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15373
15374 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15375 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15376 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15377 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15378 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15379 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15380 for frozen messages. For example,
15381 .code
15382 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15383 .endd
15384 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15385 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15386 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15387 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15388 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15389 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15390
15391
15392 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15393 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15394 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15395 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15396 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15397 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15398 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15399 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15400 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15401 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15402
15403
15404 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15405 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15406
15407 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15408 .cindex "environment" "values from"
15409 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15410 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15411 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15412 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15413 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15414 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15415 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15416
15417 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15418 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15419
15420 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15421 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15422 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15423 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15424
15425 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15426 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15427 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15428 anymore.
15429
15430 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15431 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15432 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15433 details.
15434
15435
15436 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
15437 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15438 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15439 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15440 logged.
15441
15442
15443 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15444 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15445 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15446 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15447 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15448 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15449 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15450 and constrained to be a directory.
15451
15452
15453 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15454 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15455 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15456 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15457 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15458 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15459 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15460 and constrained to be a file.
15461
15462
15463 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15464 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15465 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15466 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15467 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15468 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15469
15470
15471 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15472 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15473 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15474 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15475 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15476 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15477 identity to be proven.
15478
15479
15480 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15481 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15482 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15483 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15484 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15485
15486
15487 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15488 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15489 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15490 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15491 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15492 with LDAP support.
15493
15494
15495 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15496 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15497 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15498 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15499 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15500 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15501 to hard/demand.
15502
15503
15504 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15505 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15506 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15507 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15508 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15509 of SSL-on-connect.
15510 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15511 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15512 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15513
15514
15515 .option ldap_version main integer unset
15516 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15517 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15518 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15519 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15520 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15521 has been built with LDAP support.
15522
15523
15524
15525 .option local_from_check main boolean true
15526 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15527 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15528 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15529 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15530 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15531 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15532
15533 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15534 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15535 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15536
15537 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15538 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15539 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15540 and the default qualify domain.
15541
15542 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15543 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15544 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15545 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15546
15547 .cindex "envelope sender"
15548 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15549 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15550 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15551
15552 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15553 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15554 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15555
15556
15557
15558
15559 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
15560 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15561 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15562 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15563 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15564 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15565 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15566 example, if
15567 .code
15568 local_from_prefix = *-
15569 .endd
15570 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15571 .code
15572 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15573 .endd
15574 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15575 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15576 qualify domain.
15577
15578
15579 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15580 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15581
15582
15583 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15584 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15585 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15586 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15587 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15588 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15589 &%local_interfaces%& is
15590 .code
15591 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15592 .endd
15593 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15594 .code
15595 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15596 .endd
15597
15598 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15599 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15600 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15601 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15602 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15603 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15604 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15605 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15606
15607
15608
15609 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15610 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15611 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15612 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15613 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15614 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15615 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15616 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15617
15618
15619
15620
15621 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15622 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15623 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15624 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15625 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15626 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15627 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15628 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15629 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15630 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15631 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15632 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15633 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15634 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15635 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15636
15637
15638
15639 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15640 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15641 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15642 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15643 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15644 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15645 or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15646 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15647 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15648 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15649 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15650 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15651 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15652 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15653 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15654
15655
15656 .option log_selector main string unset
15657 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15658 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15659 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15660 minus characters. For example:
15661 .code
15662 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15663 .endd
15664 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15665 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15666
15667
15668 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15669 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15670 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15671 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15672 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15673 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15674 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15675 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15676 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15677 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15678 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15679 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15680 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15681
15682
15683 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15684 .cindex "too many open files"
15685 .cindex "open files, too many"
15686 .cindex "file" "too many open"
15687 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15688 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15689 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15690 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15691 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15692 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15693 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15694 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15695 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15696 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15697 &%lookup_open_max%&.
15698
15699
15700 .option max_username_length main integer 0
15701 .cindex "length of login name"
15702 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15703 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
15704 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15705 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15706 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15707 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15708
15709
15710 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
15711 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15712 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15713 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15714 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15715 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15716 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15717 option is set true, this no longer happens.
15718
15719
15720 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
15721 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15722 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
15723 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15724 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15725 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15726 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15727
15728
15729 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15730 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15731 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15732 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15733 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15734 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15735 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15736 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15737 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15738 empty string, the option is ignored.
15739
15740
15741 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15742 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15743 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15744 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15745 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15746 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15747 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15748 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15749 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15750 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15751 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15752 colons will become hyphens.
15753
15754
15755 .option message_logs main boolean true
15756 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15757 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15758 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15759 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15760 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15761 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15762 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15763 which is not affected by this option.
15764
15765
15766 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15767 .cindex "message" "size limit"
15768 .cindex "limit" "message size"
15769 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15770 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15771 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15772 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15773 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15774 optionally followed by K or M.
15775
15776 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15777 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15778 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15779 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15780 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15781
15782 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15783 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15784 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15785 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15786 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15787 message that an individual transport can process.
15788
15789 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15790 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15791 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15792 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15793 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15794 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15795 some problems may result.
15796
15797 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15798 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15799 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15800
15801
15802 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15803 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15804 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15805 .code
15806 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15807 .endd
15808 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15809 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15810 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15811 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15812 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15813
15814
15815 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15816 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15817 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15818 contains a full description of this facility.
15819
15820
15821
15822 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15823 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15824 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15825 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15826 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15827
15828
15829 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15830 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15831 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15832 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15833 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15834 safety precaution.
15835
15836 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15837 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15838 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15839 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15840 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15841
15842 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15843 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15844 example is
15845 .code
15846 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15847 .endd
15848 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15849 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15850 transport driver.
15851
15852
15853 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +single_dh_use +no_ticket"
15854 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15855 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15856 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15857 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15858
15859 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15860 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15861 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15862 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15863 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15864 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15865 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15866
15867 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15868 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15869 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15870 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15871 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15872
15873 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15874
15875 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15876 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15877 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15878 some now infamous attacks.
15879
15880 Examples:
15881 .code
15882 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15883 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15884 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15885
15886 # Disable older protocol versions:
15887 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15888 .endd
15889
15890 Possible options may include:
15891 .ilist
15892 &`all`&
15893 .next
15894 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15895 .next
15896 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15897 .next
15898 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15899 .next
15900 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
15901 .next
15902 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15903 .next
15904 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15905 .next
15906 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15907 .next
15908 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15909 .next
15910 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15911 .next
15912 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15913 .next
15914 &`no_compression`&
15915 .next
15916 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15917 .next
15918 &`no_sslv2`&
15919 .next
15920 &`no_sslv3`&
15921 .next
15922 &`no_ticket`&
15923 .next
15924 &`no_tlsv1`&
15925 .next
15926 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
15927 .next
15928 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
15929 .next
15930 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15931 .next
15932 &`single_dh_use`&
15933 .next
15934 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15935 .next
15936 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15937 .next
15938 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15939 .next
15940 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15941 .next
15942 &`tls_d5_bug`&
15943 .next
15944 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15945 .endlist
15946
15947 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15948 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15949 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15950 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15951 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15952 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15953
15954
15955 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15956 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15957 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15958 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15959 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15960
15961
15962 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15963 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15964 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15965 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15966 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15967 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15968 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15969 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15970 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15971 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15972 an ACL.
15973
15974 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15975 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15976 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15977 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15978 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15979 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15980 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15981
15982
15983 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15984 .cindex "Perl"
15985 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15986 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15987
15988
15989 .option perl_startup main string unset
15990 .cindex "Perl"
15991 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15992 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15993
15994 .option perl_startup main boolean false
15995 .cindex "Perl"
15996 This Option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
15997
15998
15999 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
16000 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
16001 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
16002 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
16003 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
16004 PostgreSQL support.
16005
16006
16007 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
16008 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
16009 .cindex "pid file, path for"
16010 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
16011 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
16012 to the host name:
16013 .code
16014 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
16015 .endd
16016 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
16017 spool directory.
16018 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
16019 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
16020 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
16021
16022
16023 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16024 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16025 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16026 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16027 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16028 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
16029 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
16030 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
16031 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
16032
16033
16034 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
16035 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16036 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16037 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16038 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16039 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16040 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16041 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16042
16043 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16044 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16045 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16046 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16047 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16048 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16049 volume of mail. Use with care!
16050
16051
16052 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16053 .cindex "name" "of local host"
16054 .cindex "host" "name of local"
16055 .cindex "local host" "name of"
16056 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16057 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16058 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16059 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16060 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16061 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16062
16063 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16064 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16065 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16066 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16067 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16068 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16069
16070
16071 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16072 .cindex "printing characters"
16073 .cindex "8-bit characters"
16074 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
16075 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16076 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16077 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16078 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16079 characters.
16080
16081 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16082 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16083 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16084 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16085 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16086 standards.
16087
16088
16089 .option process_log_path main string unset
16090 .cindex "process log path"
16091 .cindex "log" "process log"
16092 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16093 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16094 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16095 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16096 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16097 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16098 different spool directories.
16099
16100
16101 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16102 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16103 .oindex "&%-M%&"
16104 .oindex "&%-R%&"
16105 .oindex "&%-q%&"
16106 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16107 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16108 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16109
16110
16111 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16112 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16113 .cindex "address" "qualification"
16114 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16115 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16116 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16117 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16118 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16119 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16120
16121 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16122 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16123 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16124 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16125 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16126 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16127 &%primary_hostname%& value.
16128
16129
16130 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16131 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16132 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16133
16134
16135
16136 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16137 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16138 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16139 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16140 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16141 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16142 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16143 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16144
16145
16146 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16147 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16148 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
16149 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16150 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16151 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16152 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16153
16154
16155 .option queue_only main boolean false
16156 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16157 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16158 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16159 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
16160 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16161 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16162
16163 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16164 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16165 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16166 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16167
16168
16169 .option queue_only_file main string unset
16170 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16171 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16172 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16173 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16174 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16175 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16176 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16177 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16178 .code
16179 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16180 .endd
16181 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16182 &_/some/file_& exists.
16183
16184
16185 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16186 .cindex "load average"
16187 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16188 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16189 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16190 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16191 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16192 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16193 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16194 false.
16195
16196 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16197 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16198 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16199 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16200
16201
16202 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16203 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16204 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16205 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16206 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16207 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16208 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16209 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16210 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16211 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16212 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16213 re-evaluated for each message.
16214
16215
16216 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
16217 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16218 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16219 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16220 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16221 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16222
16223
16224 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16225 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16226 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16227 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16228 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16229 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16230 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16231 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16232 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16233 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16234 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16235 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16236 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16237
16238
16239
16240 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16241 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16242 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16243 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16244 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16245 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16246 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16247 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16248 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16249
16250 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16251 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16252 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16253 the daemon's command line.
16254
16255 .cindex queues named
16256 .cindex "named queues"
16257 To set limits for different named queues use
16258 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16259
16260 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16261 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16262 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16263 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16264 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16265 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16266 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16267 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16268 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16269 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16270 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16271 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16272 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16273 &%queue_domains%&.
16274
16275
16276 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
16277 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16278 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16279 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16280 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
16281 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16282 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16283
16284 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16285 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16286 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16287 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16288 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16289 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16290 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16291 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16292 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16293 header lines. The default setting is:
16294
16295 .code
16296 received_header_text = Received: \
16297 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16298 {${if def:sender_ident \
16299 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16300 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16301 by $primary_hostname \
16302 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
16303 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
16304 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16305 ${if def:sender_address \
16306 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16307 id $message_exim_id\
16308 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16309 .endd
16310
16311 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16312 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16313 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16314 header lines such as the following:
16315 .code
16316 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16317 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16318 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16319 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16320 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16321 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16322 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16323 .endd
16324 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16325 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16326 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16327 message was accepted.
16328
16329
16330 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
16331 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
16332 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
16333 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16334 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16335 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16336 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16337 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16338
16339
16340 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16341 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16342 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16343 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16344 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16345 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16346 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16347 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16348 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16349 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16350 option was not set.
16351
16352
16353 .option recipients_max main integer 0
16354 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16355 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16356 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16357 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16358 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16359 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16360 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16361 done.
16362
16363 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16364 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16365 RCPT commands in a single message.
16366
16367
16368 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16369 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16370 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16371 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16372 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16373 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16374 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16375
16376
16377 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16378 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16379 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16380 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16381 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16382 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16383 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16384 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16385 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16386 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16387 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16388 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16389 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16390 tagged with its process id.
16391
16392 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16393 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16394 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16395 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16396 is received.
16397
16398 .cindex "number of deliveries"
16399 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16400 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16401 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16402 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16403 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16404 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16405 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16406 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16407 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16408 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
16409
16410 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16411 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16412 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16413 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16414
16415
16416 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16417 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16418 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16419 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16420 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16421 .code
16422 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16423 .endd
16424 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16425 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16426
16427
16428 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16429 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16430 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16431 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16432 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16433 past failures.
16434
16435
16436 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16437 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16438 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16439 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16440 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16441 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16442 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16443 the default value.
16444
16445
16446 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
16447 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16448 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16449 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16450 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16451 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16452 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16453 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16454 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16455 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16456
16457
16458 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16459 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16460
16461
16462 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16463 .cindex "RFC 1413"
16464 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16465 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16466 an item in the list.
16467 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16468 for the system.
16469
16470 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16471 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16472 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16473 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16474 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16475
16476
16477 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16478 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16479 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16480 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16481 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16482 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16483 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16484 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16485 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16486 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16487
16488 .option set_environment main "string list" empty
16489 .cindex "environment"
16490 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
16491 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16492 default list is empty,
16493
16494
16495 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16496 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16497 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16498 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16499 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16500 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16501 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16502
16503
16504
16505 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16506 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16507 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16508 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16509 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16510 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16511 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16512 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16513 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16514 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16515 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16516
16517
16518
16519 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16520 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16521 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16522 .cindex "inetd"
16523 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16524 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16525 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16526 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16527 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16528 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16529
16530 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16531 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16532 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16533 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16534
16535
16536 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16537 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16538 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16539 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16540 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16541 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16542 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16543 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16544
16545 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16546 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16547 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16548 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16549 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16550 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16551 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16552 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16553
16554
16555 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16556 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16557 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16558 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16559 live with.
16560
16561
16562 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16563 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16564 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16565 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16566 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16567 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16568 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16569 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16570 . the option name to split.
16571
16572 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16573 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16574 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16575 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16576 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16577 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16578 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16579 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16580 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16581 seen).
16582
16583
16584 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16585 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16586 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16587 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16588 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16589 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16590 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16591 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16592 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16593 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16594 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16595
16596 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16597 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16598 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16599 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16600 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16601 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16602
16603
16604
16605 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16606 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16607 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16608 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16609 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16610 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16611 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16612 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16613 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16614 to all messages received in the same connection.
16615
16616 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16617 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16618 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16619 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16620
16621
16622 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16623
16624 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16625 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16626 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16627 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16628 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16629 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16630 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16631 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16632 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16633 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16634 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16635 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16636 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16637
16638
16639 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16640 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16641 .cindex "host" "reserved"
16642 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16643 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16644 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16645 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16646 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16647 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16648 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16649 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16650 individual host.
16651
16652 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16653 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16654 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16655 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16656
16657
16658 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16659 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16660 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16661 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16662 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16663 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16664 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16665 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16666 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16667
16668 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16669 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16670 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16671 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16672
16673 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16674 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16675 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16676 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16677 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16678 For example:
16679 .code
16680 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16681 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16682 .endd
16683
16684 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16685 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16686 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16687 &%helo_data%& value.
16688
16689 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16690 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16691 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
16692 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16693 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16694 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16695 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16696 .code
16697 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16698 $version_number $tod_full
16699 .endd
16700 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16701 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16702 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16703 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16704 multiline response).
16705
16706
16707 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16708 .cindex "checking disk space"
16709 .cindex "disk space, checking"
16710 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16711 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16712 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16713 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16714 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16715 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16716
16717
16718 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16719 .cindex "connection backlog"
16720 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16721 .cindex "backlog of connections"
16722 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16723 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16724 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16725 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16726 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16727 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16728 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16729 attacks by SYN flooding.
16730
16731
16732 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16733 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16734 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16735 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16736 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16737 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16738 fewer, but they still exist.
16739
16740 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16741 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16742 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16743 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16744 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16745 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16746 does detect many instances.
16747
16748 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16749 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16750 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16751 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16752
16753
16754
16755 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16756 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16757 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16758 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16759 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16760 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16761 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16762 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16763 example:
16764 .code
16765 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16766 $sender_host_address
16767 .endd
16768 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16769 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16770 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16771 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16772 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16773 the command.
16774
16775
16776 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16777 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16778 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16779 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16780 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16781
16782
16783 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16784 .cindex "load average"
16785 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16786 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16787 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16788 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16789 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16790 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16791
16792
16793
16794 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16795 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16796 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16797 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16798 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16799 .code
16800 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16801 .endd
16802 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16803 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16804 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16805 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16806 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16807
16808 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16809 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16810 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16811 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16812 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16813 not count towards the limit.
16814
16815
16816
16817 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16818 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16819 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16820 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16821 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16822 that subvert web
16823 clients
16824 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16825 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16826
16827
16828
16829 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16830 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16831 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16832 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16833 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16834 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16835 recipients.
16836
16837 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16838 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16839 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16840 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16841
16842 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16843 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16844 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16845 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16846 values:
16847
16848 .ilist
16849 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16850 .next
16851 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16852 fractional parts are allowed here.
16853 .next
16854 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16855 .next
16856 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16857 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16858 .endlist
16859
16860 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16861 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16862 .code
16863 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16864 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16865 .endd
16866 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16867 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16868 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16869 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16870
16871
16872 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16873 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16874
16875
16876 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16877 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16878
16879
16880 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16881 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16882 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16883 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16884 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16885 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16886 the message is abandoned.
16887 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16888 .code
16889 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16890 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16891 .endd
16892 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16893 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16894
16895 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16896 expanded before use and may depend on
16897 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16898
16899
16900 .oindex "&%-os%&"
16901 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16902 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16903 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16904 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16905 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16906
16907
16908 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16909 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16910 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16911
16912
16913 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16914 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16915 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16916 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16917 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16918 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16919 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16920 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16921 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16922 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16923 .code
16924 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16925 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16926 .endd
16927
16928
16929 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16930 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
16931 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
16932 the availability thereof is advertised in
16933 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16934 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
16935
16936
16937 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
16938 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16939 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16940 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16941
16942
16943
16944 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
16945 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
16946 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
16947
16948
16949
16950 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16951 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16952 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16953 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16954 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16955 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16956 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16957 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16958 arrival of the message.
16959
16960 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16961 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16962 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16963 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16964 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16965
16966 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16967 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16968 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16969 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16970 automatically deleted.
16971
16972 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16973 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16974 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16975 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16976 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16977 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16978 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16979 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16980 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16981
16982
16983 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16984 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16985 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16986 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16987 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16988 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16989 &$primary_hostname$&.
16990
16991 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16992 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16993 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16994 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16995 as failures in the configuration file.
16996
16997 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16998 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16999
17000 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
17001 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
17002 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
17003 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
17004 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
17005 Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
17006 option.
17007
17008 The following variables will not have useful values:
17009 .code
17010 $max_received_linelength
17011 $body_linecount
17012 $body_zerocount
17013 .endd
17014
17015 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
17016 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
17017 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
17018 will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
17019
17020 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
17021 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
17022 The transmission benefit is maintained.
17023
17024 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
17025 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
17026 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
17027 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
17028
17029 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
17030 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
17031 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
17032 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17033 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17034 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17035
17036 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17037 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17038 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17039 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17040 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17041 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17042 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17043
17044
17045 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17046 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17047 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17048 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17049 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17050 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17051 domain causes a syntax error.
17052 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17053 syntax checking.
17054
17055
17056 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17057 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17058 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17059 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17060 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17061 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17062 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17063 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17064 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17065 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17066 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17067 the LOG_ALERT priority.
17068
17069
17070 .option syslog_facility main string unset
17071 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17072 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17073 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17074 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17075 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17076 details of Exim's logging.
17077
17078
17079 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
17080 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
17081 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17082 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17083 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17084 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17085 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17086
17087
17088
17089 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17090 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17091 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17092 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17093 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17094
17095
17096
17097 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17098 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17099 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17100 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17101 details of Exim's logging.
17102
17103
17104 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
17105 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
17106 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17107 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17108 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17109 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17110 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17111 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17112 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17113 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17114 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17115 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17116
17117
17118 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17119 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
17120 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17121 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17122 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17123 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17124
17125
17126 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17127 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17128 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17129 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17130 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17131
17132 .option system_filter_group main string unset
17133 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17134 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17135 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17136 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17137
17138 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17139 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17140 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17141 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17142 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17143 contains the pipe command.
17144
17145
17146 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17147 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17148 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17149 is used in a system filter.
17150
17151
17152 .option system_filter_user main string unset
17153 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17154 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17155 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17156 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17157 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17158 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17159 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17160 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17161 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17162
17163 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17164 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17165 transport option overrides.
17166
17167
17168 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17169 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17170 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17171 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17172 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17173 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17174 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17175 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17176 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17177 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17178 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17179 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17180 TCP_NODELAY.
17181
17182
17183 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17184 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17185 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17186 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17187 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
17188 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17189 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17190 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17191 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17192 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17193
17194 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17195 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17196 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17197
17198
17199 .option timezone main string unset
17200 .cindex "timezone, setting"
17201 .cindex "environment" "values from"
17202 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17203 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17204 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17205 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17206 .code
17207 timezone = UTC
17208 .endd
17209 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17210 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17211 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17212 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17213 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17214 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17215
17216
17217 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17218 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17219 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17220 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17221 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17222 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17223 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17224 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17225 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17226 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17227 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17228
17229
17230 .option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17231 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17232 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17233 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17234 files which contains the server's certificates. Commonly only one file is
17235 needed.
17236 The server's private key is also
17237 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17238 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17239
17240 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17241 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17242 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17243 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17244
17245 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17246 separator in the usual way to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17247
17248 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
17249 when a list of more than one
17250 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17251
17252 &*Note*&: OCSP stapling is not usable under OpenSSL
17253 when a list of more than one file is used.
17254
17255 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17256 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17257 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17258 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17259
17260 If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17261 generated for every connection.
17262
17263 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17264 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17265 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17266 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17267 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17268
17269 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17270
17271 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17272 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17273 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17274
17275 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17276
17277
17278 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17279 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17280 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17281 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17282 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17283 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17284
17285 The value must be at least 1024.
17286
17287 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17288 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17289 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17290
17291 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17292 number.
17293
17294 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17295 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17296 larger prime than requested.
17297
17298
17299 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17300 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17301 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17302 to be used by Exim.
17303
17304 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
17305 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17306 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17307 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17308
17309 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17310 then it names a file from which DH
17311 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17312 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17313 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17314 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17315 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17316 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17317
17318 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17319 loaded by Exim.
17320
17321 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17322 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17323 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17324 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17325
17326 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17327 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17328
17329 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
17330 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17331 in IKE is assigned number 23.
17332
17333 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17334 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17335 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17336 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17337 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17338
17339 The available standard primes are:
17340 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17341 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17342 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17343 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17344
17345 The available additional primes are:
17346 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17347
17348 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17349 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17350 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17351 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17352 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17353
17354 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17355 they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17356 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17357
17358 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17359 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17360 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17361 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17362 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17363 userbase.
17364
17365 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17366 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17367 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17368 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17369 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17370 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17371 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17372
17373
17374 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17375 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17376 This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17377 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17378
17379 After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17380 &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17381 for valid selections.
17382
17383 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17384 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17385 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17386
17387 If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17388
17389
17390 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17391 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
17392 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17393 This option
17394 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17395 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17396 Certificate Authority.
17397
17398 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17399
17400 For GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17401 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17402 The ordering of the two lists must match.
17403
17404
17405 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17406 .cindex SSMTP
17407 .cindex SMTPS
17408 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17409 operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17410 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17411 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17412
17413
17414
17415 .option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17416 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17417 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17418 files which contains the server's private keys.
17419 If this option is unset, or if
17420 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17421 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17422 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17423
17424 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17425
17426
17427 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17428 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17429 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17430 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17431 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17432 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17433 TLS session.
17434
17435
17436 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17437 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17438 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17439 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17440 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17441 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17442 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17443 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17444 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17445 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17446 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17447
17448
17449 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17450 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17451 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17452 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17453
17454
17455 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17456 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17457 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17458 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17459 word "system"
17460 or the absolute path to
17461 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17462 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17463
17464 The "system" value for the option will use a
17465 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17466 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17467 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17468 must be specified.
17469
17470 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17471 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17472
17473 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17474 explicitly
17475 either by file or directory
17476 are added to those given by the system default location.
17477
17478 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17479 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17480 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17481 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17482 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17483 use the explicit directory version.
17484
17485 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17486
17487 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17488 being unset.
17489
17490
17491 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17492 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17493 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17494 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17495 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17496 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17497 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17498 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17499
17500 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17501 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17502 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17503 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17504 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17505 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17506 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17507
17508 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17509 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17510 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17511 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17512 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17513 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17514 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17515 certificate"&.
17516
17517 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17518 certificates.
17519
17520
17521 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17522 .cindex "trusted groups"
17523 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
17524 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17525 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17526 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17527 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17528 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17529 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17530 are trusted.
17531
17532 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17533 .cindex "trusted users"
17534 .cindex "user" "trusted"
17535 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17536 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17537 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17538 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17539 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17540 Exim user are trusted.
17541
17542 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17543 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17544 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17545 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17546 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17547 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17548 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17549 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17550 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17551 &%-F%& option.
17552
17553 .option unknown_username main string unset
17554 See &%unknown_login%&.
17555
17556 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17557 .cindex "trusted users"
17558 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17559 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17560 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17561 .cindex "envelope sender"
17562 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
17563 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
17564 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
17565 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
17566 is used) is ignored.
17567
17568 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
17569 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
17570 .code
17571 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
17572 .endd
17573 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
17574 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
17575 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
17576 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
17577 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
17578 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
17579 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
17580 followed by a hyphen
17581 by a setting like this:
17582 .code
17583 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
17584 .endd
17585 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
17586 restriction, you can use
17587 .code
17588 untrusted_set_sender = *
17589 .endd
17590 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
17591 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
17592 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
17593 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
17594 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
17595 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
17596 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
17597 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
17598
17599 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
17600 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
17601 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
17602 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
17603 sender address.
17604
17605
17606 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
17607 .cindex "&""From""& line"
17608 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
17609 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
17610 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
17611 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
17612 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
17613 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
17614 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
17615 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
17616 .code
17617 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
17618 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
17619 .endd
17620 The pattern can be seen by running
17621 .code
17622 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
17623 .endd
17624 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
17625 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
17626 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
17627 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
17628 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
17629 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
17630
17631
17632 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
17633 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
17634
17635
17636 .option warn_message_file main string unset
17637 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
17638 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
17639 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
17640 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
17641 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
17642 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
17643 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
17644
17645
17646 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
17647 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
17648 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
17649 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
17650 .ecindex IIDconfima
17651 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
17652
17653
17654
17655
17656 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17657 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17658
17659 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
17660 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
17661 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
17662 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
17663 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
17664
17665 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
17666 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
17667 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
17668 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
17669 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
17670
17671
17672
17673 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
17674 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17675 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17676 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17677 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17678 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17679 delivery of the address to be deferred.
17680
17681 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17682 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17683 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17684 routers, and the eventual transport.
17685
17686 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17687 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17688 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17689 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17690 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17691
17692 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17693 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17694 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17695 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17696 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17697
17698 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17699 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17700 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17701 .code
17702 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17703 .endd
17704 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17705 .code
17706 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17707 .endd
17708 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17709 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17710
17711 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17712 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17713 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17714 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17715 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17716 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17717 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17718
17719
17720
17721 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17722 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
17723 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17724 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17725 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17726 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17727 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17728 routing.
17729
17730
17731
17732 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17733 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17734 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17735 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17736 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17737 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17738 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17739 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17740 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17741 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17742 you could put:
17743 .code
17744 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17745 .endd
17746 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17747 and
17748 .code
17749 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17750 .endd
17751 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17752 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17753 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17754 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17755
17756
17757 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17758 .cindex "case of local parts"
17759 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17760 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17761 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17762 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17763 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17764 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17765 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17766 more details.
17767
17768 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17769 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17770 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17771 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17772 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17773 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17774 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17775 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17776 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17777
17778 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17779 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17780 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17781 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17782
17783
17784
17785 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17786 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
17787 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17788 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17789 .vindex "&$home$&"
17790 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17791 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17792 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17793 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17794 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17795 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17796 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17797 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17798 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17799 the router is skipped.
17800
17801 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17802 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17803 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17804 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17805 setting to achieve this. For example:
17806 .code
17807 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17808 .endd
17809 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17810 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17811 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17812
17813
17814
17815 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17816 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17817 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17818 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17819 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17820 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17821 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17822 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17823
17824 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17825 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17826
17827 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17828 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17829
17830 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17831 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17832 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17833 .code
17834 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17835 .endd
17836 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17837 .code
17838 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17839 .endd
17840
17841 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17842 .code
17843 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17844 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17845 condition = foobar
17846 .endd
17847
17848 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17849 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17850 be specified using &%condition%&.
17851
17852 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17853 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17854 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17855 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17856 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17857 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17858 Router rules processing behavior.
17859
17860 This is best illustrated in an example:
17861 .code
17862 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17863 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17864
17865 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17866 true {yes} {no}}
17867
17868 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17869 {yes} {no}}
17870 .endd
17871 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17872 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17873 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17874 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17875 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17876 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17877 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17878 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17879
17880 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17881 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17882 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17883 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17884 string characters.
17885
17886 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17887 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17888 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17889 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17890 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17891
17892
17893 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17894 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17895 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17896 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17897 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17898 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17899 output, and Exim carries on processing.
17900 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17901 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17902 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17903 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17904 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17905 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17906 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17907
17908
17909
17910 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
17911 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17912 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17913 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17914 transport option of the same name.
17915
17916 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17917 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17918 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17919 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17920 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17921 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17922 the dnssec request bit set.
17923 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17924
17925 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17926 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17927 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17928 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17929 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17930 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
17931 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17932 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17933 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17934
17935
17936 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17937 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17938 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17939 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17940 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17941 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17942 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17943 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17944
17945
17946
17947 .option driver routers string unset
17948 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17949 to be used.
17950
17951
17952 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17953 .cindex "DSN" "success"
17954 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17955 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17956 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17957 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17958 Not effective on redirect routers.
17959
17960
17961
17962 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17963 .cindex "envelope sender"
17964 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17965 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17966 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17967 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17968 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17969 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17970 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17971
17972 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17973 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17974 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17975 setting.
17976
17977 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17978 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17979 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17980 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17981
17982 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17983 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17984 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17985 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17986 settings:
17987 .code
17988 errors_to =
17989 errors_to = ""
17990 .endd
17991 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17992 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17993 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17994 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17995 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17996
17997 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17998 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17999 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
18000 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
18001 setting &%return_path%&.
18002
18003 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
18004 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
18005 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
18006
18007
18008
18009 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
18010 .cindex "address" "testing"
18011 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
18012 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
18013 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
18014 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
18015 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
18016 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
18017 on for the system alias file.
18018 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18019 are evaluated.
18020
18021 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
18022 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
18023 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
18024
18025
18026
18027 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
18028 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
18029 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18030 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18031
18032
18033
18034 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18035 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18036 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18037
18038
18039
18040 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18041 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18042 verifying a sender, verification fails.
18043
18044
18045
18046 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18047 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18048 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18049 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18050 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18051 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
18052 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18053 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18054 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18055
18056 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18057 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18058 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18059 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18060 transport for further details.
18061
18062
18063 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
18064 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18065 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18066 .cindex "transport" "local"
18067 .cindex "router" "setting group"
18068 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18069 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18070 process.
18071 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18072 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18073 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18074 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18075 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18076
18077
18078
18079 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18080 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
18081 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18082 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18083 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
18084 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18085 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18086 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18087 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18088 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18089 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18090 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18091 &"see"& the added header lines.
18092
18093 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18094 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18095 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18096 failures are treated as configuration errors.
18097
18098 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18099 for a router; all listed headers are added.
18100
18101 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18102 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18103
18104 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18105 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
18106 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18107 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18108 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18109 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18110 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18111 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18112 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18113 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18114
18115
18116
18117 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18118 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18119 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18120 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18121 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
18122 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18123 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18124 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18125 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18126 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18127 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18128 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18129 &"see"& the original header lines.
18130
18131 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
18132 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18133 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18134 errors.
18135
18136 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18137 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18138
18139 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18140 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18141
18142 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18143 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18144 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18145 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18146
18147 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18148 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18149 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18150
18151
18152
18153 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18154 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18155 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18156 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18157 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18158 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18159 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18160 like
18161 .code
18162 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18163 .endd
18164 by setting
18165 .code
18166 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18167 .endd
18168 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18169 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18170 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18171 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18172 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18173 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18174
18175 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18176 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18177 .code
18178 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18179 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18180 .endd
18181 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18182 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18183
18184 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18185 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18186 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18187 domain that is being routed.
18188
18189 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18190 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18191 checked.
18192
18193 .option initgroups routers boolean false
18194 .cindex "additional groups"
18195 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18196 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18197 .cindex "transport" "local"
18198 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18199 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18200 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18201 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18202 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18203
18204
18205
18206 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18207 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18208 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18209 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18210 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18211 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18212 evaluated.
18213
18214 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18215 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18216 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18217 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18218 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18219 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18220 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18221 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18222 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18223
18224 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18225 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18226 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18227 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18228 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18229 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18230 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18231 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18232 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18233 the relevant transport.
18234
18235 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18236 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18237 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18238 callout.
18239
18240 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18241 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18242 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18243 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18244 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18245 .code
18246 real_localuser:
18247 driver = accept
18248 local_part_prefix = real-
18249 check_local_user
18250 transport = local_delivery
18251 .endd
18252 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18253 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18254 .code
18255 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18256 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18257 .endd
18258
18259 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18260 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18261 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18262 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18263
18264
18265 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18266 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18267
18268
18269
18270 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18271 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18272 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18273 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18274 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18275 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18276 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18277 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18278 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18279 &%username-foo%&.
18280
18281
18282 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18283 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18284
18285
18286
18287 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18288 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18289 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18290 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18291 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18292 are evaluated, and
18293 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18294 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18295 example:
18296 .code
18297 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18298 .endd
18299 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18300 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18301 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18302 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18303 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18304 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18305 each virtual domain:
18306 .code
18307 postmaster:
18308 driver = redirect
18309 local_parts = postmaster
18310 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18311 .endd
18312
18313
18314 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18315 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
18316 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18317 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18318 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18319 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18320 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18321 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18322 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18323 redirect addresses.
18324
18325
18326
18327 .option more routers boolean&!! true
18328 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18329 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18330 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18331 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18332 delivery to be deferred.
18333
18334 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18335 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18336 .oindex "&%self%&"
18337 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18338 means of the setting
18339 .code
18340 self = pass
18341 .endd
18342 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18343 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18344 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18345
18346 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18347 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18348 controls what happens next.
18349
18350
18351 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18352 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
18353 .cindex "router" "timeout"
18354 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18355 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18356 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18357 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18358 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18359
18360 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18361 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18362 applies to all of them.
18363
18364
18365
18366 .option pass_router routers string unset
18367 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18368 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18369 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18370 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18371 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18372 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18373 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18374 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18375 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18376 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18377
18378
18379
18380 .option redirect_router routers string unset
18381 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18382 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18383 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18384 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18385 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18386
18387 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18388 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18389 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18390 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18391
18392
18393
18394 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18395 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18396 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18397 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18398 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18399 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18400 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18401
18402 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18403 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
18404 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18405 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18406
18407 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18408 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18409 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18410 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18411 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18412
18413 .cindex "NFS"
18414 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18415 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18416 unavailable.
18417
18418 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18419 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18420 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18421 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18422 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18423 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18424 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18425 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
18426
18427 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18428 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18429 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18430 operates as follows:
18431
18432 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18433 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18434 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18435 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18436 used. For example:
18437 .code
18438 require_files = mail:/some/file
18439 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18440 .endd
18441 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18442 &%require_files%& condition fails.
18443
18444 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18445 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18446 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18447 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18448
18449 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18450 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18451 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18452 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18453 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18454
18455 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18456 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18457 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18458 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18459 check again in that process.
18460
18461 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18462 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18463 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18464 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18465 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
18466 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18467 as if the file did not exist. For example:
18468 .code
18469 require_files = +/some/file
18470 .endd
18471 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18472 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18473 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18474
18475
18476
18477 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18478 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18479 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18480 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18481 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18482 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18483 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18484 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18485 latter kind.
18486
18487 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18488 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18489 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
18490 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18491 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18492 same name.
18493
18494 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18495 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18496 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18497
18498
18499
18500 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18501 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
18502 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
18503 .vindex "&$home$&"
18504 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18505 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18506 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18507 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18508 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18509 cause the router to defer.
18510
18511 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18512 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18513 place.
18514 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18515 are evaluated.)
18516 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18517 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18518
18519 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18520 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18521 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18522 of these values that is set:
18523
18524 .ilist
18525 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18526 .next
18527 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18528 .next
18529 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18530 .next
18531 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18532 .endlist
18533
18534 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18535 router, but not for the transport.
18536
18537
18538
18539 .option self routers string freeze
18540 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18541 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18542 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
18543 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
18544 and &(manualroute)& routers.
18545 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
18546 of remote hosts.
18547 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
18548 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
18549 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
18550 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
18551 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18552
18553 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
18554 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
18555 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
18556 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
18557 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
18558 cases:
18559
18560 .vlist
18561 .vitem &%defer%&
18562 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
18563
18564 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
18565 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
18566 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
18567 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
18568
18569 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
18570 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
18571 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
18572 rewritten.
18573
18574 .vitem &%pass%&
18575 .oindex "&%more%&"
18576 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
18577 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
18578 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
18579 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
18580 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
18581 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
18582 combination
18583 .code
18584 self = pass
18585 no_more
18586 .endd
18587 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
18588 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
18589 be passed to the next router.
18590
18591 .vitem &%fail%&
18592 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
18593
18594 .vitem &%send%&
18595 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
18596 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
18597 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
18598 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
18599 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
18600 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
18601 .endlist
18602
18603
18604
18605 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
18606 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
18607 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
18608 address matches something on the list.
18609 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18610 are evaluated.
18611
18612 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
18613 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
18614 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
18615 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
18616 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
18617 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
18618 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
18619 matters.
18620
18621
18622 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
18623 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
18624 .cindex "packet radio"
18625 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
18626 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
18627 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
18628 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
18629 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
18630 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
18631 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
18632 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
18633
18634 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18635 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
18636 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
18637 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
18638 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
18639 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
18640 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
18641 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
18642 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
18643 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
18644 .code
18645 translate_ip_address = \
18646 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
18647 {$value}fail}}
18648 .endd
18649 The file would contain lines like
18650 .code
18651 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
18652 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
18653 .endd
18654 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
18655 are doing.
18656
18657
18658
18659 .option transport routers string&!! unset
18660 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
18661 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
18662 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
18663 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
18664 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
18665 delivery is deferred.
18666
18667 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18668 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18669 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18670
18671
18672
18673 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18674 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18675 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18676 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18677 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18678 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18679 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18680 overridden by a setting on the transport.
18681 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18682 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18683 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18684 environment.
18685
18686
18687
18688
18689 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18690 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18691 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18692 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18693 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18694 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18695 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18696 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18697 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18698 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18699
18700 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18701 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18702 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18703 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18704 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18705
18706 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18707 environment.
18708
18709
18710
18711
18712 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18713 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18714 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18715 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18716 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18717 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18718 delivery to be deferred.
18719
18720 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18721 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18722 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18723 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18724 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18725 sometimes true and sometimes false).
18726
18727 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18728 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18729 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18730 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18731 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18732 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18733 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18734 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18735
18736 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18737 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18738 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18739 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18740 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18741 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18742 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18743 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18744 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18745 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18746
18747 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18748 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18749 subsequent routers.
18750
18751
18752 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
18753 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18754 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18755 .cindex "transport" "local"
18756 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18757 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18758 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18759 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18760 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18761 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18762 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18763 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18764 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18765 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18766 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18767 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18768
18769
18770
18771 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
18772 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18773 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18774
18775
18776 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18777 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18778 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
18779 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18780 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18781 delivering in cutthrough mode or
18782 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18783 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18784 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18785 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18786
18787 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18788 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18789 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18790 user or group.
18791
18792
18793 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18794 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18795 addresses,
18796 delivering in cutthrough mode
18797 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18798 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18799 are evaluated.
18800 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18801
18802
18803 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18804 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18805 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18806 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18807 are evaluated.
18808 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18809 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18810 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18811
18812
18813
18814
18815
18816
18817 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18818 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18819
18820 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18821 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
18822 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18823 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18824 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18825 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18826 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18827 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18828 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18829 .code
18830 localusers:
18831 driver = accept
18832 domains = mydomain.example
18833 check_local_user
18834 transport = local_delivery
18835 .endd
18836 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18837 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18838 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18839 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18840
18841
18842
18843
18844
18845
18846 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18847 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18848
18849 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18850 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18851 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18852 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18853 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18854 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18855
18856 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18857 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18858 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18859 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18860 records.
18861
18862 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18863 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18864 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18865 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18866 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18867 generic option, the router declines.
18868
18869 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18870 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18871 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18872
18873 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18874 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18875 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18876 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18877 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18878 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18879
18880
18881 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18882 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18883 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18884 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18885 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18886 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18887
18888 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18889 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18890 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18891 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18892 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18893 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18894 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18895 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18896 case routing fails.
18897
18898
18899 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18900 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18901 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18902 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18903 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18904
18905 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18906 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18907
18908 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18909 .ilist
18910 The domain does not exist in DNS
18911 .next
18912 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18913 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18914 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18915 .next
18916 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18917 .next
18918 MX record points to a non-existent host.
18919 .next
18920 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18921 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18922 .next
18923 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18924 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18925 .next
18926 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18927 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18928 .next
18929 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18930 not be found in the MX records (see below)
18931 .endlist
18932
18933
18934
18935
18936 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18937 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18938 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18939
18940 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18941 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18942 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18943 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18944 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18945 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18946 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18947
18948
18949 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18950 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18951 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18952 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18953 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18954 required. For example,
18955 .code
18956 check_srv = smtp
18957 .endd
18958 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18959 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18960 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18961 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18962 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18963 normal way.
18964
18965 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18966 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18967 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18968 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18969 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18970 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18971
18972 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18973 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18974 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18975 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18976 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18977 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18978 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18979 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18980
18981 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18982 when there is a DNS lookup error.
18983
18984
18985
18986
18987 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18988 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
18989 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18990 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18991 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18992 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18993 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18994 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18995 also being queued.
18996
18997
18998 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
18999 .cindex IPv6 disabling
19000 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
19001 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19002 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19003 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19004 only A records are used.
19005
19006 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
19007 .cindex IPv4 preference
19008 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
19009 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19010 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19011 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19012 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
19013
19014 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19015 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
19016 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
19017 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
19018 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
19019 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
19020 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
19021 setting:
19022 .code
19023 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
19024 .endd
19025 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
19026 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
19027 the address record.
19028
19029
19030 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19031 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19032 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19033 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19034
19035
19036
19037
19038 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19039 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19040 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19041 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19042 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19043 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19044 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19045 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19046 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19047 &'resolv.conf'&.
19048
19049
19050
19051 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19052 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19053 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19054 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19055 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19056 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19057 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19058 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19059 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19060 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19061 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19062
19063 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19064 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19065 sense.
19066
19067 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19068 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19069 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19070 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19071 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19072 header rewriting.
19073
19074
19075 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19076 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19077 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19078 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19079 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19080 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19081 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19082 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19083
19084 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19085 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19086 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19087 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19088 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19089 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19090 without processing them independently,
19091 provided the following conditions are met:
19092
19093 .ilist
19094 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19095 &%headers_remove%&.
19096 .next
19097 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19098 the domain.
19099 .endlist
19100
19101
19102
19103
19104 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19105 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19106 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19107 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19108 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19109 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19110 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19111 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19112 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19113 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19114
19115 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19116 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19117 local wildcard.
19118
19119
19120
19121 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19122 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19123 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19124 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19125
19126
19127
19128
19129 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19130 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19131 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19132 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19133 if
19134 .code
19135 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19136 .endd
19137 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19138 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19139 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19140 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19141 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19142 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19143
19144
19145 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19146 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19147 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19148 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19149 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19150
19151 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19152 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19153 such as that implied by
19154 .code
19155 domains = @mx_any
19156 .endd
19157 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19158 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19159 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19160 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19161
19162
19163
19164
19165
19166
19167
19168
19169
19170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19171 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19172
19173 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19174 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19175 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19176 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19177 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19178 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19179 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19180 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19181 router handles the address
19182 .code
19183 root@[192.168.1.1]
19184 .endd
19185 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19186 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19187 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19188 .code
19189 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19190 .endd
19191 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19192 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19193
19194 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19195 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19196 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19197 &%self%& option determines what happens.
19198
19199 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19200 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19201 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19202 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19203
19204
19205
19206 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19207 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19208
19209 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19210 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19211 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19212 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19213 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19214 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19215 must set
19216 .code
19217 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19218 .endd
19219 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19220
19221 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19222 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19223 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19224 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19225 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19226 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19227 must not be specified for it.
19228
19229 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19230 .option hosts iplookup string unset
19231 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19232 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19233 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19234 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19235 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19236
19237
19238 .option optional iplookup boolean false
19239 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19240 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19241 delivery to the address is deferred.
19242
19243
19244 .option port iplookup integer 0
19245 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19246 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19247 call.
19248
19249
19250 .option protocol iplookup string udp
19251 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19252 protocols is to be used.
19253
19254
19255 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19256 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19257 default value is:
19258 .code
19259 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19260 .endd
19261 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19262 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19263
19264
19265 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19266 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19267 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19268 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19269 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19270 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19271 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19272 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19273
19274
19275 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19276 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19277 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19278 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19279 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19280 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19281 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19282 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19283 following could be used:
19284 .code
19285 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19286 reroute = $local_part@$1
19287 .endd
19288
19289 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
19290 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19291 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19292 call. It does not apply to UDP.
19293
19294
19295
19296
19297 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19298 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19299
19300 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19301 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19302 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19303 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19304 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19305 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19306 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19307 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19308 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19309 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19310
19311 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19312 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19313 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19314 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19315 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19316 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19317 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19318
19319 .vindex "&$host$&"
19320 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19321 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19322 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19323 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19324 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19325 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19326 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19327 text string.
19328
19329 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19330 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19331 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19332 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19333 below, following the list of private options.
19334
19335
19336 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19337
19338 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19339 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19340
19341 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19342 See &%host_find_failed%&.
19343
19344 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19345 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19346 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19347 of the following values:
19348 .code
19349 decline
19350 defer
19351 fail
19352 freeze
19353 ignore
19354 pass
19355 .endd
19356 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19357 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19358 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19359 &%pass_router%&),
19360 .oindex "&%more%&"
19361 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19362 router only if &%more%& is true.
19363
19364 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19365 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19366 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19367 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19368
19369 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19370 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19371 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19372
19373
19374 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19375 .cindex "randomized host list"
19376 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19377 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19378 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19379 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19380 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19381 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19382 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19383 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19384
19385 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19386 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19387 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19388 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19389 .code
19390 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19391 .endd
19392 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19393 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19394 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19395 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19396 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19397
19398
19399 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19400 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19401 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19402 example:
19403 .code
19404 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19405 .endd
19406 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19407 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19408 deferred.
19409
19410
19411 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19412 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19413 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19414 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19415
19416
19417 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19418 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19419 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19420 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19421 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19422 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19423 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19424 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19425
19426 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19427 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19428 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19429 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19430 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19431 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19432 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19433 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19434
19435
19436
19437
19438 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19439 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19440 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19441 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19442 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19443 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19444 .display
19445 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19446 .endd
19447 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19448 no options:
19449 .code
19450 route_list = \
19451 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19452 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19453 .endd
19454 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19455 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19456 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19457 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19458 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19459 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19460 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19461 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19462 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19463 in a &%route_list%&).
19464
19465 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19466 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19467 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19468 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19469
19470
19471
19472 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19473 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19474 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19475 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19476 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19477 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19478 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19479 like this:
19480 .code
19481 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19482 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19483 .endd
19484 This data can be accessed by setting
19485 .code
19486 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19487 .endd
19488 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19489 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19490 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19491 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19492 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19493
19494
19495
19496
19497 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19498 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19499 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19500 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19501 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
19502 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19503 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19504
19505 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
19506 variables are set during its expansion:
19507
19508 .ilist
19509 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19510 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
19511 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
19512 .code
19513 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
19514 .endd
19515 .next
19516 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
19517 .next
19518 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
19519
19520 .next
19521 .vindex "&$value$&"
19522 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
19523 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
19524 .code
19525 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
19526 .endd
19527 .endlist
19528
19529 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
19530 semicolon is the default route list separator.
19531
19532
19533
19534 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
19535 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
19536 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
19537 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
19538 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
19539 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
19540
19541 .ilist
19542 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
19543 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
19544 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
19545 .code
19546 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
19547 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
19548 .endd
19549 .next
19550 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
19551 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
19552 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
19553 number follows. For example:
19554 .code
19555 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
19556 .endd
19557 .endlist
19558
19559 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
19560 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
19561 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
19562 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
19563 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
19564 transport.
19565
19566 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
19567 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
19568 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
19569 records in the DNS. For example:
19570 .code
19571 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
19572 .endd
19573 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
19574 example:
19575 .code
19576 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
19577 .endd
19578 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
19579 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
19580 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
19581 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
19582 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
19583 happens is controlled by the
19584 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19585 &%self%& option of the router.
19586
19587 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
19588 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
19589 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
19590 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
19591 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
19592 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
19593 defined by MX preferences.
19594
19595 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
19596 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
19597 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
19598
19599 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
19600 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
19601 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
19602 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
19603
19604 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
19605 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
19606 router.
19607
19608 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
19609 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
19610 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
19611
19612 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
19613 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
19614
19615
19616
19617 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
19618 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
19619 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
19620 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
19621 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
19622 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
19623 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
19624
19625 .ilist
19626 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
19627 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19628 .next
19629 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
19630 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19631 .next
19632 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
19633 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
19634 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
19635 .next
19636 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
19637 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
19638 timeout), delivery is deferred.
19639 .next
19640 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
19641 .next
19642 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
19643 .endlist
19644
19645 For example:
19646 .code
19647 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
19648 domain2 host4:host5
19649 .endd
19650 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
19651 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
19652 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
19653 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
19654 call.
19655
19656 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
19657 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
19658 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
19659 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
19660 function called.
19661
19662 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
19663 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
19664 option specified.
19665
19666
19667
19668 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
19669 &%host_find_failed%& option.
19670
19671 .vindex "&$host$&"
19672 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
19673 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
19674
19675
19676
19677 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
19678 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
19679 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
19680
19681 .ilist
19682 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
19683 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
19684 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
19685 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
19686 .code
19687 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
19688 .endd
19689 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
19690 your first router something like this:
19691 .code
19692 smart_route:
19693 driver = manualroute
19694 domains = !+local_domains
19695 transport = remote_smtp
19696 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
19697 .endd
19698 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
19699 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
19700 they are tried in order
19701 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19702 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19703 .code
19704 smart_route:
19705 driver = manualroute
19706 transport = remote_smtp
19707 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19708 .endd
19709 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19710 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19711 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19712 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19713 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19714 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19715 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19716 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19717
19718 .next
19719 .cindex "mail hub example"
19720 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19721 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19722 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19723 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19724 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19725 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19726 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19727 lookup is easier to manage.
19728
19729 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19730 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19731 example:
19732 .code
19733 hub_route:
19734 driver = manualroute
19735 transport = remote_smtp
19736 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19737 .endd
19738 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19739 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19740 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19741 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19742 domain can be used to find the host:
19743 .code
19744 through_firewall:
19745 driver = manualroute
19746 transport = remote_smtp
19747 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19748 .endd
19749 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19750 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19751 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19752 next router.
19753
19754 .next
19755 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19756 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19757 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19758 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19759 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19760 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19761 .code
19762 save_in_file:
19763 driver = manualroute
19764 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19765 route_list = saved.domain.example
19766 .endd
19767 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19768 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19769 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19770 .code
19771 save_in_file:
19772 driver = manualroute
19773 route_list = \
19774 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19775 *.saved.domain2.example \
19776 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19777 batch_pipe
19778 .endd
19779 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19780 .vindex "&$host$&"
19781 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19782 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19783 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19784 the address if the lookup fails.
19785
19786 .next
19787 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19788 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19789 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19790 one way it can be done:
19791 .code
19792 # Transport
19793 uucp:
19794 driver = pipe
19795 user = nobody
19796 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19797 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19798 return_fail_output = true
19799
19800 # Router
19801 uucphost:
19802 transport = uucp
19803 driver = manualroute
19804 route_data = \
19805 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19806 .endd
19807 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19808 .code
19809 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19810 .endd
19811 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19812 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19813 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19814 .endlist
19815 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
19816 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
19817
19818
19819
19820
19821
19822
19823
19824
19825 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19826 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19827
19828 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19829 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19830 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19831 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
19832 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19833 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19834 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19835 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19836 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19837 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19838 options:
19839 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19840
19841 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19842 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19843 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19844 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19845 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19846
19847
19848 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
19849 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19850 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19851 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19852 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19853 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19854
19855
19856 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
19857 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19858 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19859 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19860 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19861 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19862 not set, a value for the gid also.
19863
19864 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19865 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19866 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19867 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19868 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19869 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19870 gid.
19871
19872
19873 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
19874 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19875 before running the command.
19876
19877
19878 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19879 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19880 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19881 timeout.
19882
19883
19884 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19885 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19886 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19887 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19888 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19889
19890 .ilist
19891 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19892 below).
19893 .next
19894 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19895 &%no_more%& is set.
19896 .next
19897 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19898 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19899 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19900 included in the SMTP response.
19901 .next
19902 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19903 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19904 included in any SMTP response.
19905 .next
19906 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19907 .next
19908 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19909 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19910 .next
19911 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19912 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19913 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19914 .endlist
19915
19916 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19917 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19918 the page):
19919 .code
19920 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19921 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19922 .endd
19923 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19924 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19925 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19926 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19927
19928 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19929 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19930 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19931 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19932 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19933
19934 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19935 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19936 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19937 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19938 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19939
19940 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19941 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19942 variable. For example, this return line
19943 .code
19944 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19945 .endd
19946 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19947 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19948 .ecindex IIDquerou1
19949 .ecindex IIDquerou2
19950
19951
19952
19953
19954 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19955 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19956
19957 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19958 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19959 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19960 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19961 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19962 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19963 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19964 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19965 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19966 redirected in several different ways:
19967
19968 .ilist
19969 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19970 independently.
19971 .next
19972 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19973 .next
19974 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19975 .next
19976 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19977 .next
19978 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19979 .next
19980 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19981 .next
19982 It can be discarded.
19983 .endlist
19984
19985 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19986 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19987 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19988 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19989
19990 If success DSNs have been requested
19991 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19992 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19993 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19994
19995
19996
19997 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19998 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19999 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
20000 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
20001 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
20002 aliases, in a configuration like this:
20003 .code
20004 system_aliases:
20005 driver = redirect
20006 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
20007 .endd
20008 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
20009 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
20010 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
20011 cause delivery to be deferred.
20012
20013 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
20014 &_.forward_& files, like this:
20015 .code
20016 userforward:
20017 driver = redirect
20018 check_local_user
20019 file = $home/.forward
20020 no_verify
20021 .endd
20022 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
20023 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
20024 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
20025 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
20026 comments.
20027
20028
20029
20030 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20031 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20032 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20033 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20034
20035 .ilist
20036 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20037 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20038 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20039 practice the router may not be able to operate.
20040 .next
20041 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20042 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20043 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20044 saves some resources.
20045 .endlist
20046
20047
20048
20049
20050
20051
20052 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20053 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20054 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20055 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20056 can be interpreted in two different ways:
20057
20058 .ilist
20059 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20060 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20061 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20062 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20063 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20064 document is intended for use by end users.
20065 .next
20066 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20067 described in the next section.
20068 .endlist
20069
20070 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
20071 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20072 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20073 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20074 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20075
20076
20077
20078 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20079 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20080 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20081 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20082 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20083 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20084 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20085 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20086 commas or newlines.
20087 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20088 quotes.
20089
20090 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20091 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20092 next newline character is ignored.
20093
20094 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20095 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20096 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20097 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20098 removed.
20099
20100 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20101 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20102 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20103 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20104 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20105 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20106 setting:
20107 .code
20108 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20109 .endd
20110
20111
20112 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20113 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
20114 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20115 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20116 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20117 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20118 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20119 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20120 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20121 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20122 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20123
20124 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20125 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20126 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20127 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20128 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20129 .code
20130 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20131 .endd
20132 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
20133 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20134 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20135 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20136 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20137 synonymously.
20138
20139 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
20140 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20141 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20142 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20143 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20144
20145 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20146 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20147 contains:
20148 .code
20149 Sam.Reman: spqr
20150 .endd
20151 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20152 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20153 this forward file:
20154 .code
20155 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20156 .endd
20157 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20158 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20159 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20160 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20161 should really contain
20162 .code
20163 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20164 .endd
20165 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20166 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20167 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20168
20169
20170
20171 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20172 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20173 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20174
20175 .ilist
20176 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20177 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20178 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20179 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20180 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20181 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20182 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20183
20184 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20185 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20186 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20187 in double quotes, for example:
20188 .code
20189 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20190 .endd
20191 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20192 quote just the command. An item such as
20193 .code
20194 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20195 .endd
20196 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20197
20198 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20199 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20200 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20201 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20202 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20203 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20204 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20205 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20206 an &%accept%& router.
20207
20208 .next
20209 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20210 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20211 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20212 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20213 .code
20214 /home/world/minbari
20215 .endd
20216 is treated as a file name, but
20217 .code
20218 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20219 .endd
20220 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
20221 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20222 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20223 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20224
20225 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20226 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20227
20228 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20229 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20230 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20231 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20232
20233 .next
20234 .cindex "included address list"
20235 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20236 If an item is of the form
20237 .code
20238 :include:<path name>
20239 .endd
20240 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20241 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20242 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20243 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20244 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20245 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20246 .code
20247 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20248 .endd
20249 It must be given as
20250 .code
20251 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20252 .endd
20253 .next
20254 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20255 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
20256 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20257 .cindex "black hole"
20258 .cindex "abandoning mail"
20259 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20260 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20261 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20262 .code
20263 :blackhole:
20264 .endd
20265 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20266 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20267 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20268
20269 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20270 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20271 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20272 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20273 &_/dev/null_&.
20274
20275 .next
20276 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20277 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20278 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20279 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20280 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20281 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20282 redirection items of the form
20283 .code
20284 :defer:
20285 :fail:
20286 .endd
20287 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20288 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20289 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20290 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20291 .code
20292 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20293 .endd
20294 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20295 of a
20296 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20297 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20298 default.
20299 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20300 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20301 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20302
20303 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20304 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20305 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20306 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20307 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20308 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20309 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20310 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20311 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20312 ignored.
20313
20314 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20315 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20316 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20317 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20318
20319 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20320 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20321 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20322 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20323 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20324
20325 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20326 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20327 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
20328 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20329 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20330 rules still apply.
20331
20332 .next
20333 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20334 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20335 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20336 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20337 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20338 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20339 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20340 .endlist
20341
20342
20343 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20344 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
20345 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20346 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20347 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20348 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20349 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20350 aliasing scheme of the type
20351 .code
20352 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20353 localpart1: pipe
20354 localpart2: pipe
20355 .endd
20356 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20357 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20358 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20359 such as
20360 .code
20361 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20362 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20363 .endd
20364 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20365 the pipes are distinct.
20366
20367
20368
20369 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20370 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20371 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20372 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20373 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20374 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20375 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20376 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20377 can be used to avoid this.
20378
20379
20380 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20381 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20382 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20383 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20384 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20385 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20386 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20387
20388
20389
20390 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20391
20392 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20393 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20394
20395
20396 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20397 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20398 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20399
20400
20401 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20402 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20403 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20404 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20405
20406
20407 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20408 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20409 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20410 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20411 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20412 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20413 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20414
20415 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20416 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20417
20418
20419 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20420 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20421 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20422 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20423 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20424
20425
20426
20427 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20428 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20429 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20430 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20431 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20432 let ordinary users do.
20433
20434
20435
20436 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20437 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20438 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20439 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20440 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20441 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20442
20443 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20444 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20445 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20446 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20447 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20448 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20449 .code
20450 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20451 .endd
20452 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20453 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20454 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20455 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20456 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20457 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20458 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20459 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20460
20461
20462 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20463 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20464 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20465 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20466 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
20467 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
20468 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
20469 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
20470
20471
20472
20473 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
20474 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
20475 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
20476 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
20477 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
20478 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
20479
20480
20481 .option data redirect string&!! unset
20482 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20483 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20484 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20485 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20486 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20487
20488 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20489 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20490 terminated with newline characters. For example:
20491 .code
20492 data = #Exim filter\n\
20493 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20494 .endd
20495 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20496 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20497 choice into a newline.
20498
20499
20500 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20501 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20502 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20503 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20504 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
20505
20506
20507 .option file redirect string&!! unset
20508 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
20509 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
20510 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
20511 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
20512 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
20513 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
20514 entirely of comments), the router declines.
20515
20516 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
20517 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
20518 runs a check on the containing directory,
20519 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
20520 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
20521 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
20522 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
20523 not, the router declines.
20524
20525
20526 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
20527 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20528 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
20529 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20530 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20531 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
20532 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
20533
20534
20535 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
20536 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
20537 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
20538 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
20539 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
20540
20541
20542 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
20543 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20544 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20545 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
20546 redirection list.
20547
20548
20549 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
20550 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20551 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20552 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
20553 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20554
20555
20556
20557
20558 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
20559 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20560 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
20561 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20562 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
20563 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
20564 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
20565 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
20566 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
20567 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
20568 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
20569
20570
20571 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
20572 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20573 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20574 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20575 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
20576 functions.
20577
20578 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
20579 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20580 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20581 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
20582 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20583 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
20584
20585 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
20586 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20587 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20588 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
20589 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
20590 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
20591 &_.forward_& files).
20592
20593
20594 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
20595 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20596 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20597 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20598 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
20599
20600
20601 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
20602 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20603 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20604 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
20605 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
20606 of the embedded Perl support.
20607
20608
20609 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
20610 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20611 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20612 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20613 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
20614
20615
20616 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
20617 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20618 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20619 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20620 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
20621
20622
20623 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
20624 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20625 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20626 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
20627 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
20628 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
20629 &%one_time%& is set.
20630
20631
20632 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
20633 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20634 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20635 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20636 to make use of &%run%& items.
20637
20638
20639 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
20640 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20641 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20642 If this option is true, items of the form
20643 .code
20644 :include:<path name>
20645 .endd
20646 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
20647
20648
20649 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
20650 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20651 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20652 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
20653 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
20654 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
20655 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
20656
20657
20658 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
20659 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20660 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20661 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
20662 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20663
20664
20665 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20666 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
20667 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
20668 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
20669 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
20670
20671
20672
20673
20674 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
20675 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
20676 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
20677 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
20678 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
20679 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
20680 bounce may well quote the generated address.
20681
20682
20683 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
20684 .cindex "EACCES"
20685 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20686 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
20687 file did not exist.
20688
20689
20690 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
20691 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
20692 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20693 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
20694 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
20695
20696 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
20697 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
20698 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
20699 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
20700 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
20701 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
20702 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
20703 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
20704
20705
20706
20707 .option include_directory redirect string unset
20708 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
20709 redirection list must start with this directory.
20710
20711
20712 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
20713 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
20714 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
20715
20716
20717 .option one_time redirect boolean false
20718 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
20719 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
20720 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
20721 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
20722 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
20723 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
20724 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
20725 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
20726 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
20727 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
20728 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
20729 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
20730 before they subscribed.
20731
20732 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
20733 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
20734 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
20735 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20736 attempt.
20737
20738 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20739 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20740 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20741 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20742
20743 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20744 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20745 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20746
20747 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20748 &%one_time%&.
20749
20750 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20751 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20752 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20753 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20754 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20755 expansion.
20756
20757
20758 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
20759 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20760 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20761 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20762 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20763 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20764 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20765 See &%check_owner%& above.
20766
20767
20768 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20769 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20770 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20771 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20772
20773
20774 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20775 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20776 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20777 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20778 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20779 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20780 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20781
20782
20783 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20784 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20785 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20786 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20787 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20788 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20789 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20790 &$qualify_recipient$&.
20791
20792 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20793 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20794 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20795 addresses.
20796
20797 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20798 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20799 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20800 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20801 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20802 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20803 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20804 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20805 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20806 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20807
20808
20809 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20810 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20811 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20812 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20813 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20814 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20815
20816
20817 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20818 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20819 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20820 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20821 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20822 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20823
20824
20825 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
20826 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20827 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20828 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20829 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20830
20831
20832 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20833 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20834 :subaddress part of an address.
20835
20836 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20837 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20838 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20839 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20840
20841
20842 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20843 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20844 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20845 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20846 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20847 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20848 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20849
20850
20851
20852 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20853 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
20854 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20855 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
20856 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20857 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20858 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20859 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20860 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20861 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20862 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20863 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20864 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20865 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20866 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20867 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20868
20869 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20870 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20871 the following routers.
20872
20873 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20874 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20875 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20876 so it is passed to the following routers.
20877
20878 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20879 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20880 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20881 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20882
20883 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20884 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20885 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20886 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20887 .code
20888 userforward:
20889 driver = redirect
20890 allow_filter
20891 check_local_user
20892 file = $home/.forward
20893 file_transport = address_file
20894 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20895 reply_transport = address_reply
20896 no_verify
20897 skip_syntax_errors
20898 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20899 syntax_errors_text = \
20900 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20901 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20902 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20903 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20904 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20905 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20906 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20907 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20908 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20909 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20910 .endd
20911 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20912 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20913 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20914 .code
20915 real_localuser:
20916 driver = accept
20917 check_local_user
20918 local_part_prefix = real-
20919 transport = local_delivery
20920 .endd
20921 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20922 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20923 .code
20924 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20925 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20926 .endd
20927
20928
20929 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20930 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20931
20932
20933 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20934 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20935 .ecindex IIDredrou1
20936 .ecindex IIDredrou2
20937
20938
20939
20940
20941
20942
20943 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20944 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20945
20946 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20947 "Environment for local transports"
20948 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20949 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
20950 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20951 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20952 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20953 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20954 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20955
20956 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20957 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20958 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20959 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20960
20961 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20962 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20963 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20964 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20965 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20966
20967
20968
20969 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20970 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20971 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20972 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20973 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20974 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20975 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20976 time.
20977
20978 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20979 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20980 .code
20981 my_transport:
20982 driver = pipe
20983 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20984 .endd
20985 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20986 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20987 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20988 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20989
20990
20991
20992
20993 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20994 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20995 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20996 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20997 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20998 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20999 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
21000 group (set by the transport). For example:
21001 .code
21002 # Routers ...
21003 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
21004 local_users:
21005 driver = accept
21006 check_local_user
21007 transport = group_delivery
21008
21009 # Transports ...
21010 # This transport overrides the group
21011 group_delivery:
21012 driver = appendfile
21013 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21014 group = mail
21015 .endd
21016 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
21017 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
21018 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
21019 set.
21020
21021 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
21022 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
21023 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
21024 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
21025 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
21026 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
21027
21028 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21029 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21030 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21031 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21032 original gid is also used.
21033
21034 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21035 following that is set is used:
21036
21037 .ilist
21038 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21039 .next
21040 A &%group%& setting of the router;
21041 .next
21042 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21043 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21044 .next
21045 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21046 .next
21047 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21048 the uid is the creator's uid;
21049 .next
21050 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21051 .endlist
21052
21053 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21054 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21055 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21056 The first of the following that is set is used:
21057
21058 .ilist
21059 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21060 .next
21061 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21062 .next
21063 A &%user%& setting of the router;
21064 .next
21065 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21066 .next
21067 The Exim uid.
21068 .endlist
21069
21070 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21071 &%never_users%& list.
21072
21073
21074
21075
21076
21077 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21078 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
21079 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21080 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21081 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21082 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21083 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21084 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21085 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21086 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21087
21088 .ilist
21089 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21090 .next
21091 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21092 .next
21093 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21094 .next
21095 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21096 .endlist
21097
21098 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21099
21100 .ilist
21101 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21102 .next
21103 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21104 .endlist
21105
21106
21107 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21108 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21109 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21110
21111
21112
21113 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21114 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21115 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21116 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21117 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21118 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21119 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21120 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21121 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21122 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21123 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21124 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21125 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21126 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21127
21128
21129
21130
21131
21132
21133
21134 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21135 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21136
21137 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21138 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21139 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21140 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21141 The following generic options apply to all transports:
21142
21143
21144 .option body_only transports boolean false
21145 .cindex "transport" "body only"
21146 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21147 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21148 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21149 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21150 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21151 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21152 automatically suppress them.
21153
21154
21155 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21156 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21157 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21158 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21159 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21160 logged, and delivery is deferred.
21161
21162
21163 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
21164 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21165 deliveries by the transport or for any
21166 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21167 what you are doing.
21168
21169
21170 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21171 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21172 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21173 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21174 transport is run.
21175 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21176 output, and Exim carries on processing.
21177 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21178 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21179 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21180 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21181 one.
21182 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21183 transport and the router that called it.
21184
21185 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21186 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21187 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21188 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21189 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21190 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21191 safely be resent to other recipients.
21192
21193
21194 .option driver transports string unset
21195 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21196 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21197
21198
21199 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21200 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21201 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21202 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21203 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21204 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21205 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21206 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21207 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21208 resent to other recipients.
21209
21210
21211 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
21212 .cindex events
21213 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21214 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21215
21216
21217 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21218 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21219 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21220 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21221 &%user%& (see below).
21222
21223
21224 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21225 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21226 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21227 This option specifies a list of text headers,
21228 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
21229 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21230 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21231 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21232 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21233 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21234 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21235
21236 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21237 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21238
21239
21240 .option headers_only transports boolean false
21241 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21242 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21243 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21244 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21245 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21246 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21247 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21248
21249
21250 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21251 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
21252 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21253 This option specifies a list of header names,
21254 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
21255 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21256 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21257 routers.
21258 Each list item is separately expanded.
21259 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21260 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21261 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21262
21263 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21264 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21265
21266 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21267 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21268 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21269
21270
21271
21272 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21273 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21274 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21275 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21276 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21277 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21278 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21279 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21280 example,
21281 .code
21282 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21283 x@y w@z
21284 .endd
21285 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21286 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21287 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21288 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21289 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21290 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21291 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21292 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21293 change envelope recipients at this time.
21294
21295
21296 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21297 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21298 .vindex "&$home$&"
21299 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21300 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21301 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21302 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21303 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21304 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21305 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21306 deferred.
21307
21308
21309 .option initgroups transports boolean false
21310 .cindex "additional groups"
21311 .cindex "groups" "additional"
21312 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21313 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21314 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21315 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21316
21317
21318 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21319 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21320 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
21321 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21322 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21323 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21324 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21325 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21326
21327 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21328 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21329 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21330 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21331 Obviously there is scope for
21332 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21333 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21334
21335 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21336 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21337 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21338 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21339 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21340
21341
21342 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21343 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21344 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21345 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21346 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21347 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21348 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21349 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21350 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21351 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21352 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21353 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21354 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21355 delivered.
21356
21357
21358
21359 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21360 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21361 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21362 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
21363 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
21364 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21365 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21366 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21367 that contains
21368 .code
21369 local_part_prefix = *-
21370 .endd
21371 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21372 is delivered with
21373 .code
21374 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21375 .endd
21376 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21377 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21378 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21379 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21380 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21381
21382
21383 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21384 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21385 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21386 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21387 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21388 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21389 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21390 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21391 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21392
21393 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21394 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21395 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21396 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21397
21398 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21399 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21400 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21401
21402
21403 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
21404 .cindex "envelope sender"
21405 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21406 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21407 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21408 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21409 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21410 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21411 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21412 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21413 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21414
21415 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21416 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21417
21418 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
21419 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21420 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21421 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21422 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21423 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21424 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21425
21426 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21427 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21428 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21429 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21430 &%errors_to%& in a router.
21431
21432
21433
21434 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
21435 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21436 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21437 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21438 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21439 have easy access to it.
21440
21441 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21442 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21443 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21444 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21445 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21446 recipients.
21447
21448
21449 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21450 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21451
21452
21453 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
21454 .cindex "shadow transport"
21455 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
21456 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21457 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21458
21459 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21460 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21461 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21462 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21463 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21464 cause a log line to be written.
21465
21466 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
21467 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
21468 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
21469 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
21470 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
21471 of the form
21472 .code
21473 ST=<shadow transport name>
21474 .endd
21475 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
21476 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
21477 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
21478 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
21479 headers that some sites insist on.
21480
21481
21482 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
21483 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21484 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21485 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
21486 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
21487 individual users or via a system filter.
21488 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
21489
21490 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
21491 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
21492 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
21493 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
21494 command must be specified as an absolute path.
21495
21496 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
21497 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
21498 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
21499 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
21500 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
21501 &(pipe)& transports.
21502
21503 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
21504 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
21505 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
21506 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
21507 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
21508
21509 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
21510 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
21511 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
21512 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
21513
21514 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
21515 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
21516 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
21517 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
21518 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
21519 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
21520
21521 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21522 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
21523 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
21524 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
21525 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
21526 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
21527 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
21528 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
21529
21530 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21531 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
21532 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
21533 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
21534 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
21535 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
21536 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
21537 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
21538 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
21539 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
21540
21541 .vindex "&$host$&"
21542 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21543 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
21544 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
21545 which the message is being sent. For example:
21546 .code
21547 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
21548 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
21549 .endd
21550
21551 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
21552 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
21553 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
21554 .ilist
21555 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
21556 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
21557 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
21558 example:
21559 .code
21560 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
21561 .endd
21562 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
21563 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
21564 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
21565 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
21566 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
21567 Exim tried to expand the first one.
21568 .next
21569 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
21570 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
21571 arguments. Consider this example:
21572 .code
21573 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21574 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21575 .endd
21576 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
21577 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
21578 .code
21579 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21580 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21581 .endd
21582 .endlist
21583
21584 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
21585 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
21586 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
21587 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
21588 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
21589 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
21590 bounced from a transport filter.
21591
21592 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
21593 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
21594 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
21595
21596
21597 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
21598 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
21599 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
21600 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
21601 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
21602 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
21603 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
21604 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
21605 becomes a temporary error.
21606
21607
21608 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
21609 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21610 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
21611 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
21612 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
21613 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
21614 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
21615 option is not set.
21616
21617 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
21618 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
21619 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
21620
21621 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
21622 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
21623 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
21624 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
21625 retry data.
21626 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
21627 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
21628 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
21629
21630
21631
21632
21633
21634
21635 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21636 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21637
21638 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
21639 "Address batching"
21640 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
21641 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
21642 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
21643 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
21644 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
21645 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
21646 copy of the message is delivered each time.
21647
21648 .cindex "batched local delivery"
21649 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
21650 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
21651 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
21652 local transport, for example:
21653
21654 .ilist
21655 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
21656 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
21657 recipients saves space.
21658 .next
21659 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
21660 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
21661 .next
21662 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
21663 to a scanner program or
21664 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
21665 acceptable.
21666 .endlist
21667
21668 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
21669 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
21670 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
21671
21672 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
21673 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
21674 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
21675 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
21676 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
21677 to certain conditions:
21678
21679 .ilist
21680 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21681 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
21682 batching is possible.
21683 .next
21684 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21685 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
21686 addresses with the same domain are batched.
21687 .next
21688 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
21689 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
21690 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
21691 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
21692 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
21693 from taking place.
21694 .next
21695 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
21696 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
21697 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
21698 be the same.
21699 .endlist
21700
21701 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
21702 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
21703 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
21704 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
21705 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
21706 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
21707 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
21708 .code
21709 check_string = "."
21710 escape_string = ".."
21711 .endd
21712 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
21713 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
21714 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
21715
21716 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21717 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
21718 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
21719 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
21720 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
21721 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
21722
21723 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
21724 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21725 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
21726 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
21727 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
21728 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
21729 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
21730 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
21731 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
21732
21733
21734
21735
21736 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21737 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21738
21739 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
21740 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
21741 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
21742 .cindex "directory creation"
21743 .cindex "creating directories"
21744 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
21745 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21746 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21747 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21748 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21749 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21750 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21751 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21752 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21753 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21754
21755 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21756 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21757 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21758 included.
21759
21760 .cindex "quota" "system"
21761 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21762 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21763 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21764
21765 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21766 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21767 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21768 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21769
21770 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21771 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21772 private options.
21773
21774 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21775 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21776 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21777 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21778 option).
21779
21780
21781
21782 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21783 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21784 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21785 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21786 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21787
21788 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21789 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21790 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21791 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21792 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21793 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21794 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21795 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21796 operation. There are two cases:
21797
21798 .ilist
21799 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21800 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21801 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21802 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21803 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21804 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21805 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21806 .next
21807 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21808 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21809 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21810 .endlist
21811
21812
21813 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21814 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21815 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21816 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21817 form:
21818 .code
21819 save folder23
21820 .endd
21821 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21822 .code
21823 require "fileinto";
21824 fileinto "folder23";
21825 .endd
21826 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21827 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21828 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21829 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21830 way of handling this requirement:
21831 .code
21832 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21833 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21834 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21835 {$address_file} \
21836 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21837 }} \
21838 }
21839 .endd
21840 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21841 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21842 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21843
21844 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21845 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21846 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21847 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21848 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21849 path to the transport.
21850
21851 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21852 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21853
21854
21855
21856
21857 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21858 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21859
21860
21861
21862 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21863 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21864 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21865 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21866 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21867 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21868 delivery is deferred.
21869
21870
21871 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21872 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21873 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21874 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21875 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21876 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21877 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21878 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21879
21880
21881 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21882 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21883 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21884 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21885 file.
21886
21887
21888 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21889 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21890
21891
21892 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
21893 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21894 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21895 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21896 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21897
21898
21899 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21900 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21901 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21902 process is running.
21903
21904
21905 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21906 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21907 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21908 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21909 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21910 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21911 contains is significant.
21912
21913 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21914 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21915 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21916 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21917 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21918
21919 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21920 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21921 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21922 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21923 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21924 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21925 .code
21926 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21927 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21928 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21929 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21930 .endd
21931 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21932 .cindex "directory creation"
21933 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21934 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21935 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21936
21937 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21938 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21939 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21940 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21941 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21942
21943
21944
21945 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21946 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21947 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21948 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21949 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21950 beneath.
21951
21952 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21953 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21954 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21955 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21956 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21957 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21958 &%file_must_exist%&.
21959
21960
21961 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21962 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21963 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21964 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21965
21966 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21967 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21968 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21969 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21970 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21971
21972
21973 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21974 .cindex "base62"
21975 .vindex "&$inode$&"
21976 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21977 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21978 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21979 .code
21980 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21981 .endd
21982 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21983 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21984 option.
21985
21986
21987 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21988 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21989 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21990
21991
21992 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21993 See &%check_string%& above.
21994
21995
21996 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
21997 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21998 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21999 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
22000 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
22001 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
22002 &%file%&.
22003
22004 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22005 .cindex "locking files"
22006 .cindex "lock files"
22007 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
22008 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
22009
22010 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
22011 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
22012 examples:
22013 .code
22014 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
22015 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
22016 file = $home/inbox
22017 .endd
22018 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
22019 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
22020 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
22021 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
22022 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
22023 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
22024
22025
22026
22027 .option file_format appendfile string unset
22028 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22029 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22030 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22031 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22032 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22033 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22034 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22035 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22036 this added to it:
22037 .code
22038 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22039 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22040 .endd
22041 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22042 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22043 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22044 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22045 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22046 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22047 delivery is deferred.
22048
22049
22050 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22051 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22052 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22053 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22054
22055
22056 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22057 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22058 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22059 .cindex "locking files"
22060 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22061 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22062 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22063 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22064 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22065 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22066 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22067 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22068
22069 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22070 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22071 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22072 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22073
22074 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22075 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22076 retries is
22077 .code
22078 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22079 .endd
22080 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22081 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22082 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22083
22084 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22085 local deliveries because of errors of the form
22086 .code
22087 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22088 .endd
22089
22090 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22091 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22092 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22093 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22094
22095
22096 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22097 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22098 for details of locking.
22099
22100
22101 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22102 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22103 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22104
22105
22106 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22107 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22108 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22109
22110
22111 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22112 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22113 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22114 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22115 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22116
22117
22118 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22119 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22120 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22121 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22122 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22123 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22124 external source that maintains the data.
22125
22126
22127 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22128 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22129 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22130 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22131 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22132 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22133 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22134 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22135
22136
22137
22138 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22139 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22140 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22141 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22142 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22143 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22144 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22145 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22146 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22147 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22148
22149
22150 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22151 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22152 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22153 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22154 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22155 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22156 calculation. The default value is:
22157 .code
22158 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22159 .endd
22160 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22161 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22162 &_Trash_&
22163 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22164 .code
22165 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22166 .endd
22167 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22168 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22169 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22170 directly into that directory.
22171
22172
22173 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22174 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22175 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22176
22177
22178 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22179 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22180 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22181
22182
22183 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22184 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22185 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22186 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22187 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22188 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22189 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22190 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22191
22192 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22193 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22194 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22195 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22196 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22197 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22198 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22199 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22200 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22201 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22202
22203
22204 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22205 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22206 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22207 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22208 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22209 below for further details.
22210
22211
22212 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22213 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22214 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22215
22216
22217 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22218 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22219 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22220
22221
22222 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22223 .cindex "locking files"
22224 .cindex "file" "locking"
22225 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
22226 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22227 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22228 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22229 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22230 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22231 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22232
22233 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22234 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22235 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22236 combination:
22237 .code
22238 mbx_format = true
22239 message_prefix =
22240 message_suffix =
22241 .endd
22242 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22243 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22244 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22245 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22246 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22247 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22248 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22249 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22250
22251 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22252 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22253 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22254 append messages to it.
22255
22256
22257 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22258 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22259 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22260 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22261 in which case it is:
22262 .code
22263 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22264 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22265 .endd
22266 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22267 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22268
22269 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22270 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22271 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22272 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22273 setting
22274 .code
22275 message_suffix =
22276 .endd
22277 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22278 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22279
22280 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22281 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22282 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22283 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22284 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22285 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22286 value, and this option is ignored.
22287
22288
22289 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22290 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22291 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22292 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22293 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22294
22295
22296 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22297 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22298 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22299 on users about incoming mail.
22300
22301
22302 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22303 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22304 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22305 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22306 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22307 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22308 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22309 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22310 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22311
22312 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22313 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22314 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22315
22316 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22317 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22318 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22319 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22320 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22321 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22322
22323 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22324 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22325 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22326 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22327 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22328 be handled.
22329
22330 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22331 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22332
22333 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22334
22335 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22336 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22337 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22338 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22339 system quota failures.
22340
22341 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22342 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22343 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22344 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22345 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22346 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22347 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22348 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22349 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22350 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22351
22352
22353 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22354 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22355 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22356 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22357 delivery directory.
22358
22359
22360 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22361 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22362 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22363 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22364 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22365 &"no quota"&.
22366
22367 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22368 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22369
22370 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22371 See &%quota%& above.
22372
22373
22374 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22375 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22376 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22377 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22378 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
22379 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22380 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22381
22382 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22383 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22384 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22385 the file length to the file name. For example:
22386 .code
22387 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22388 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22389 .endd
22390 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22391 number of lines in the message.
22392
22393 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22394 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22395 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
22396
22397 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22398
22399
22400 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22401 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22402 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22403 .code
22404 quota_warn_message = "\
22405 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22406 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22407 This message is automatically created \
22408 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22409 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22410 a warning threshold that is\n\
22411 set by the system administrator.\n"
22412 .endd
22413
22414
22415 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22416 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22417 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22418 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22419 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22420 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22421 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22422 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22423 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22424 sign. For example:
22425 .code
22426 quota = 10M
22427 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22428 .endd
22429 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22430 percent sign is ignored.
22431
22432 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22433 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22434 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22435 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22436 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22437 &'From:'& line, the default is:
22438 .code
22439 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22440 .endd
22441 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22442 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22443 option.
22444
22445 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22446 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22447 percentage.
22448
22449
22450 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22451 .cindex "envelope sender"
22452 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
22453 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
22454 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
22455 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
22456 for details of batch SMTP.
22457
22458
22459 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
22460 .cindex "carriage return"
22461 .cindex "linefeed"
22462 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22463 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22464 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
22465 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22466
22467 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
22468 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
22469 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
22470 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
22471 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
22472 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22473
22474
22475 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22476 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
22477 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
22478 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
22479 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22480 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
22481
22482
22483 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
22484 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
22485 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
22486 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
22487 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
22488
22489 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
22490 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
22491 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
22492 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
22493
22494 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
22495 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
22496 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
22497 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
22498 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
22499 error.
22500
22501 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
22502 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
22503
22504
22505 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
22506 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
22507 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
22508 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
22509 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
22510 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
22511 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
22512
22513 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22514 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
22515 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
22516 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
22517 file corruption.
22518
22519 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
22520 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
22521 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
22522
22523
22524 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22525 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22526 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
22527 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
22528 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
22529 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
22530 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
22531 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
22532 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
22533
22534 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22535 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
22536 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
22537 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
22538
22539
22540
22541
22542 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
22543 .cindex "appending to a file"
22544 .cindex "file" "appending"
22545 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
22546
22547 .ilist
22548 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
22549 return is given.
22550
22551 .next
22552 .cindex "directory creation"
22553 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
22554 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
22555 &%directory_mode%& option.
22556
22557 .next
22558 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
22559 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
22560 transport.
22561
22562 .next
22563 .cindex "file" "locking"
22564 .cindex "locking files"
22565 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22566 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
22567 reliably over NFS, as follows:
22568
22569 .olist
22570 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
22571 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
22572 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
22573 .next
22574 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
22575 .next
22576 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
22577 Unlink the hitching post name.
22578 .next
22579 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
22580 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
22581 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
22582 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
22583 .next
22584 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
22585 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
22586 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
22587 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
22588 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
22589 it before trying again.
22590 .endlist olist
22591
22592 .next
22593 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
22594 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
22595 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
22596
22597 .next
22598 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22599 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22600 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
22601 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
22602 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
22603 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
22604 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
22605 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
22606 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
22607 checked.
22608
22609 .next
22610 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
22611 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
22612 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
22613 delivery is deferred.
22614
22615 .next
22616 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
22617 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
22618 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
22619 permissions.
22620
22621 .next
22622 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
22623 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
22624 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
22625
22626 .next
22627 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
22628 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
22629 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
22630
22631 .next
22632 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
22633 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
22634 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
22635 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
22636 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
22637 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
22638 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
22639 that prevents link following.
22640
22641 .next
22642 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
22643 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
22644 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
22645 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
22646 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
22647
22648 .next
22649 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
22650
22651 .next
22652 .cindex "file" "locking"
22653 .cindex "locking files"
22654 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
22655 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
22656 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
22657 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
22658 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
22659 .code
22660 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
22661 .endd
22662 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
22663 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
22664 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
22665
22666 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
22667 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
22668 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
22669
22670 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
22671 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
22672 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
22673 delivery is deferred.
22674
22675 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
22676 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
22677 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
22678 immediately. It retries up to
22679 .code
22680 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
22681 .endd
22682 times (rounded up).
22683 .endlist
22684
22685 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
22686 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
22687
22688
22689 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
22690 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
22691 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22692 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
22693 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
22694 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
22695 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
22696 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
22697 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
22698 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
22699
22700 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
22701 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
22702 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
22703 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
22704 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
22705 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
22706 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
22707
22708 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
22709 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
22710 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
22711 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
22712
22713
22714 .cindex "maildir format"
22715 .cindex "mailstore format"
22716 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
22717 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
22718 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
22719 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
22720 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
22721
22722 .cindex "directory creation"
22723 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
22724 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
22725 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
22726 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
22727 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
22728 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
22729 deferred.
22730
22731
22732
22733 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
22734 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
22735 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
22736 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
22737 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
22738 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
22739 &_new_& subdirectory.
22740
22741 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
22742 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
22743 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
22744 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
22745 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
22746 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
22747 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
22748
22749 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
22750 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
22751 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22752 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22753 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22754 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22755 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22756 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22757
22758 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22759 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22760 folders. Consider this example:
22761 .code
22762 maildir_format = true
22763 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22764 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22765 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22766 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22767 .endd
22768 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22769 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22770 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22771 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22772 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22773 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22774
22775 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22776 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22777 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22778 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22779 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22780
22781 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22782 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22783 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22784
22785 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22786 .cindex "maildir++"
22787 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22788 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22789 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22790 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22791 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22792 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22793 amount of space used.
22794
22795 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22796 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22797 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22798 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22799 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22800 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22801
22802
22803
22804
22805 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22806 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22807 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22808 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22809 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22810 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22811
22812
22813 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
22814 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22815 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22816 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22817 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22818 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22819 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22820 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22821 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22822 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22823 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22824 backwards compatibility).
22825
22826 For one common implementation, you might set:
22827 .code
22828 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22829 .endd
22830 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22831
22832 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22833 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22834 &[stat()]& each message file.
22835
22836
22837 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22838 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22839 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22840 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22841 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22842 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22843 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22844 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22845 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22846
22847 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22848 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22849 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22850 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22851 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22852 need to know the quota.
22853
22854 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22855 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22856
22857 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22858 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22859 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22860 details.
22861
22862
22863 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22864 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22865 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22866 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22867 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22868 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22869 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22870 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22871
22872 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22873 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22874 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22875 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22876 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22877 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22878
22879 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22880 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22881 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22882 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22883 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22884 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22885
22886 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22887 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22888 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22889 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22890
22891
22892 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22893 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22894 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22895 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22896 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22897 .code
22898 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22899 .endd
22900 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22901 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22902 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22903 .ecindex IIDapptra1
22904 .ecindex IIDapptra2
22905
22906
22907
22908
22909
22910
22911 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22912 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22913
22914 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22915 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22916 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22917 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22918 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22919 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22920 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22921 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22922
22923 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22924 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22925 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22926 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22927 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22928
22929
22930 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22931 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22932 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22933 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22934 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22935
22936 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22937 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22938 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22939 transport is run as a consequence of a
22940 &%mail%&
22941 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22942 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22943 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22944 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22945 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22946 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22947
22948 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22949 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22950 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22951 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22952
22953 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22954 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22955 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22956 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22957 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22958 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22959 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22960
22961 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22962 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22963 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22964 the transport defers.
22965 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22966 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22967
22968 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22969 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22970 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22971 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22972
22973 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22974 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22975 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22976 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22977 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22978 problems. They are just discarded.
22979
22980
22981
22982 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22983 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22984
22985 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22986 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22987 message when the message is specified by the transport.
22988
22989
22990 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22991 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22992 when the message is specified by the transport.
22993
22994
22995 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
22996 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22997 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22998 string comes first.
22999
23000
23001 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
23002 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
23003 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
23004
23005
23006 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
23007 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
23008 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
23009
23010
23011 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
23012 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
23013 specified by the transport.
23014
23015
23016 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
23017 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
23018 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
23019 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
23020
23021
23022 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
23023 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
23024 the message is specified by the transport.
23025
23026
23027 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
23028 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23029 used.
23030
23031
23032 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23033 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23034 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23035 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23036 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23037
23038
23039
23040 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
23041 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23042 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23043 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23044
23045 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23046 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
23047 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23048 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23049 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23050 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23051 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23052 infinity.
23053
23054 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23055 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23056 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23057 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23058 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23059
23060 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23061 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23062 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23063 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23064 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23065 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23066
23067
23068 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23069 See &%once%& above.
23070
23071
23072 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23073 See &%once%& above.
23074 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23075
23076
23077 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23078 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23079 specified by the transport.
23080
23081
23082 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
23083 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23084 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23085 configuration option.
23086
23087
23088 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23089 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23090 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23091 automatic responses. For example:
23092 .code
23093 subject = Re: $h_subject:
23094 .endd
23095 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23096 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23097 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23098 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23099 small.
23100
23101
23102
23103 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
23104 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23105 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23106 the text comes first.
23107
23108
23109 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
23110 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23111 when the message is specified by the transport.
23112 .ecindex IIDauttra1
23113 .ecindex IIDauttra2
23114
23115
23116
23117
23118 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23119 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23120
23121 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23122 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23123 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23124 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23125 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23126 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23127 specified command
23128 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23129 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23130 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23131 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23132 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23133 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23134 .code
23135 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
23136 .endd
23137 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23138 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23139 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23140 as follows:
23141
23142 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23143 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23144
23145
23146 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23147 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23148 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23149 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23150 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23151
23152
23153 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
23154 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23155 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23156 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23157 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23158 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23159 LMTP protocol.
23160
23161 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23162 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23163 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23164 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23165 in its response to the LHLO command.
23166
23167 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23168 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23169 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23170 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23171
23172
23173 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
23174 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23175 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23176 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23177 LMTP transport:
23178 .code
23179 lmtp:
23180 driver = lmtp
23181 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23182 batch_max = 20
23183 user = exim
23184 .endd
23185 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23186 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23187
23188
23189
23190 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23191 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23192
23193 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23194 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23195 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23196 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23197 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23198 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23199 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23200 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23201 following ways:
23202
23203 .ilist
23204 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23205 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23206 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23207 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23208 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23209 .next
23210 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23211 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23212 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23213 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23214 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23215 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23216 that are routed to the transport.
23217 .next
23218 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23219 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23220 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23221 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23222 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23223 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23224 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23225 .endlist
23226
23227
23228 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23229 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23230 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23231
23232 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23233 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23234 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23235 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23236 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23237 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23238 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23239
23240
23241 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23242 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23243 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23244 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23245 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23246 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23247 of "1" to enforce serialization.
23248
23249
23250
23251
23252 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23253 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23254 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23255 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23256 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23257 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23258 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23259 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23260 &"local delivery failed"&.
23261
23262 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23263 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23264 will be sent as normal.
23265
23266 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23267 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23268 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23269 apply in this case.
23270
23271 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23272 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23273 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23274 a non-existent command may be the problem.
23275
23276 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23277 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23278 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23279 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23280 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23281 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23282 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23283 &%temp_errors%&.
23284
23285
23286
23287 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23288 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23289 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23290 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23291 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23292 run.
23293
23294 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23295 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23296 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23297 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23298
23299 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23300 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23301 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23302 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23303 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23304 .code
23305 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23306 .endd
23307 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23308 arguments. You have to write
23309 .code
23310 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23311 .endd
23312 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23313 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23314 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23315 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23316 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23317 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23318 example:
23319 .code
23320 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23321 .endd
23322
23323 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23324 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23325 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23326 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23327 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23328 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23329 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23330 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23331 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23332 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23333
23334 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
23335 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23336 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23337 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23338 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23339 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23340 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23341 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23342
23343 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23344 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23345 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23346 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23347 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23348 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23349 control what is done with it.
23350
23351 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23352 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23353 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23354 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23355 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23356 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23357 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23358 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23359 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23360 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23361 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23362
23363
23364
23365 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23366 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23367 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23368 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23369 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23370 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23371 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23372 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23373 .display
23374 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23375 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23376 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23377 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23378 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23379 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23380 &`LOGNAME `& see below
23381 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23382 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23383 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23384 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23385 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23386 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23387 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23388 &`USER `& see below
23389 .endd
23390 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23391 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23392 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23393 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23394 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23395 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23396 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23397
23398 .cindex "HOST"
23399 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23400 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23401 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23402 the router.
23403
23404 .cindex "HOME"
23405 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23406 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23407 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23408 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23409
23410
23411 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23412 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23413
23414
23415
23416 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23417 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23418 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23419 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23420 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23421 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23422 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23423 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23424 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23425 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23426 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23427 example, if
23428 .code
23429 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23430 .endd
23431 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23432 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23433 &%use_shell%& is set.
23434
23435
23436 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23437 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23438
23439
23440 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
23441 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23442 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23443
23444
23445 .option check_string pipe string unset
23446 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23447 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23448 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23449 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
23450 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
23451 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
23452 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23453 ignored.
23454
23455
23456 .option command pipe string&!! unset
23457 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
23458 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
23459 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
23460 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
23461 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
23462 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
23463
23464
23465 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
23466 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23467 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23468 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
23469 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
23470 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23471 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
23472
23473
23474 .option escape_string pipe string unset
23475 See &%check_string%& above.
23476
23477
23478 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
23479 .cindex "exec failure"
23480 .cindex "failure of exec"
23481 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
23482 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
23483 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
23484 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
23485 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
23486
23487
23488 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
23489 .cindex "signal exit"
23490 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
23491 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
23492 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
23493 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
23494
23495
23496 .option force_command pipe boolean false
23497 .cindex "force command"
23498 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
23499 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
23500 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
23501 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
23502 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
23503 command. For example:
23504 .code
23505 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
23506 force_command
23507 .endd
23508
23509 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
23510 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
23511 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
23512
23513
23514 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
23515 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
23516 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
23517 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
23518 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
23519 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
23520
23521 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
23522 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
23523
23524
23525 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
23526 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
23527 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
23528 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
23529 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
23530 written to the main log.
23531
23532
23533 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
23534 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
23535 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
23536 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
23537 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
23538 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
23539 be set.
23540
23541
23542 .option log_output pipe boolean false
23543 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
23544 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
23545 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
23546 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23547
23548
23549 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
23550 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
23551 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
23552 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
23553 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
23554 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
23555 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
23556 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
23557
23558
23559 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
23560 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23561 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
23562 .code
23563 message_prefix = \
23564 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
23565 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
23566 .endd
23567 .cindex "Cyrus"
23568 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
23569 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23570 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
23571 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
23572 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
23573 setting
23574 .code
23575 message_prefix =
23576 .endd
23577 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23578 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23579
23580
23581 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
23582 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23583 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
23584 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
23585 .code
23586 message_suffix =
23587 .endd
23588 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23589 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23590
23591
23592 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
23593 This option is expanded and
23594 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
23595 variable of the subprocess.
23596 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
23597 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
23598 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
23599
23600
23601 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
23602 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
23603 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
23604 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
23605 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
23606 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
23607 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
23608 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
23609 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
23610
23611
23612 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
23613 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23614 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
23615 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
23616 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
23617 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
23618 accept the message is used.
23619
23620
23621 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
23622 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
23623 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
23624 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
23625 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
23626 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
23627
23628
23629 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
23630 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
23631 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
23632 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
23633 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
23634 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
23635 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23636
23637
23638
23639 .option return_output pipe boolean false
23640 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
23641 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
23642 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
23643 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
23644 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
23645 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
23646 of them may be set.
23647
23648
23649
23650 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
23651 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
23652 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
23653 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
23654 and &%return_output%& is not set,
23655 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
23656 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
23657 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
23658 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
23659 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
23660 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
23661 and 73, respectively.
23662
23663
23664 .option timeout pipe time 1h
23665 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
23666 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
23667 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
23668 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
23669 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
23670 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
23671
23672 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
23673 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
23674 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
23675 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
23676 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
23677 delivery to be deferred.
23678
23679 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
23680 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
23681
23682
23683 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
23684 .cindex "envelope sender"
23685 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
23686 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
23687 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
23688 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
23689 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
23690
23691 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
23692 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
23693 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
23694 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
23695 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
23696 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
23697 class database.
23698
23699
23700 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
23701 .cindex "carriage return"
23702 .cindex "linefeed"
23703 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23704 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23705 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
23706 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23707
23708 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
23709 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
23710 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
23711 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
23712 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23713
23714
23715 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
23716 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23717 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
23718 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
23719 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
23720 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
23721 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
23722 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
23723 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
23724 its &%-c%& option.
23725
23726
23727
23728 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
23729 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
23730 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
23731 .cindex "external local delivery"
23732 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
23733 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
23734 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
23735 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
23736 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
23737 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
23738 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
23739 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
23740 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
23741 configuration for &%procmail%&:
23742 .code
23743 # transport
23744 procmail_pipe:
23745 driver = pipe
23746 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
23747 return_path_add
23748 delivery_date_add
23749 envelope_to_add
23750 check_string = "From "
23751 escape_string = ">From "
23752 umask = 077
23753 user = $local_part
23754 group = mail
23755
23756 # router
23757 procmail:
23758 driver = accept
23759 check_local_user
23760 transport = procmail_pipe
23761 .endd
23762 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23763 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23764 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23765 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23766 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23767 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23768
23769 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23770 .code
23771 IFS=" "
23772 .endd
23773 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23774 use a shell to run pipe commands.
23775
23776 .cindex "Cyrus"
23777 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23778 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23779 .code
23780 # transport
23781 local_delivery_cyrus:
23782 driver = pipe
23783 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23784 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23785 user = cyrus
23786 group = mail
23787 return_output
23788 log_output
23789 message_prefix =
23790 message_suffix =
23791
23792 # router
23793 local_user_cyrus:
23794 driver = accept
23795 check_local_user
23796 local_part_suffix = .*
23797 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23798 .endd
23799 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23800 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23801 sender.
23802 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
23803 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
23804
23805
23806 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23807 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23808
23809 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23810 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23811 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23812 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23813 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23814 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23815 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23816 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23817
23818
23819 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23820 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23821 two ways:
23822
23823 .ilist
23824 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23825 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23826 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23827 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23828 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23829 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23830 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23831 .next
23832 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23833 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23834 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23835 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23836 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23837 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23838 process.
23839 .endlist
23840
23841
23842 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23843 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23844 no further messages are sent over that connection.
23845
23846
23847
23848 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23849 .vindex "&$host$&"
23850 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23851 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23852 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23853 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23854 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23855 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23856 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23857 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23858
23859
23860 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23861 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
23862 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23863 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23864 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
23865 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23866 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23867 are the values that were set when the message was received.
23868 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23869 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23870 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23871 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23872 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23873 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23874
23875 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23876 and will be removed in a future release.
23877
23878
23879 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23880 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23881 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23882
23883
23884 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23885 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23886 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23887 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23888 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23889 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23890 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23891 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23892
23893 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23894 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
23895 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23896 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23897 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23898 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23899 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23900 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23901 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23902
23903
23904 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23905 .cindex "Cyrus"
23906 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23907 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23908 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23909 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23910 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23911 ignored.
23912
23913 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23914 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23915 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23916 particular connection.
23917
23918 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23919 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23920 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23921 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23922
23923 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23924 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23925 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23926 .code
23927 authenticated_sender = $local_part
23928 .endd
23929 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23930 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23931
23932 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23933 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23934 value.
23935
23936
23937 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23938 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23939 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23940 authenticated as a client.
23941
23942
23943 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23944 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23945 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23946 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23947
23948
23949 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23950 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23951 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23952 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23953 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23954 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23955 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23956
23957
23958 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23959 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23960 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23961 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23962 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23963 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23964 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23965 option.
23966
23967
23968 .option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
23969 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
23970 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
23971 .cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
23972 This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
23973 where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
23974 If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
23975 Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
23976 configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
23977 been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
23978 TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
23979 counter-intuitively decreasing it.
23980 If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
23981 be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
23982
23983
23984 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23985 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23986 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23987 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23988
23989
23990 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
23991 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
23992 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
23993 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
23994 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
23995 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
23996 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
23997 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
23998 .option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
23999 DKIM signing options. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24000
24001
24002 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
24003 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
24004 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
24005 cutoff times.
24006
24007 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
24008 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
24009 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
24010 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
24011 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
24012 unhappy at this prospect, so...
24013
24014 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24015 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
24016 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24017 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
24018 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
24019 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
24020 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
24021 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
24022 to them.
24023
24024
24025 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
24026 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
24027 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
24028 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
24029 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
24030
24031
24032 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
24033 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
24034 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
24035 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
24036 details.
24037
24038
24039 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24040 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24041 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24042 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24043 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24044 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
24045 the dnssec request bit set.
24046 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24047
24048
24049
24050 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24051 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24052 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24053 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24054 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24055 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24056 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
24057 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
24058 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24059
24060
24061
24062 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24063 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24064 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24065 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24066 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24067 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24068 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24069
24070 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24071 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24072 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24073 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24074 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24075
24076
24077 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24078 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24079 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24080 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24081 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24082 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24083 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24084 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24085
24086 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24087 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24088 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24089 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24090 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24091 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24092
24093 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24094 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24095 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24096 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24097 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24098
24099 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24100 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24101 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24102 copy of the message is sent.
24103
24104 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24105 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24106 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24107 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24108 fails"& facility.
24109
24110
24111 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24112 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24113 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24114 zero.
24115
24116 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24117 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24118 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24119 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24120 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24121 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24122
24123 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24124 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24125 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24126 implementations of TLS.
24127
24128 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24129 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24130 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24131 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24132 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24133 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24134 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24135 option is:
24136 .code
24137 $primary_hostname
24138 .endd
24139 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24140 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24141 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24142 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24143 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24144 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24145 interface address, you could use this:
24146 .code
24147 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24148 {$primary_hostname}}
24149 .endd
24150 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24151 callouts.
24152
24153 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24154 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24155 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24156 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24157 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24158 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24159
24160 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24161 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24162 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24163 &%hosts_override%& is set.
24164
24165 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24166 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24167 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24168 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24169 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24170 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24171 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24172
24173 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24174 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24175 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24176 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24177 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24178 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24179 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24180 address are used.
24181
24182 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24183 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24184
24185
24186 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24187 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24188 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24189 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24190 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24191 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24192 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24193 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24194 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24195 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24196
24197
24198 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24199 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24200 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24201 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24202
24203
24204 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24205 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24206 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24207 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24208
24209 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24210 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24211 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24212 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24213 to any host that matches this list.
24214
24215
24216 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24217 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24218 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24219 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24220 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24221 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24222 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24223 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24224
24225
24226 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24227 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24228 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24229 why it exists.
24230
24231
24232
24233 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24234 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24235 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24236 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24237 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24238 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24239 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24240 explanation of when this might be needed.
24241
24242 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
24243 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24244 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24245 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24246 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24247 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24248 message on the same session.
24249
24250 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24251 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24252 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24253 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24254 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24255 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24256 logging.
24257
24258
24259
24260 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24261 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24262 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24263 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24264 &%fallback_hosts%&.
24265
24266
24267 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24268 .cindex "randomized host list"
24269 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24270 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24271 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24272 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24273 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24274 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24275 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24276 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24277
24278 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24279 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24280 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24281 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
24282 .code
24283 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24284 .endd
24285 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24286 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24287 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24288
24289 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24290 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24291 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24292 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24293 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24294 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24295 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24296 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24297 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24298
24299
24300 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24301 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24302 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24303 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24304 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24305
24306 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24307 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24308 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
24309 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24310 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24311 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made.
24312 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24313 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24314
24315 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24316 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24317 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24318 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24319 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24320
24321 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24322 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24323 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24324 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24325 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24326 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24327
24328 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24329 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24330 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24331 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24332 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24333 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24334 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24335
24336 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24337 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24338 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24339 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24340 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24341 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24342 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24343
24344 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24345 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24346 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
24347 If built with DANE support, Exim will lookup a
24348 TLSA record for any host matching the list.
24349 If found and verified by DNSSEC,
24350 a DANE-verified TLS connection is made to that host;
24351 there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24352 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24353
24354 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" unset
24355 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24356 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24357 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24358 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24359 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24360 perform a TCP Fast Open.
24361 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24362 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24363 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24364
24365 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24366 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24367
24368 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24369 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24370 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
24371 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
24372 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
24373
24374 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24375 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24376 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24377 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24378 for multi-recipient messages.
24379 The option can usually be left as default.
24380
24381 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24382 .cindex "bind IP address"
24383 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
24384 .vindex "&$host$&"
24385 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24386 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24387 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24388 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24389 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24390 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24391 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24392 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24393 unknown.
24394
24395 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24396 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24397 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24398 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24399 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24400 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
24401 .code
24402 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24403 .endd
24404 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24405 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24406 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24407 interface to use if the host has more than one.
24408
24409
24410 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
24411 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
24412 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
24413 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
24414 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
24415 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
24416 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
24417 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
24418 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
24419 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
24420 unreachable hosts.
24421
24422
24423 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
24424 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24425 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
24426 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
24427 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
24428
24429 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
24430 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
24431 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
24432 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
24433 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
24434 permits this.
24435
24436
24437 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
24438 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24439 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
24440 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
24441 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
24442 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
24443 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
24444 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
24445
24446 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
24447 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
24448 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
24449
24450 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
24451 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
24452 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
24453 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
24454 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
24455 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
24456 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
24457 variable that contains an outgoing port.
24458
24459 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
24460 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
24461 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
24462 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
24463 is deferred.
24464
24465
24466
24467 .option protocol smtp string smtp
24468 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
24469 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
24470 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
24471 .vindex "&$port$&"
24472 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
24473 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
24474 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
24475 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
24476 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
24477
24478 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
24479 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
24480 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
24481 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
24482
24483
24484 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
24485 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
24486 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
24487 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
24488 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
24489 addresses is not affected.
24490
24491 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
24492 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
24493 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
24494 Exim to use only the host name.
24495 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
24496
24497
24498 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24499 .cindex "serializing connections"
24500 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
24501 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
24502 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
24503 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
24504 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
24505 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
24506 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
24507
24508 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
24509 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
24510 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
24511 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
24512 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
24513 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
24514
24515 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
24516 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
24517 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
24518 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
24519 are used for ETRN serialization.
24520
24521 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
24522
24523
24524 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
24525 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
24526 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
24527 .cindex "size" "of message"
24528 .cindex "transport" "filter"
24529 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24530 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
24531 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
24532 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
24533 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
24534 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
24535 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
24536
24537 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
24538 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
24539
24540
24541 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
24542 .cindex proxy SOCKS
24543 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
24544 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
24545
24546
24547 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
24548 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
24549 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
24550 .vindex "&$host$&"
24551 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24552 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24553 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
24554 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
24555 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
24556 details of TLS.
24557
24558 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
24559 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
24560 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
24561 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
24562 client.
24563
24564
24565 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
24566 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
24567 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
24568 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
24569 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
24570
24571
24572 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
24573 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
24574 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
24575 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
24576 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
24577 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
24578 will fail.
24579
24580 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
24581
24582
24583 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
24584 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
24585 .vindex "&$host$&"
24586 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24587 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24588 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
24589 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
24590 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24591 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
24592 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
24593 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24594
24595
24596 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24597 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
24598 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24599 .vindex "&$host$&"
24600 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24601 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
24602 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
24603 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
24604 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24605 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
24606 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
24607 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
24608 ciphers is a preference order.
24609
24610
24611
24612 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
24613 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
24614 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
24615 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
24616 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
24617 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
24618 certificate and private key for the session.
24619
24620 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
24621
24622 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
24623 TLS extensions.
24624
24625
24626
24627
24628 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
24629 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
24630 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
24631 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
24632 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
24633 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
24634 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
24635 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
24636 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24637 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24638 in clear.
24639
24640
24641 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
24642 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24643 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24644 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24645 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
24646 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24647 Note that unless the host is in this list
24648 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
24649 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
24650 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
24651 certificate verification succeeds.
24652
24653
24654 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
24655 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
24656 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24657 This option give a list of hosts for which,
24658 while verifying the server certificate,
24659 checks will be included on the host name
24660 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
24661 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
24662 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
24663
24664 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
24665
24666
24667 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
24668 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24669 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24670 .vindex "&$host$&"
24671 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24672 The value of this option must be either the
24673 word "system"
24674 or the absolute path to
24675 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
24676 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
24677
24678 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
24679 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
24680 is taken as empty and an explicit location
24681 must be specified.
24682
24683 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
24684 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
24685
24686 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
24687 explicitly
24688 either by file or directory
24689 are added to those given by the system default location.
24690
24691 The values of &$host$& and
24692 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24693 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24694
24695 For back-compatibility,
24696 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
24697 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
24698 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
24699
24700
24701 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24702 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24703 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24704 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24705 certificate verification must succeed.
24706 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24707 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
24708 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
24709
24710
24711
24712
24713 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
24714 "SECTvalhosmax"
24715 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24716 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
24717 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
24718 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
24719 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
24720
24721
24722 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
24723 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
24724 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
24725 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
24726 retrying.
24727
24728 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
24729 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
24730 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
24731
24732 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
24733 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
24734 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
24735 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
24736 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
24737
24738 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
24739 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
24740 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
24741 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
24742 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
24743 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
24744 see below for an exception).
24745
24746 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
24747 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
24748 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
24749 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
24750 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
24751
24752 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
24753 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
24754 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
24755 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
24756 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
24757 reached their retry times.
24758
24759 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
24760 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
24761 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
24762 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
24763 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
24764 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
24765 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
24766 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
24767 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
24768 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
24769 reached.
24770
24771 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
24772 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
24773 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
24774 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
24775 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
24776 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
24777
24778 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
24779 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
24780 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
24781 possible IP addresses have been tried.
24782 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
24783 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
24784
24785
24786
24787
24788
24789 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24790 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24791
24792 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
24793 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
24794 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
24795 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
24796 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
24797 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
24798
24799 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
24800 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
24801 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
24802 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
24803 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
24804 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
24805 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
24806
24807 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
24808 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
24809 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
24810 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
24811
24812
24813 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
24814 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
24815 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
24816 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
24817
24818 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
24819 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
24820 facility; you do not have to use it.
24821
24822 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
24823 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
24824 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
24825 address to which it applies.
24826
24827 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
24828 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
24829 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
24830 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
24831 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
24832 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
24833 rules.
24834
24835 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
24836 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
24837 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
24838 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
24839
24840
24841 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24842 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24843 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24844 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24845 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24846 discouraged.
24847
24848 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24849 illustrated by these examples:
24850
24851 .ilist
24852 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24853 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24854 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24855 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
24856 .next
24857 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
24858 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
24859 .endlist
24860
24861
24862
24863 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
24864 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24865 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24866 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24867 message's processing.
24868
24869 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24870 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24871 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24872 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24873 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24874 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24875 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24876 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24877 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24878
24879 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24880 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24881 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24882 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24883 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24884 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24885 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24886 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24887 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24888 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24889
24890 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24891 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24892 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24893 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24894 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24895 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24896
24897 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24898 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24899 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24900
24901 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24902 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24903 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24904 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24905 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24906 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24907 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24908 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24909 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24910
24911 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24912 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24913 transport time.
24914
24915
24916
24917
24918 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24919 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24920 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24921 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24922 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
24923 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
24924 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
24925 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
24926 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
24927 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
24928 .code
24929 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
24930 .endd
24931 might produce the output
24932 .code
24933 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24934 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24935 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24936 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24937 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24938 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24939 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24940 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24941 .endd
24942 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24943 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24944 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24945 set for a particular transport.
24946
24947
24948 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24949 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24950 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24951 rules in the form
24952 .display
24953 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24954 .endd
24955 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24956 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24957 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24958 any colons must be doubled, of course).
24959
24960 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24961 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24962 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24963 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24964 ignored.
24965
24966 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24967 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24968 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24969
24970 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24971 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24972 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24973 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24974 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24975 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24976 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24977
24978 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24979 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24980 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24981 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24982 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24983 .code
24984 *@* ${lookup ...
24985 .endd
24986 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24987 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24988
24989
24990 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24991 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24992 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24993 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24994 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24995 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24996 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24997 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24998 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24999
25000 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
25001 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
25002 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
25003
25004 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
25005 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
25006 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
25007 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
25008 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
25009 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
25010 of pattern they are set as follows:
25011
25012 .ilist
25013 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
25014 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
25015 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
25016 pattern
25017 .code
25018 *queen@*.fict.example
25019 .endd
25020 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
25021 .code
25022 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
25023 $1 = hearts-
25024 $2 = wonderland
25025 .endd
25026 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
25027 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
25028
25029 .next
25030 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
25031 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
25032 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
25033 rewriting rule of the form
25034 .display
25035 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
25036 .endd
25037 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
25038 .code
25039 $1 = foo
25040 $2 = bar
25041 $3 = baz.example
25042 .endd
25043 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
25044 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
25045 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
25046 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
25047 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
25048 .endlist
25049
25050
25051 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25052 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25053 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25054 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25055 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25056 .code
25057 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25058 .endd
25059 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25060 &'From:'& headers.
25061
25062 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25063 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25064 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25065 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25066 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25067 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25068 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25069 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25070 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25071 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25072 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25073 entry written to the panic log.
25074
25075
25076
25077 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25078 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25079
25080 .ilist
25081 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25082 c, f, h, r, s, t.
25083 .next
25084 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25085 .next
25086 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25087 .endlist
25088
25089 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25090 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25091
25092
25093
25094 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25095 "SECID154"
25096 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25097 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25098 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25099 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25100 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25101 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25102 .display
25103 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25104 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25105 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25106 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25107 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25108 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25109 &`h`& rewrite all headers
25110 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25111 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25112 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25113 .endd
25114 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25115 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25116 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25117
25118 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25119 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25120
25121
25122 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25123 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25124 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25125 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25126 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25127 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25128 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25129 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25130 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25131
25132 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25133 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25134 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25135 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25136 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25137 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25138 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25139 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25140
25141
25142 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25143 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25144 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25145 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25146
25147 .ilist
25148 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25149 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25150 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25151 .next
25152 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25153 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25154 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25155 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25156 .next
25157 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25158 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25159 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25160 .next
25161 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25162 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25163 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25164 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25165 .code
25166 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25167 .endd
25168 into
25169 .code
25170 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25171 .endd
25172 .cindex "RFC 2047"
25173 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25174 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25175 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25176 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
25177 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25178 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25179 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25180 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25181
25182 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25183 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25184 .endlist
25185
25186
25187 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25188 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25189 .code
25190 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25191 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25192 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25193 .endd
25194 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25195 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25196 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25197 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25198 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25199 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25200 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25201 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25202
25203 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25204 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25205 .code
25206 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25207 .endd
25208 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25209 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25210
25211 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25212 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25213 messages that originate outside the local host:
25214 .code
25215 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25216 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25217 .endd
25218 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25219 space.
25220
25221 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25222 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25223 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25224 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25225 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25226 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25227 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25228 components. For example, the rule
25229 .code
25230 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25231 .endd
25232 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25233 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25234 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25235 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25236 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25237 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25238 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25239 .ecindex IIDaddrew
25240
25241
25242
25243
25244
25245 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25246 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25247
25248 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25249 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25250 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25251 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25252 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25253 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25254 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25255 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25256 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25257 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25258 address, domain and error.
25259
25260 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25261 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25262 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25263 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25264 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25265 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25266 log selector is set, the message
25267 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25268 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25269 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25270 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25271
25272 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25273 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25274 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25275 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25276 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25277 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25278 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25279 domain are maintained independently.
25280
25281 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25282 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25283 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25284 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25285 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25286 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25287 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25288 the local address is reached.
25289
25290 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25291 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25292 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25293 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25294 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25295
25296 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25297 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25298 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25299 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25300 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25301 messages that it should now be retaining.
25302
25303
25304
25305 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25306 .cindex "retry" "rules"
25307 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25308 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25309 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25310 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25311 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25312 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25313 message's sender, respectively.
25314
25315
25316 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25317 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25318 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25319 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25320 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25321 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25322 example,
25323 .code
25324 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25325 .endd
25326 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25327 whereas
25328 .code
25329 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25330 .endd
25331 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25332 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25333 part.
25334
25335 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25336 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25337 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25338 expressions work in address lists.
25339 .display
25340 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25341 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25342 .endd
25343
25344
25345 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25346 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25347 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25348 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25349 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25350 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25351 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25352 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25353 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25354
25355 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25356 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25357 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25358 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25359 local transports).
25360
25361 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25362 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25363 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25364 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25365 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25366 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25367 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25368 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25369 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25370 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25371 commands.
25372
25373
25374
25375 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25376 "SECID160"
25377 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25378 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25379 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25380 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25381 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25382 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25383 .code
25384 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25385 MX 6 p.q.r.example
25386 MX 7 m.n.o.example
25387 .endd
25388 and the retry rules are
25389 .code
25390 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25391 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25392 .endd
25393 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
25394 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
25395 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
25396 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
25397 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
25398 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
25399
25400 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
25401 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
25402 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
25403 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
25404
25405 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
25406 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
25407 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
25408 .code
25409 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
25410 .endd
25411 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
25412 textual form of the IP address.
25413
25414 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
25415 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
25416 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
25417 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
25418
25419 .vlist
25420 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
25421 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
25422 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
25423
25424 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
25425 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
25426 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
25427
25428 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
25429 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
25430
25431 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
25432 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
25433 .endlist
25434
25435 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
25436 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
25437 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
25438 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
25439 retry rule of this form:
25440 .code
25441 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
25442 .endd
25443 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
25444 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
25445
25446 .vlist
25447 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
25448 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
25449 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
25450 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
25451
25452 .vitem &%lookup%&
25453 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
25454 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
25455 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
25456 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
25457 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
25458
25459 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
25460 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
25461
25462 .vitem &%refused_A%&
25463 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
25464
25465 .vitem &%refused%&
25466 A connection was refused.
25467
25468 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
25469 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
25470
25471 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
25472 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
25473
25474 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
25475 A connection attempt timed out.
25476
25477 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
25478 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
25479 obtained from an MX record.
25480
25481 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
25482 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
25483 obtained from an MX record.
25484
25485 .vitem &%timeout%&
25486 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
25487
25488 .vitem &%tls_required%&
25489 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
25490 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
25491 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
25492
25493 .vitem &%quota%&
25494 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25495 transport.
25496
25497 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
25498 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
25499 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
25500 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25501 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
25502 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
25503 for four days.
25504 .endlist
25505
25506 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
25507 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
25508 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
25509 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
25510 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
25511 heuristic rules:
25512
25513 .ilist
25514 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
25515 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
25516 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
25517 .next
25518 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
25519 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
25520 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
25521 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
25522 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
25523 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
25524 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
25525 .next
25526 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
25527 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
25528 .endlist
25529
25530 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
25531 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
25532 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
25533 error).
25534
25535
25536
25537 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
25538 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
25539 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
25540 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
25541 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
25542 form:
25543 .display
25544 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
25545 .endd
25546 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
25547 .code
25548 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
25549 .endd
25550 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
25551 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
25552 For example:
25553 .code
25554 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
25555 .endd
25556 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
25557 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
25558 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
25559 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
25560 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
25561
25562 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
25563 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
25564 .code
25565 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
25566 .endd
25567 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
25568 list is never matched.
25569
25570
25571
25572
25573
25574 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
25575 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
25576 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
25577 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
25578 .display
25579 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
25580 .endd
25581 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
25582 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
25583 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
25584 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
25585 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
25586
25587 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
25588 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
25589 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
25590 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
25591 The available algorithms are:
25592
25593 .ilist
25594 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
25595 the interval.
25596 .next
25597 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
25598 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
25599 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
25600 .next
25601 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
25602 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
25603 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
25604 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
25605 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
25606 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
25607 queue processing times.
25608 .endlist
25609
25610 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
25611 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
25612 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
25613 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
25614 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
25615 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
25616 interval is found. The main configuration variable
25617 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
25618 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
25619 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
25620 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
25621 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
25622
25623 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
25624 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
25625 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
25626 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
25627 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
25628 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
25629 time.
25630
25631 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
25632 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
25633 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
25634 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
25635 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
25636 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
25637 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
25638 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
25639 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
25640 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
25641 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
25642 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
25643
25644 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
25645 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
25646 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
25647 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
25648 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
25649 deliveries that have been deferred.
25650
25651
25652 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
25653 Here are some example retry rules:
25654 .code
25655 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
25656 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
25657 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
25658 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25659 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
25660 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
25661 .endd
25662 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
25663 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
25664 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
25665 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
25666 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
25667 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
25668 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
25669 days.
25670
25671 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
25672 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
25673 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
25674 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
25675 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
25676
25677 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
25678 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
25679 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
25680 were not obtained from an MX record.
25681
25682 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
25683 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
25684 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
25685 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
25686 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
25687
25688
25689
25690 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
25691 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
25692 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
25693 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
25694 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
25695 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
25696 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
25697 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
25698 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
25699 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
25700 failing for the first time.
25701
25702 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
25703 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
25704 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
25705 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
25706
25707 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
25708 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
25709 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
25710
25711
25712
25713
25714 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
25715 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
25716 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
25717 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
25718 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
25719 default retry rule:
25720 .code
25721 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
25722 .endd
25723 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
25724 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
25725 failure for the recipient address that counts.
25726
25727 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
25728 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
25729 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
25730 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
25731 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
25732
25733 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
25734 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
25735 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
25736
25737 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
25738 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
25739 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
25740 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
25741 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
25742 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
25743 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
25744 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
25745
25746 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
25747 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
25748 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
25749 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
25750 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
25751 notice.
25752
25753 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25754 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
25755 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25756 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
25757 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
25758 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
25759 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
25760 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
25761 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
25762 true.
25763
25764 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
25765 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
25766 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
25767 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
25768 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
25769 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
25770 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
25771 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
25772 reached.
25773
25774 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
25775 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
25776 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
25777 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
25778 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
25779 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
25780 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
25781 time out the address.
25782
25783 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
25784 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
25785 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
25786 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
25787 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
25788 considered immediately.
25789 .ecindex IIDretconf1
25790 .ecindex IIDregconf2
25791
25792
25793
25794
25795
25796
25797 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25798 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25799
25800 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
25801 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
25802 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
25803 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
25804 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
25805 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
25806 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
25807 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
25808 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
25809 other.
25810
25811 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
25812 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
25813
25814 .ilist
25815 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
25816 the client's EHLO command.
25817 .next
25818 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
25819 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
25820 .next
25821 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
25822 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
25823 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
25824 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
25825 with the AUTH command.
25826 .next
25827 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
25828 .next
25829 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
25830 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
25831 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25832 connection.
25833 .next
25834 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
25835 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
25836 unauthenticated connection.
25837 .endlist
25838
25839 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25840 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25841 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25842 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25843 .display
25844 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25845 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25846 &`Connected to server.example.`&
25847 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
25848 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25849 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25850 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25851 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
25852 &`250-PIPELINING`&
25853 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
25854 &`250 HELP`&
25855 .endd
25856 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
25857 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
25858 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
25859 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
25860 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
25861 included by setting
25862 .code
25863 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
25864 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25865 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
25866 AUTH_GSASL=yes
25867 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25868 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
25869 AUTH_SPA=yes
25870 AUTH_TLS=yes
25871 .endd
25872 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25873 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25874 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25875 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25876 work via a socket interface.
25877 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25878 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25879 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25880 supporting setting a server keytab.
25881 The sixth can be configured to support
25882 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25883 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25884 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25885 The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25886 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25887
25888 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25889 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25890 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25891 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25892 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25893 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25894 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25895
25896 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25897 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25898 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25899 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25900 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25901 both sets of options, is required. For example:
25902 .code
25903 cram:
25904 driver = cram_md5
25905 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25906 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25907 client_name = ph10
25908 client_secret = secret2
25909 .endd
25910 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25911 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25912
25913 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25914 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25915 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25916 in Exim.
25917
25918 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25919 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25920 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25921 authenticating data.
25922
25923 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
25924 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
25925 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
25926 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
25927 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
25928 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
25929 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
25930 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
25931 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
25932 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25933 choose to honour.
25934
25935 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25936 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25937 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25938 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25939
25940
25941
25942 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25943 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25944 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25945
25946 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25947 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25948 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25949 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25950 encrypted by a setting such as:
25951 .code
25952 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25953 .endd
25954
25955
25956 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25957 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25958 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
25959 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25960
25961
25962 .option driver authenticators string unset
25963 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25964 authenticators is to be used.
25965
25966
25967 .option public_name authenticators string unset
25968 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25969 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25970 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25971 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25972 defaults to the driver's instance name.
25973
25974
25975 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25976 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25977 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25978 mechanism is not advertised.
25979 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25980 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25981 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25982
25983
25984 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25985 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25986 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25987 for details.
25988
25989 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25990 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25991
25992 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25993 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25994 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25995 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25996 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25997 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25998 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25999 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
26000 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
26001 the error text.
26002
26003
26004 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
26005 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
26006 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
26007 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
26008 out the values of variables.
26009 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
26010 output, and Exim carries on processing.
26011
26012
26013 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26014 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26015 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
26016 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
26017 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
26018 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
26019 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
26020 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
26021 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
26022
26023
26024 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26025 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
26026 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
26027 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
26028 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
26029 remembered for later use.
26030 How it is used is described in the following section.
26031
26032
26033
26034
26035
26036 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
26037 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
26038 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26039 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
26040 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
26041 message:
26042
26043 .ilist
26044 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
26045 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
26046 .next
26047 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
26048 .next
26049 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
26050 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
26051 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26052 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26053 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26054 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26055 given for the MAIL command.
26056 .next
26057 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26058 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26059 authenticated.
26060 .next
26061 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26062 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26063 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26064 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26065 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26066 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26067 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26068 message.
26069 .endlist
26070
26071
26072 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26073 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26074 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26075 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26076
26077 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26078 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26079 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26080 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26081 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26082 ACL is run.
26083
26084
26085
26086 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26087 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26088 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26089 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26090 conditions:
26091
26092 .ilist
26093 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26094 .next
26095 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26096 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26097 .endlist
26098
26099 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26100 the mechanisms are advertised.
26101
26102 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26103 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26104 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26105 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26106 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26107 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26108 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26109 .code
26110 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26111 .endd
26112 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26113
26114 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26115 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26116 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26117 such as:
26118 .code
26119 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26120 .endd
26121 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26122 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26123 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26124
26125 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26126 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26127 command. This is the case if
26128
26129 .ilist
26130 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26131 .next
26132 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26133 .next
26134 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26135 server authenticators.
26136 .endlist
26137
26138
26139 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26140 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26141 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26142
26143 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26144 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26145 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26146 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26147 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26148 rejected with a 504 error.
26149
26150 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26151 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26152 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26153 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26154 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26155 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26156 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26157 no successful authentication.
26158
26159 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
26160 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
26161 &$authresults$& expansion item.
26162
26163
26164
26165
26166 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26167 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26168 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26169 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26170 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26171 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26172 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26173 script:
26174 .code
26175 use MIME::Base64;
26176 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26177 .endd
26178 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26179 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26180 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26181 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26182 command line to run this script on such data might be
26183 .code
26184 encode '\0user\0password'
26185 .endd
26186 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26187 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26188 whose code value is zero.
26189
26190 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26191 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26192 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26193 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26194
26195 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26196 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26197 example, a command such as
26198 .code
26199 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26200 .endd
26201 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26202
26203 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26204 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26205 .code
26206 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26207 .endd
26208 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26209 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26210 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26211 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26212
26213
26214
26215 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26216 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26217 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26218 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26219 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26220 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26221
26222 .ilist
26223 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26224 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26225 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26226 of the authenticator.
26227 .next
26228 .vindex "&$host$&"
26229 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26230 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26231 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26232 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26233 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26234 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26235 delivery to be deferred.
26236 .next
26237 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26238 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26239 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26240 usual way.
26241 .next
26242 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26243 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26244 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26245 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26246 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26247 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26248 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26249 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26250 deliver the message unauthenticated.
26251 .endlist
26252
26253 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26254 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26255 upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
26256 router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
26257 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26258 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26259 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26260 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26261
26262 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26263
26264 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26265 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26266 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26267 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26268 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26269 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26270 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26271 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26272 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26273 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26274 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26275 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
26276 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
26277
26278
26279
26280
26281
26282
26283 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26284 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26285
26286 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26287 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26288 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26289 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26290 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26291 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26292 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26293 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26294 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26295 connections as you do for login accounts.
26296
26297 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
26298 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26299 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26300
26301 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26302 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26303 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26304
26305 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
26306 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26307 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26308 given.
26309
26310 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26311 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26312 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26313 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26314 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26315 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26316 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26317
26318 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26319 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26320 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26321 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26322 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26323 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26324 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26325
26326 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26327 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26328 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26329 string expansions that also use them for other things.
26330
26331 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26332 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26333 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26334
26335 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26336 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26337 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26338 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26339 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26340 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26341 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26342 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26343 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26344 string as the error text
26345
26346 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26347 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26348 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26349
26350
26351
26352 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26353 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26354 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26355 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26356 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26357 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26358 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26359 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26360
26361 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26362 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26363 configured as follows:
26364 .code
26365 fixed_plain:
26366 driver = plaintext
26367 public_name = PLAIN
26368 server_prompts = :
26369 server_condition = \
26370 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26371 server_set_id = $auth2
26372 .endd
26373 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
26374 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
26375 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
26376 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
26377
26378 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
26379 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
26380 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
26381 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
26382 .code
26383 250-AUTH PLAIN
26384 .endd
26385 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
26386 .code
26387 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
26388 .endd
26389 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
26390 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
26391 .code
26392 AUTH PLAIN
26393 .endd
26394 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
26395 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
26396
26397 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
26398 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
26399 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
26400 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
26401 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
26402
26403 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
26404 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
26405 authenticating clients it could make sense.
26406
26407 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
26408 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
26409 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
26410 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
26411 This is an incorrect example:
26412 .code
26413 server_condition = \
26414 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
26415 .endd
26416 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
26417 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
26418 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
26419 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
26420 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
26421 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
26422 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
26423 .code
26424 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
26425 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
26426 .endd
26427 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
26428 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
26429 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
26430 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
26431 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
26432
26433
26434 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
26435 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
26436 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
26437 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
26438 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
26439 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
26440 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
26441 .code
26442 fixed_login:
26443 driver = plaintext
26444 public_name = LOGIN
26445 server_prompts = User Name : Password
26446 server_condition = \
26447 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
26448 server_set_id = $auth1
26449 .endd
26450 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
26451 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
26452 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
26453 strings are used to obtain two data items.
26454
26455 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
26456 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
26457 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
26458 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
26459 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
26460 .code
26461 login:
26462 driver = plaintext
26463 public_name = LOGIN
26464 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
26465 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
26466 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
26467 ldapauth{\
26468 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
26469 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
26470 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
26471 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
26472 .endd
26473 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
26474 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
26475 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
26476 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
26477 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
26478 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
26479 uninterpreted string.
26480
26481
26482 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
26483 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
26484 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
26485 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
26486 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
26487 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
26488
26489
26490
26491
26492 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
26493 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
26494 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
26495
26496 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
26497 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
26498 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
26499 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
26500 usual.
26501
26502 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
26503 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
26504 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
26505 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
26506 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
26507 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
26508 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
26509 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
26510 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
26511 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
26512 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
26513 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
26514
26515 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
26516 splitting takes priority and happens first.
26517
26518 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
26519 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
26520 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
26521 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
26522 the string.
26523
26524 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
26525 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
26526 .code
26527 fixed_plain:
26528 driver = plaintext
26529 public_name = PLAIN
26530 client_send = ^username^mysecret
26531 .endd
26532 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
26533 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
26534 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
26535 .code
26536 fixed_login:
26537 driver = plaintext
26538 public_name = LOGIN
26539 client_send = : username : mysecret
26540 .endd
26541 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
26542 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
26543 prompts.
26544 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
26545 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
26546
26547
26548
26549
26550 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26551 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26552
26553 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
26554 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26555 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
26556 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
26557 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
26558 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
26559 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
26560 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
26561 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
26562 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
26563 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
26564 available in plain text at either end.
26565
26566
26567 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
26568 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
26569 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
26570 authenticator as a server:
26571
26572 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26573 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26574 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
26575 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
26576 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
26577 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
26578 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
26579 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
26580 returned to the client.
26581
26582 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
26583 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
26584 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
26585 numeric variables for other things.
26586
26587 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
26588 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
26589 user name, authentication fails.
26590 .code
26591 fixed_cram:
26592 driver = cram_md5
26593 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26594 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
26595 server_set_id = $auth1
26596 .endd
26597 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26598 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
26599 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
26600 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
26601 .code
26602 lookup_cram:
26603 driver = cram_md5
26604 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26605 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
26606 {$value}fail}
26607 server_set_id = $auth1
26608 .endd
26609 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
26610 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
26611
26612 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
26613 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
26614 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
26615 realm, with:
26616 .code
26617 cyrusless_crammd5:
26618 driver = cram_md5
26619 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26620 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
26621 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26622 server_set_id = $auth1
26623 .endd
26624
26625 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
26626 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
26627 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
26628
26629
26630
26631 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
26632 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
26633 computing the response to the server's challenge.
26634
26635
26636 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26637 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
26638 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
26639
26640
26641 .vindex "&$host$&"
26642 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26643 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
26644 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
26645 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
26646 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
26647 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
26648 send the message to the current server.
26649
26650 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
26651 strings, is:
26652 .code
26653 fixed_cram:
26654 driver = cram_md5
26655 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26656 client_name = ph10
26657 client_secret = secret
26658 .endd
26659 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
26660 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
26661
26662
26663
26664 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26665 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26666
26667 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
26668 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
26669 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
26670 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
26671 .cindex "Kerberos"
26672 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
26673 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
26674
26675 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
26676 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
26677 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
26678 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
26679 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
26680
26681 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
26682 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
26683 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
26684 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
26685
26686 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
26687 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
26688 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
26689 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
26690 depending on the driver you are using.
26691
26692 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
26693 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
26694 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
26695 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
26696 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
26697 implementation.
26698
26699 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
26700 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
26701 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
26702 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
26703 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
26704 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
26705 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
26706 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
26707
26708
26709 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
26710 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
26711 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
26712 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
26713 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
26714 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
26715 things.
26716
26717
26718 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
26719 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26720 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
26721 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
26722
26723
26724 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
26725 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26726 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26727 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26728 example:
26729 .code
26730 sasl:
26731 driver = cyrus_sasl
26732 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26733 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26734 server_set_id = $auth1
26735 .endd
26736
26737 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
26738 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26739
26740
26741 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
26742 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26743
26744
26745 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
26746 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
26747 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
26748 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
26749 .code
26750 sasl_cram_md5:
26751 driver = cyrus_sasl
26752 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26753 server_set_id = $auth1
26754
26755 sasl_plain:
26756 driver = cyrus_sasl
26757 public_name = PLAIN
26758 server_set_id = $auth2
26759 .endd
26760 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
26761 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
26762 but it is present in many binary distributions.
26763 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
26764 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
26765
26766
26767
26768
26769 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26770 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26771 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
26772 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
26773 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
26774 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
26775 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
26776 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
26777 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
26778 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
26779 authenticator only. There is only one option:
26780
26781 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
26782
26783 This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
26784 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
26785 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
26786 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
26787 .code
26788 dovecot_plain:
26789 driver = dovecot
26790 public_name = PLAIN
26791 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26792 server_set_id = $auth1
26793
26794 dovecot_ntlm:
26795 driver = dovecot
26796 public_name = NTLM
26797 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26798 server_set_id = $auth1
26799 .endd
26800 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
26801 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
26802 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
26803 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
26804 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
26805 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
26806 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
26807 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
26808
26809
26810 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26811 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26812 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
26813 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
26814 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
26815 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
26816 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
26817 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26818 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26819 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
26820 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
26821 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
26822 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
26823 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
26824 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
26825 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
26826 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
26827 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
26828 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
26829 without code changes in Exim.
26830
26831
26832 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
26833 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
26834 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
26835 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
26836 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
26837 context.
26838
26839 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
26840 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
26841 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
26842
26843 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
26844 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
26845 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
26846
26847 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
26848 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
26849 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
26850
26851
26852 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
26853 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26854 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26855 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26856
26857
26858 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
26859 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26860 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26861 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26862 example:
26863 .code
26864 sasl:
26865 driver = gsasl
26866 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26867 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26868 server_set_id = $auth1
26869 .endd
26870
26871
26872 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
26873 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
26874 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
26875 the password itself.
26876
26877 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
26878 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
26879 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26880 if available, else the empty string.
26881 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26882 else the empty string.
26883
26884 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26885
26886 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26887 option to be simply "true".
26888
26889
26890 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26891 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26892 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26893
26894
26895 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26896 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26897 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26898 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26899
26900
26901 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26902 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26903 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26904 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26905
26906
26907 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26908 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26909 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26910
26911
26912 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26913 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26914 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26915 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26916
26917 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
26918 meanings for these variables:
26919
26920 .ilist
26921 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26922 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
26923 .next
26924 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26925 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
26926 .next
26927 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
26928 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
26929 .endlist
26930
26931 On a per-mechanism basis:
26932
26933 .ilist
26934 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26935 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
26936 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26937 .next
26938 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26939 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
26940 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26941 .next
26942 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26943 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
26944 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
26945 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26946 .endlist
26947
26948 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26949 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26950 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26951
26952
26953 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26954 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26955 .code
26956 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26957 driver = gsasl
26958 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26959 server_realm = imap.example.org
26960 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26961 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26962 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26963 server_condition = yes
26964 .endd
26965
26966
26967 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26968 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26969
26970 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26971 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26972 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26973 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26974 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26975 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26976 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26977 reliably.
26978
26979 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26980 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26981 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26982 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26983
26984 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26985 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26986 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26987 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26988
26989 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26990 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26991 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
26992 from the keytab.
26993
26994
26995 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26996 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26997 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26998 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26999
27000 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
27001 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
27002 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
27003 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
27004
27005 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27006 .ilist
27007 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
27008 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
27009 .next
27010 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
27011 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
27012 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
27013 GSS Display Name.
27014 .endlist
27015
27016
27017 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27018 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27019
27020 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
27021 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
27022 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
27023 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
27024 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
27025 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
27026 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
27027 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
27028 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
27029 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
27030 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
27031 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
27032 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
27033 follows:
27034
27035 .ilist
27036 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
27037 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
27038 .next
27039 The server sends back a challenge.
27040 .next
27041 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
27042 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
27043 .endlist
27044
27045 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
27046
27047
27048
27049 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
27050 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
27051 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
27052
27053 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
27054 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
27055 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
27056 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
27057 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
27058 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
27059 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
27060 for other things. For example:
27061 .code
27062 spa:
27063 driver = spa
27064 public_name = NTLM
27065 server_password = \
27066 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
27067 .endd
27068 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27069 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27070
27071
27072
27073
27074
27075 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
27076 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
27077 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
27078
27079
27080
27081 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
27082 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
27083
27084
27085 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
27086 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
27087
27088
27089 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
27090 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
27091 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
27092 &'msn.com'&:
27093 .code
27094 msn:
27095 driver = spa
27096 public_name = MSN
27097 client_username = msn/msn_username
27098 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
27099 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
27100 .endd
27101 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
27102 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
27103
27104
27105
27106
27107
27108 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27109 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27110
27111 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
27112 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
27113 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
27114 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27115 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27116 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27117 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
27118 authentication based on client certificates.
27119
27120 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
27121 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
27122 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
27123 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
27124 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
27125 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
27126
27127 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
27128 for which it must have been requested via the
27129 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27130 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27131
27132 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
27133 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
27134 and can authenticate the connection.
27135 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
27136
27137 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
27138
27139
27140 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
27141 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
27142
27143 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
27144 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
27145 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
27146 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
27147 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27148 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27149
27150 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
27151 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
27152 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
27153
27154 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
27155
27156
27157 Example:
27158 .code
27159 tls:
27160 driver = tls
27161 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27162 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27163 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
27164 {!= {0} \
27165 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
27166 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
27167 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
27168 } } } }
27169 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
27170 .endd
27171 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27172 of your configured trust-anchors
27173 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27174 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
27175 Note that the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27176 whereas a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27177
27178 . An alternative might use
27179 . .code
27180 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
27181 . .endd
27182 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
27183 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
27184 . This would help for per-device use.
27185 .
27186 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
27187 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
27188
27189 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
27190 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
27191
27192
27193 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
27194 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
27195 a connect- or helo-ACL.
27196
27197
27198
27199 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27200 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27201
27202 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
27203 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
27204 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
27205 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
27206 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
27207 .cindex "OpenSSL"
27208 .cindex "GnuTLS"
27209 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
27210 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
27211 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
27212 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
27213 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
27214 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
27215 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
27216 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
27217 certificates are used.
27218
27219 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
27220 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
27221 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
27222 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
27223 between them is encrypted.
27224
27225 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
27226 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
27227 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
27228 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
27229 encryption state.
27230
27231 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
27232 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
27233 in order to get TLS to work.
27234
27235
27236
27237 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
27238 "SECID284"
27239 .cindex "submissions protocol"
27240 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
27241 .cindex "smtps protocol"
27242 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
27243 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
27244 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
27245 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
27246 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
27247 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
27248 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
27249 by them in preference to STARTTLS.
27250
27251 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
27252 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
27253 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
27254
27255 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
27256 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
27257 reassigned for other use.
27258 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
27259 this port.
27260 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
27261 not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
27262 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
27263
27264 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
27265 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
27266 the most common use is expected to be:
27267 .code
27268 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
27269 .endd
27270 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
27271 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
27272 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
27273 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
27274 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
27275 defined elsewhere.
27276
27277 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
27278 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
27279
27280
27281
27282
27283
27284
27285 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
27286 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
27287 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
27288 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
27289 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
27290 .code
27291 USE_GNUTLS=yes
27292 .endd
27293 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
27294 .code
27295 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
27296 .endd
27297 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
27298 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
27299
27300 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
27301
27302 .ilist
27303 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
27304 cannot be the path of a directory
27305 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
27306 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
27307 .next
27308 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
27309 .next
27310 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27311 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
27312 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
27313 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
27314 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
27315 .next
27316 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
27317 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
27318 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
27319 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
27320 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
27321 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
27322 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
27323 option).
27324 .next
27325 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
27326 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
27327 .next
27328 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
27329 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
27330 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
27331 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
27332 .next
27333 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
27334 main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
27335 .next
27336 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
27337 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
27338 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
27339 implementation, then patches are welcome.
27340 .endlist
27341
27342
27343 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
27344 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
27345 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
27346 but not the chosen filename.
27347 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
27348 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
27349
27350 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
27351 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
27352 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
27353 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
27354 of bits requested.
27355 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
27356 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
27357 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
27358 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
27359 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
27360 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
27361 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
27362
27363 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
27364 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
27365 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
27366 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
27367 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
27368
27369 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
27370 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
27371 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
27372 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
27373 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
27374 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
27375
27376 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
27377 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
27378 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
27379
27380 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
27381 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
27382 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
27383 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
27384 .code
27385 # ls
27386 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
27387 # rm -f new-params
27388 # touch new-params
27389 # chown exim:exim new-params
27390 # chmod 0600 new-params
27391 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
27392 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
27393 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
27394 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
27395 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
27396 # chmod 0400 new-params
27397 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
27398 .endd
27399 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
27400 stalling is removed.
27401
27402 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
27403 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
27404 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
27405 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
27406 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
27407 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
27408 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
27409 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
27410 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
27411 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
27412 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
27413
27414 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
27415 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
27416 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
27417 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
27418
27419 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
27420 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
27421 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
27422 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
27423 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
27424
27425
27426 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
27427 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
27428 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
27429 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
27430 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
27431 .new
27432 are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
27433 .wen
27434 The list is colon separated and may contain names like
27435 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
27436 directly to this function call.
27437 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
27438 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
27439 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
27440 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
27441
27442 .ilist
27443 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
27444 .next
27445 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
27446 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
27447 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
27448 SSL v3 algorithms.
27449 .next
27450 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
27451 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
27452 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
27453 algorithms.
27454 .endlist
27455
27456 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
27457 &`-`& or &`+`&.
27458 .ilist
27459 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
27460 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
27461 stated.
27462 .next
27463 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
27464 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
27465 .next
27466 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
27467 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
27468 .endlist
27469
27470 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
27471 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
27472 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
27473 not be moved to the end of the list.
27474 .endlist
27475
27476 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
27477 string:
27478 .code
27479 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
27480 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
27481 .endd
27482
27483 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27484 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
27485 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
27486 choice of clients used:
27487 .code
27488 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
27489 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27490 {DEFAULT}\
27491 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
27492 .endd
27493
27494 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
27495 .code
27496 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
27497 .endd
27498
27499 .new
27500 For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
27501 and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
27502 The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
27503 TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
27504
27505 As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
27506 .code
27507 TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
27508 .endd
27509 .wen
27510
27511
27512 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
27513 "SECTreqciphgnu"
27514 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
27515 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
27516 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
27517 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
27518 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
27519 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
27520 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
27521 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
27522 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
27523 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
27524
27525 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
27526 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
27527
27528 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
27529 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
27530 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
27531 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
27532 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
27533 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
27534
27535 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
27536 "Priority strings". This is online as
27537 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
27538 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
27539 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
27540 then the example code
27541 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
27542 on that site can be used to test a given string.
27543
27544 For example:
27545 .code
27546 # Disable older versions of protocols
27547 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
27548 .endd
27549
27550 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
27551 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
27552 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
27553
27554 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27555 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
27556 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
27557 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
27558 used:
27559 .code
27560 # GnuTLS variant
27561 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27562 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
27563 {SECURE128}}
27564 .endd
27565
27566
27567 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
27568 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
27569 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
27570 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
27571 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
27572 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
27573 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
27574
27575 If STARTTLS is to be used you
27576 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
27577
27578 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
27579 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
27580 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
27581 with the error
27582 .code
27583 554 Security failure
27584 .endd
27585 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
27586 rejected with a 554 error code.
27587
27588 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
27589 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
27590
27591 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
27592 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
27593 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
27594 from someone able to intercept the communication.
27595
27596 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
27597
27598 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
27599 .code
27600 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
27601 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
27602 .endd
27603 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
27604 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
27605 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
27606 that goes with it. These files need to be
27607 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
27608 always be given as full path names.
27609 The key must not be password-protected.
27610 They can be the same file if both the
27611 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
27612 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
27613 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
27614 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
27615 the server's certificate.
27616
27617 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
27618 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
27619 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
27620 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
27621 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
27622 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
27623
27624 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
27625 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
27626 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
27627
27628 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
27629 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
27630 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
27631 transport.
27632
27633 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
27634 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
27635 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
27636 .code
27637 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
27638 .endd
27639 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
27640 with the parameters contained in the file.
27641 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
27642 available:
27643 .code
27644 tls_dhparam = none
27645 .endd
27646 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
27647 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
27648 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
27649 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
27650
27651 See the command
27652 .code
27653 openssl dhparam
27654 .endd
27655 for a way of generating file data.
27656
27657 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
27658 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
27659 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
27660 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
27661 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
27662
27663 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27664 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27665 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27666 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
27667 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
27668 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
27669 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
27670 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
27671 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
27672
27673 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
27674 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
27675 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
27676 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
27677 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
27678 documentation for more details.
27679
27680 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
27681 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
27682
27683
27684 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
27685 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27686 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27687 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
27688 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
27689 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
27690 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
27691 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
27692 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
27693 expected certificates.
27694 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
27695 an explicit file or,
27696 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
27697 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
27698
27699 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
27700 directory is used
27701 (OpenSSL only),
27702 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
27703 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
27704 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
27705 .code
27706 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
27707 .endd
27708 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
27709
27710 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
27711 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
27712 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
27713 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
27714 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
27715 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
27716 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
27717 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
27718 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
27719 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
27720
27721 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27722 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
27723 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
27724 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
27725
27726 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27727 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
27728 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
27729 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
27730 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
27731 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
27732
27733
27734 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
27735 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
27736 .cindex "revocation list"
27737 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
27738 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
27739 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
27740 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
27741 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
27742 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
27743 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
27744 CRL in PEM format.
27745 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
27746 file from every certificate authority they know of.
27747
27748 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
27749 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
27750 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
27751 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
27752 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
27753 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
27754
27755 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
27756 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
27757 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
27758 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
27759
27760 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
27761 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
27762 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
27763 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
27764 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
27765 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
27766 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
27767 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
27768
27769 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
27770 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
27771 support for OCSP stapling is included.
27772
27773 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27774 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
27775 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
27776 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
27777 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
27778
27779 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
27780 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
27781 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
27782 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
27783 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
27784 next connection.
27785
27786 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
27787 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
27788 ignored.
27789
27790 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
27791 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
27792 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
27793 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
27794 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
27795 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27796
27797 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
27798 not any of the chain from CA to it.
27799
27800 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
27801
27802 .code
27803 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
27804 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
27805 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
27806
27807 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
27808 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
27809 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
27810 .endd
27811
27812
27813
27814
27815 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
27816 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27817 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27818 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27819 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
27820 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
27821 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
27822 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
27823 within the &(smtp)& transport.
27824
27825 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
27826 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
27827 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
27828 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
27829 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
27830
27831 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
27832 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
27833 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
27834 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
27835 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
27836 usual way.
27837
27838 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
27839 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
27840 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
27841 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
27842 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
27843 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
27844 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
27845 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
27846 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
27847 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
27848 unencrypted.
27849
27850 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
27851 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
27852 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
27853 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
27854
27855 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
27856 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
27857 These may be
27858 the system default set (depending on library version),
27859 a file,
27860 or (depending on library version) a directory.
27861 The client verifies the server's certificate
27862 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
27863 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
27864 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
27865 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
27866
27867 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
27868 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
27869 or need not succeed respectively.
27870
27871 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
27872 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
27873 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
27874 value is empty.
27875 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
27876 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
27877 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
27878 otherwise.
27879
27880 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
27881 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
27882 for OCSP to be relevant.
27883
27884 If
27885 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
27886 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
27887 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
27888 alternative hosts, if any.
27889
27890 &*Note*&:
27891 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
27892 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
27893 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
27894 client.
27895
27896 .vindex "&$host$&"
27897 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27898 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
27899 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
27900 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
27901 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
27902
27903 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
27904 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
27905 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
27906 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
27907 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
27908 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
27909 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
27910 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
27911 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
27912 outgoing connection.
27913
27914
27915
27916 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
27917 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
27918 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
27919 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
27920 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
27921 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
27922 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
27923 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
27924 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
27925 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
27926 for this session.
27927
27928 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
27929 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
27930 address.
27931
27932 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
27933 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
27934 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
27935 be of limited use in that environment.
27936
27937 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
27938 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
27939 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
27940 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
27941 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
27942
27943 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
27944 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
27945 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
27946 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
27947 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
27948
27949 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
27950 received from a client.
27951 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
27952
27953 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
27954 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
27955 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
27956
27957 .ilist
27958 &%tls_certificate%&
27959 .next
27960 &%tls_crl%&
27961 .next
27962 &%tls_privatekey%&
27963 .next
27964 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
27965 .next
27966 &%tls_ocsp_file%&
27967 .endlist
27968
27969 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
27970 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
27971 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
27972 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
27973 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI is arrived, so
27974 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
27975 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
27976
27977 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
27978 are re-expanded.
27979
27980 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
27981 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
27982 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
27983 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
27984
27985 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
27986 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
27987 built, then you have SNI support).
27988
27989
27990
27991 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
27992 "SECTmulmessam"
27993 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
27994 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
27995 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
27996 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
27997 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
27998 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
27999 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
28000 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
28001 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
28002 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
28003
28004 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
28005 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
28006 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
28007 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
28008 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
28009 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
28010 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
28011
28012 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
28013 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
28014 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
28015 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
28016 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
28017 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
28018 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
28019 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
28020 and delay other deliveries to that host.
28021
28022 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
28023 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
28024 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
28025 information is recorded.
28026
28027 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
28028 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
28029 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
28030
28031
28032
28033
28034 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
28035 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
28036 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
28037 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
28038 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
28039 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
28040 to Apache, currently at
28041 .display
28042 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
28043 .endd
28044 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
28045 links to further files.
28046 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
28047 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
28048 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
28049 .display
28050 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
28051 .endd
28052
28053
28054 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
28055 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
28056 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
28057 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
28058 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
28059 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
28060 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
28061 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
28062 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
28063 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
28064 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
28065 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
28066 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
28067
28068 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
28069 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
28070 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
28071 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
28072
28073
28074
28075 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
28076 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
28077 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
28078 with OpenSSL, like this:
28079 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
28080 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
28081 .code
28082 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
28083 -days 9999 -nodes
28084 .endd
28085 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
28086 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
28087 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
28088 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
28089 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
28090 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
28091 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
28092
28093 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
28094 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
28095 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
28096 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
28097 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
28098 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
28099 . ==== -pdp, 2012
28100 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
28101 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
28102 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
28103 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
28104 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
28105 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
28106 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
28107 be a sensible resolution).
28108
28109 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
28110 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
28111 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
28112
28113 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
28114 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
28115 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
28116 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
28117 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
28118 signed with that self-signed certificate.
28119
28120 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
28121 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
28122 Open-source PKI book, available online at
28123 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
28124 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
28125 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
28126
28127
28128
28129 .section DANE "SECDANE"
28130 .cindex DANE
28131 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
28132 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
28133 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
28134 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
28135 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
28136 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
28137
28138 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
28139 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
28140 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
28141
28142 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
28143 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
28144
28145 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
28146 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
28147 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
28148
28149 DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
28150 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
28151 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
28152 DNSSEC.
28153 2) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
28154 3) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
28155
28156 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
28157 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
28158 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
28159 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
28160
28161 The TLSA record for the server may have "certificate usage" of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3). The latter specifies
28162 the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server (and should be the sole one transmitted
28163 during the TLS handshake); this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
28164 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
28165 well-known one. A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate which is used to sign
28166 cerver certificates, but running one securely does require careful arrangement. If a private CA is used
28167 then either all clients must be primed with it, or (probably simpler) the server TLS handshake must transmit
28168 the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate. If a public CA is used then all clients must be primed with it
28169 (losing one advantage of DANE) - but the attack surface is reduced from all public CAs to that single CA.
28170 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
28171 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
28172
28173 Another approach which should be seriously considered is to use DANE with a certificate
28174 from a public CA, because of another technology, "MTA-STS", described below.
28175
28176 The TLSA record should have a Selector field of SPKI(1) and a Matching Type field of SHA2-512(2).
28177
28178 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
28179 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records; and commands like
28180
28181 .code
28182 openssl x509 -in -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
28183 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
28184 | openssl sha512 \
28185 | awk '{print $2}'
28186 .endd
28187
28188 are workable for 4th-field hashes.
28189
28190 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
28191
28192 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
28193 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
28194 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
28195
28196 .code
28197 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
28198 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
28199 {*}{}}
28200 .endd
28201
28202 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
28203 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
28204 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
28205 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
28206 control the OCSP request.
28207
28208 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
28209 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
28210
28211
28212 For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
28213 and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
28214 The require variant will result in failure if the target host is not DNSSEC-secured.
28215
28216 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
28217
28218 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
28219 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
28220 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
28221 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
28222
28223 If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
28224 prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
28225 back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
28226 This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
28227 crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
28228 which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
28229 limited to ciphersuite constraints.
28230
28231 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
28232 .code
28233 hosts_require_tls
28234 tls_verify_hosts
28235 tls_try_verify_hosts
28236 tls_verify_certificates
28237 tls_crl
28238 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
28239 .endd
28240
28241 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
28242 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
28243
28244 Currently the &%dnssec_request_domains%& must be active and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
28245
28246 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
28247
28248 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
28249 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
28250 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
28251 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
28252
28253 .cindex DANE reporting
28254 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
28255 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
28256 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
28257 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
28258 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
28259 Section 4.3 of that document.
28260
28261 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
28262
28263 DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
28264 selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
28265 to get through". There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
28266 instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
28267 time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
28268 Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
28269 can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
28270 MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
28271 information.
28272
28273 The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
28274 which is recognized by clients sending to you. That selection is outside your
28275 control.
28276
28277 The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
28278 &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
28279 renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
28280 records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
28281 information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
28282 domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
28283 incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
28284
28285
28286
28287 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28288 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28289
28290 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
28291 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
28292 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
28293 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
28294 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
28295 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
28296 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
28297 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
28298 one very small ACL:
28299 .code
28300 begin acl
28301 small_acl:
28302 accept hosts = one.host.only
28303 .endd
28304 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
28305 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
28306
28307 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
28308 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
28309 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
28310 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
28311 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
28312 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
28313 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
28314 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
28315
28316
28317 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
28318 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
28319 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
28320
28321
28322 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
28323 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
28324 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
28325 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
28326 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
28327 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28328 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
28329 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
28330 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28331 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28332 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
28333 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
28334 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28335 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
28336 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
28337 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
28338 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28339 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28340 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
28341 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28342
28343 .table2 140pt
28344 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
28345 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
28346 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
28347 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
28348 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
28349 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
28350 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
28351 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
28352 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
28353 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
28354 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
28355 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
28356 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
28357 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
28358 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
28359 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
28360 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
28361 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
28362 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
28363 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
28364 .endtable
28365
28366 For example, if you set
28367 .code
28368 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
28369 .endd
28370 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
28371 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
28372 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
28373 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
28374 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
28375 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
28376 testing as possible at RCPT time.
28377
28378
28379 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
28380 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28381 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
28382 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
28383 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
28384 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
28385 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
28386 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
28387 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
28388 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
28389 in any of these ACLs.
28390
28391 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
28392 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
28393 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
28394 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
28395 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
28396 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
28397 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
28398 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
28399 .code
28400 control = suppress_local_fixups
28401 .endd
28402 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
28403 run, it is too late.
28404
28405 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28406 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28407
28408 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
28409 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
28410 temporary error for these kinds of message.
28411
28412
28413 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
28414 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28415 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
28416 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
28417 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
28418 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
28419 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
28420 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
28421 &%smtp_banner%& option.
28422
28423
28424 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
28425 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28426 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28427 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
28428 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
28429 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
28430 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
28431 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
28432 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
28433
28434 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
28435 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
28436 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
28437
28438 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
28439 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
28440 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
28441 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
28442 an EHLO response.
28443
28444
28445 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
28446 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28447 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
28448 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
28449 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
28450 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
28451 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
28452 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
28453 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
28454 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
28455
28456 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
28457 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
28458 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
28459 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
28460 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
28461 associated with the DATA command.
28462
28463 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
28464 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
28465 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
28466 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
28467 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
28468 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
28469 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
28470 the data specified is received.
28471
28472 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
28473 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
28474 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
28475 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
28476 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
28477 your resources.
28478
28479 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
28480 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
28481 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
28482 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
28483
28484 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
28485 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
28486 enabled (which is the default).
28487
28488 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
28489 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
28490 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
28491
28492 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28493
28494 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
28495
28496
28497 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
28498 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28499 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28500
28501 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28502
28503
28504 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
28505 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28506 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
28507 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
28508 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
28509 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
28510 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
28511 has been accepted.
28512
28513 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
28514 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
28515 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
28516 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
28517 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
28518 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
28519 for some or all recipients.
28520
28521 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
28522 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
28523 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
28524 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
28525 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
28526 is &"yes"&.
28527 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
28528 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
28529 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
28530
28531 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
28532 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
28533
28534 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28535 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
28536 the feature was not requested by the client.
28537
28538 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
28539 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28540 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
28541 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
28542 does not in fact control any access.
28543 For this reason, it may only accept
28544 or warn as its final result.
28545
28546 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
28547 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
28548 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
28549 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
28550
28551 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
28552 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
28553
28554 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
28555 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
28556 response to QUIT.
28557
28558 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
28559 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
28560 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
28561 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
28562 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
28563
28564
28565 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
28566 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
28567 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
28568 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
28569 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
28570 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
28571 situation even worse.
28572
28573 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
28574 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
28575 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
28576 and &%warn%&.
28577
28578 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
28579 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
28580 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
28581 connection. The possible values are:
28582 .table2
28583 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
28584 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
28585 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
28586 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
28587 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
28588 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
28589 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
28590 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
28591 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
28592 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
28593 .endtable
28594 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
28595 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
28596 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
28597 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
28598 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
28599 used.
28600
28601
28602 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
28603 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
28604 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
28605 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
28606 .code
28607 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
28608 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
28609 .endd
28610 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
28611 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
28612 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
28613 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
28614 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
28615
28616 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
28617 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
28618 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
28619
28620 .ilist
28621 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
28622 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
28623 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
28624 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
28625 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
28626 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
28627 .code
28628 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
28629 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
28630 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
28631 .endd
28632 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
28633 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
28634 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
28635 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
28636 .next
28637 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
28638 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
28639 matches the string.
28640 .next
28641 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
28642 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
28643 want to have something like
28644 .code
28645 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
28646 .endd
28647 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
28648 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
28649 .endlist
28650
28651
28652
28653
28654 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
28655 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
28656 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
28657 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
28658 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
28659 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
28660 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
28661 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
28662 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
28663
28664 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
28665 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
28666 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
28667
28668
28669 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
28670 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
28671 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
28672 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
28673
28674 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
28675 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
28676 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
28677 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
28678 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
28679 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
28680 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
28681
28682 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
28683 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
28684
28685
28686 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
28687 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
28688 recipients; it may create new recipients.
28689
28690
28691
28692 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
28693 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
28694 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
28695 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
28696 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
28697 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
28698
28699 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
28700 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
28701 used to accept or reject anything.
28702
28703 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
28704 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
28705 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
28706 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
28707
28708 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
28709 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
28710 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
28711 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
28712 configuration file.
28713
28714
28715
28716
28717 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
28718 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
28719 .vindex &$domain$&
28720 .vindex &$local_part$&
28721 .vindex &$sender_address$&
28722 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
28723 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
28724 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
28725 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
28726 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
28727 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
28728 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
28729 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28730
28731 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
28732 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
28733 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
28734 how it is used.
28735
28736 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
28737 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
28738 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
28739 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
28740 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
28741 received).
28742
28743 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
28744 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
28745 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
28746 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
28747 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
28748 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
28749 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
28750 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
28751
28752
28753
28754
28755
28756 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
28757 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
28758 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
28759 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
28760 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
28761 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
28762 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28763 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
28764 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
28765 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
28766 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
28767 unencrypted connections.
28768 .code
28769 acl_check_auth:
28770 accept encrypted = *
28771 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
28772 {CRAM-MD5}}
28773 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
28774 .endd
28775 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
28776 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
28777 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
28778 option to do this.)
28779
28780
28781
28782 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
28783 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
28784 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
28785 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
28786 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
28787 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
28788 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
28789
28790 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
28791 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
28792 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
28793 example:
28794 .code
28795 deny dnslists = list1.example
28796 dnslists = list2.example
28797 .endd
28798 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
28799 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
28800 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
28801 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
28802 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
28803
28804
28805 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
28806 The ACL verbs are as follows:
28807
28808 .ilist
28809 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
28810 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
28811 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
28812 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
28813 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
28814 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
28815 check a RCPT command:
28816 .code
28817 accept domains = +local_domains
28818 endpass
28819 verify = recipient
28820 .endd
28821 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
28822 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
28823 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
28824 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
28825 &%endpass%&.
28826
28827 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
28828 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
28829 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
28830 configuration.
28831
28832 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
28833 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
28834 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
28835 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
28836 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
28837 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
28838 .display
28839 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
28840 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
28841 .endd
28842 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
28843 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
28844 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
28845
28846 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
28847 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
28848 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
28849 of &%endpass%&.
28850
28851
28852 .next
28853 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
28854 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
28855 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
28856 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
28857 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
28858 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
28859 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
28860
28861
28862 .next
28863 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
28864 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
28865 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
28866 example,
28867 .code
28868 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28869 .endd
28870 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
28871
28872
28873 .next
28874 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
28875 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
28876 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
28877 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
28878 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
28879 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
28880 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
28881 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
28882 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
28883
28884 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
28885 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
28886 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
28887
28888
28889 .next
28890 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
28891 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
28892 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
28893 .code
28894 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
28895 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
28896 .endd
28897 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
28898 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
28899
28900 .next
28901 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
28902 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
28903 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
28904 example, when checking a RCPT command,
28905 .code
28906 require message = Sender did not verify
28907 verify = sender
28908 .endd
28909 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
28910 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
28911 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
28912 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
28913
28914 .next
28915 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28916 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
28917 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
28918 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
28919 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
28920 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
28921 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
28922
28923 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
28924 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
28925 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
28926 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
28927 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28928
28929 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
28930 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
28931 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
28932 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
28933 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
28934 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
28935 onwards.
28936
28937
28938 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28939 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
28940 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
28941 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
28942 .code
28943 warn !verify = sender
28944 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
28945 .endd
28946 .endlist
28947
28948 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
28949
28950 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
28951 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
28952 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
28953 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
28954 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
28955
28956
28957
28958 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
28959 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
28960 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
28961 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
28962 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
28963 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
28964 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
28965 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
28966 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
28967 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
28968 .ilist
28969 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
28970 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
28971 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
28972 on the same SMTP connection.
28973 .next
28974 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
28975 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
28976 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
28977 .endlist
28978
28979 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
28980 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
28981 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
28982 .code
28983 accept hosts = whatever
28984 set acl_m4 = some value
28985 accept authenticated = *
28986 set acl_c_auth = yes
28987 .endd
28988 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
28989 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
28990 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
28991
28992 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
28993 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
28994 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
28995 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
28996 error is generated.
28997
28998 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
28999 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
29000
29001
29002 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
29003 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
29004 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
29005 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
29006 .code
29007 deny domains = *.dom.example
29008 !verify = recipient
29009 .endd
29010 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
29011 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
29012 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
29013 two statements are equivalent:
29014 .code
29015 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
29016 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
29017 .endd
29018 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
29019 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
29020
29021 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
29022 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
29023 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
29024 .code
29025 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29026 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
29027 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29028 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
29029 .endd
29030 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
29031 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
29032 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
29033 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
29034 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
29035 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
29036 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
29037
29038 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
29039 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
29040 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
29041 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
29042 message is handled.
29043
29044 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
29045 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
29046 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
29047 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
29048 .code
29049 require message = Can't verify sender
29050 verify = sender
29051 message = Can't verify recipient
29052 verify = recipient
29053 message = This message cannot be used
29054 .endd
29055 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
29056 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
29057 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
29058 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
29059 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
29060 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
29061
29062 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
29063 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
29064 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
29065 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
29066 .code
29067 deny hosts = ...
29068 !senders = *@my.domain.example
29069 message = Invalid sender from client host
29070 .endd
29071 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
29072 by which time Exim has set up the message.
29073
29074
29075
29076 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
29077 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
29078 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
29079
29080 .vlist
29081 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29082 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
29083 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
29084 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29085
29086 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29087 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
29088 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
29089 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
29090 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
29091 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
29092 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
29093 write rather ugly lines like this:
29094 .display
29095 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
29096 .endd
29097 Instead, all you need is
29098 .display
29099 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
29100 .endd
29101
29102 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29103 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29104 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
29105 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
29106 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
29107 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
29108 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
29109 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
29110
29111 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
29112 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
29113 in several different ways. For example:
29114
29115 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
29116 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
29117 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
29118 . ==== way.
29119
29120 .ilist
29121 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
29122 .code
29123 accept ...some conditions
29124 control = queue_only
29125 .endd
29126 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
29127 other words, when the conditions are all true.
29128
29129 .next
29130 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
29131 .code
29132 accept ...some conditions...
29133 control = queue_only
29134 ...some more conditions...
29135 .endd
29136 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
29137 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
29138 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
29139 to be relevant.
29140
29141 .next
29142 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
29143 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
29144 example:
29145 .code
29146 warn ...some conditions...
29147 control = freeze
29148 accept ...
29149 .endd
29150 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
29151 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
29152 log entry.
29153
29154 .next
29155 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
29156 &%require%& verb. For example:
29157 .code
29158 require control = no_multiline_responses
29159 .endd
29160 .endlist
29161
29162 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
29163 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
29164 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
29165 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
29166 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
29167 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
29168 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
29169 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
29170 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
29171
29172 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
29173 example:
29174 .code
29175 deny ...some conditions...
29176 delay = 30s
29177 .endd
29178 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
29179 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
29180 .code
29181 deny delay = 30s
29182 ...some conditions...
29183 .endd
29184 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
29185 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
29186 .code
29187 warn ...some conditions...
29188 delay = 2m
29189 control = freeze
29190 accept ...
29191 .endd
29192
29193 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
29194 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
29195 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
29196 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
29197 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
29198 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
29199 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
29200
29201
29202 .vitem &*endpass*&
29203 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
29204 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
29205 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
29206 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
29207 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
29208 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
29209 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
29210
29211
29212 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29213 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
29214 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
29215 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
29216 .code
29217 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
29218 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
29219 .endd
29220 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
29221 example:
29222 .display
29223 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
29224 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
29225 .endd
29226 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
29227 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
29228 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
29229 message.
29230
29231 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
29232 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
29233 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
29234 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
29235 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
29236 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
29237 ignored.
29238
29239 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29240 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
29241 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
29242 error message.
29243
29244 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
29245 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
29246 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
29247 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
29248 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
29249 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
29250
29251 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
29252 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
29253 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
29254 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
29255 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
29256 logging rejections.
29257
29258
29259 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
29260 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
29261 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
29262 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
29263 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
29264 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
29265 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
29266 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
29267 .display
29268 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
29269 &` log_reject_target =`&
29270 .endd
29271 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
29272 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
29273 current ACL.
29274
29275
29276 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29277 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
29278 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
29279 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
29280 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
29281 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
29282 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
29283 ACLs. For example:
29284 .display
29285 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
29286 &` control = freeze`&
29287 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
29288 .endd
29289 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
29290 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
29291 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
29292 example:
29293 .code
29294 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
29295 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
29296 .endd
29297
29298
29299 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29300 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
29301 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
29302 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
29303 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
29304 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
29305 &%accept%& for details.)
29306
29307 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
29308 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
29309 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
29310 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
29311 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
29312 .code
29313 require message = Host not recognized
29314 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
29315 .endd
29316 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
29317 processed.)
29318
29319 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
29320 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
29321 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
29322 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
29323 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
29324 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
29325 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
29326 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
29327 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
29328 EHLO options.
29329
29330 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
29331 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
29332 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
29333 .code
29334 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
29335 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
29336 .endd
29337 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
29338 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
29339 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
29340 2&'xx'&.
29341
29342 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
29343 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
29344
29345 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
29346 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
29347 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
29348 response.
29349
29350 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29351 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
29352 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
29353
29354 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
29355 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
29356 However, the original message is available in the variable
29357 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
29358 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
29359 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
29360 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
29361
29362 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
29363 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
29364 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
29365 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
29366 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
29367 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
29368 effect.
29369
29370
29371 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29372 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
29373 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
29374 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
29375 for the message.
29376 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
29377 the DATA ACL).
29378 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
29379 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
29380 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
29381 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
29382
29383
29384 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29385 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
29386 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
29387 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
29388
29389
29390 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
29391 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
29392 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
29393 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
29394
29395
29396 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
29397 .cindex "UDP communications"
29398 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
29399 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
29400 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
29401 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
29402 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
29403 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
29404 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
29405 when:
29406 .code
29407 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
29408 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
29409 .endd
29410 .endlist
29411
29412
29413
29414
29415 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
29416 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29417 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
29418
29419 .vlist
29420 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
29421 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
29422 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
29423 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
29424 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
29425 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
29426 not work without it. For example:
29427 .code
29428 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
29429 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
29430 .endd
29431 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
29432 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
29433 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
29434 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
29435 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
29436
29437
29438 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
29439 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
29440 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
29441 .cindex "case of local parts"
29442 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29443 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
29444 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
29445 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
29446 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
29447 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
29448 is encountered.
29449
29450 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
29451 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
29452 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
29453 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
29454 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
29455
29456 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
29457 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
29458 spam score:
29459 .code
29460 warn control = caseful_local_part
29461 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
29462 $acl_m4 + \
29463 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
29464 }
29465 control = caselower_local_part
29466 .endd
29467 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
29468 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
29469
29470
29471 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
29472 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
29473 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
29474 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
29475
29476 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
29477 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
29478 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
29479 is used for all recipients of the message,
29480 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
29481 and data is copied from one to the other.
29482
29483 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
29484 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
29485 If a recipient-verify callout
29486 (with use_sender)
29487 connection is subsequently
29488 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
29489 any subsequent recipients and the data,
29490 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
29491
29492 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
29493 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
29494 Note also that headers cannot be
29495 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
29496 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
29497 The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
29498 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
29499 this will affect the timestamp.
29500
29501 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
29502 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
29503 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
29504 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
29505 message body.
29506
29507 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
29508 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
29509 before the entire message has been received from the source.
29510 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
29511 or CHUNKING
29512 options in use.
29513
29514 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
29515 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
29516 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
29517 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
29518 before the acceptance "<=" line.
29519
29520 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
29521 usual fashion.
29522 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
29523 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
29524 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
29525 and does not queue the message.
29526 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
29527
29528 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
29529 (possibly faked)
29530 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
29531
29532
29533 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
29534 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
29535 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
29536 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
29537 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
29538 by default called &'debuglog'&.
29539 The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
29540 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
29541 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
29542 option.
29543 Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
29544 with the &'kill'& option.
29545 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
29546 contexts):
29547 .code
29548 control = debug
29549 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
29550 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
29551 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
29552 control = debug/kill
29553 .endd
29554
29555
29556 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
29557 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
29558 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
29559 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
29560 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29561
29562
29563 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
29564 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
29565 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
29566 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
29567 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
29568 strings or to numeric value.
29569 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
29570 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
29571 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
29572
29573 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
29574 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
29575 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
29576 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
29577 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
29578
29579
29580 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
29581 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
29582 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
29583 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
29584 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
29585 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
29586 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
29587 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
29588
29589 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
29590 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
29591 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
29592 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
29593 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
29594 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
29595 work with.
29596
29597
29598 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
29599 .cindex "fake defer"
29600 .cindex "defer, fake"
29601 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
29602 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
29603 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
29604 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
29605 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
29606
29607 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
29608 .cindex "fake rejection"
29609 .cindex "rejection, fake"
29610 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
29611 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
29612 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
29613 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
29614 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29615 the same SMTP connection.
29616
29617 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
29618 message is supplied, the following is used:
29619 .code
29620 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
29621 550-kept for evaluation.
29622 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
29623 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
29624 .endd
29625 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
29626
29627 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
29628 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
29629 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29630 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29631 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
29632 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
29633 SMTP connection.
29634
29635 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
29636 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
29637 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
29638 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
29639
29640 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
29641 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
29642 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
29643 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29644 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
29645 disables such output flushing.
29646
29647 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
29648 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
29649 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
29650 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29651 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
29652 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
29653
29654 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
29655 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
29656 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
29657 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
29658 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
29659 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
29660 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29661 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
29662 to be useful in production.
29663
29664 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
29665 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
29666 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
29667 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
29668 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
29669
29670 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
29671 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
29672 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
29673 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
29674 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
29675 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
29676
29677 .ilist
29678 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
29679 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
29680 verification failed"&) is sent.
29681 .next
29682 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
29683 line is output.
29684 .endlist
29685
29686 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
29687 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
29688
29689 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
29690 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
29691 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
29692 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
29693 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
29694 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
29695 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
29696
29697 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
29698 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
29699 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
29700 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29701 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29702 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
29703 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
29704 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
29705 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
29706 same SMTP connection.
29707
29708 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
29709 .cindex "message" "submission"
29710 .cindex "submission mode"
29711 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
29712 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
29713 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
29714 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
29715 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
29716 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
29717 late (the message has already been created).
29718
29719 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
29720 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
29721 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
29722 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
29723 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
29724
29725 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
29726 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
29727 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
29728 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
29729 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
29730
29731 .ilist
29732 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
29733 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
29734 .next
29735 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
29736 .next
29737 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
29738 .endlist ilist
29739
29740 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
29741 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
29742 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29743 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
29744 data is read.
29745
29746 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
29747 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
29748
29749 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
29750 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
29751 to a-label form.
29752 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
29753 .endlist vlist
29754
29755
29756 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
29757 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
29758
29759 .ilist
29760 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
29761 .next
29762 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
29763 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
29764 .next
29765 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
29766 .next
29767 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
29768 .endlist
29769
29770
29771
29772 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
29773 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
29774 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
29775 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
29776 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
29777 to an incoming message, as in this example:
29778 .code
29779 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29780 dialup.mail-abuse.org
29781 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
29782 .endd
29783 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29784 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29785 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29786 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
29787 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
29788 RCPT ACL).
29789
29790 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
29791 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29792
29793 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
29794 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
29795 contains one or more newlines that
29796 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
29797 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
29798 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
29799
29800 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29801 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29802 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
29803 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
29804 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
29805 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
29806 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
29807 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
29808 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
29809 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
29810 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
29811
29812 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
29813 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
29814 of message headers
29815 until they are added to the
29816 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
29817 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
29818 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
29819 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
29820 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
29821 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
29822 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29823
29824 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
29825
29826 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29827 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29828 .display
29829 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29830 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
29831
29832 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29833 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29834 .endd
29835 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
29836 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
29837 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
29838 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
29839 honoured.
29840
29841 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29842 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
29843 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
29844 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
29845 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
29846 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
29847 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
29848 specifications.
29849
29850 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
29851 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
29852 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
29853 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
29854 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
29855
29856 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
29857 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
29858 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
29859 to be a header name first.) For example:
29860 .code
29861 warn add_header = \
29862 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
29863 .endd
29864 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
29865 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
29866 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
29867 up in reverse order.
29868
29869 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29870 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
29871 system filter or in a router or transport.
29872
29873
29874
29875 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
29876 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
29877 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
29878 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
29879 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
29880 from an incoming message, as in this example:
29881 .code
29882 warn message = Remove internal headers
29883 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29884 .endd
29885 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29886 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29887 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29888 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
29889 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
29890 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
29891
29892 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
29893 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29894
29895 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
29896 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
29897 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
29898 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
29899 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
29900 .code
29901 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
29902 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29903 warn message = Remove internal headers
29904 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
29905 .endd
29906 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29907 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29908 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
29909 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
29910 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
29911 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
29912 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
29913 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
29914 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
29915 would have been removed.
29916
29917 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
29918 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
29919 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
29920 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
29921 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
29922 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
29923 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
29924 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
29925 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29926
29927 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29928 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29929 .display
29930 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
29931 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
29932
29933 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29934 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
29935 .endd
29936 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
29937 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
29938 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
29939 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
29940 are honoured.
29941
29942 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29943 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
29944 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
29945
29946
29947
29948
29949 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
29950 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
29951 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
29952 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
29953 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
29954 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29955
29956 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
29957 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
29958 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
29959 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
29960 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
29961 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
29962 The conditions are as follows:
29963
29964
29965 .vlist
29966 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
29967 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
29968 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
29969 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
29970 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
29971 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
29972 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
29973 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
29974 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
29975 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
29976 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
29977 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
29978
29979 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
29980 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
29981 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
29982 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
29983 The name and values are expanded separately.
29984 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
29985 will act as argument separators.
29986
29987 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
29988 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
29989 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
29990 conditions are tested.
29991
29992 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
29993 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
29994 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
29995 for different local users or different local domains.
29996
29997 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29998 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
29999 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
30000 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
30001 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
30002 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
30003 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
30004 .code
30005 authenticated = *
30006 .endd
30007
30008 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
30009 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
30010 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
30011 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
30012 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
30013 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
30014 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
30015 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
30016 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
30017 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
30018 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
30019 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
30020 negative.
30021
30022 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
30023 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
30024 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30025 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30026 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
30027 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
30028 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
30029 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30030
30031 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
30032 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
30033 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30034 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
30035 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30036 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
30037 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
30038 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
30039 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
30040 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
30041
30042 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30043 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
30044 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
30045 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
30046 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
30047 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
30048 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
30049 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
30050 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
30051 &%domains%& test.
30052
30053 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
30054 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
30055
30056
30057 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30058 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
30059 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
30060 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
30061 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
30062 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
30063 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
30064 .code
30065 encrypted = *
30066 .endd
30067
30068
30069 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
30070 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
30071 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
30072 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
30073 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
30074 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
30075 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
30076 .code
30077 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30078 .endd
30079 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
30080 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
30081 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
30082
30083 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
30084 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
30085 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
30086 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
30087 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
30088 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
30089
30090 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
30091 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
30092 .code
30093 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30094 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
30095 .endd
30096 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
30097 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
30098 statement can then check the IP address.
30099
30100 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
30101 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
30102 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
30103 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
30104 .code
30105 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
30106 message = $host_data
30107 .endd
30108 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
30109
30110 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
30111 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
30112 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
30113 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
30114 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
30115 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
30116 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
30117 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
30118 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
30119 the next &%local_parts%& test.
30120
30121 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
30122 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
30123 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
30124 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
30125 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30126 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
30127 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30128
30129 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30130 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
30131 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30132 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30133 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30134 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
30135 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
30136 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30137
30138 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
30139 .cindex "rate limiting"
30140 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
30141 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
30142
30143 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30144 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
30145 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
30146 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
30147 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
30148 recipient address against a list of recipients.
30149
30150 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30151 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
30152 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30153 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30154 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
30155 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
30156 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30157
30158 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30159 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
30160 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30161 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
30162 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30163 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
30164 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
30165 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
30166 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
30167 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
30168 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
30169 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
30170 influence the sender checking.
30171
30172 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30173 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30174
30175 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30176 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
30177 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30178 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
30179 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
30180 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
30181 .code
30182 senders = :
30183 .endd
30184 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30185 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30186
30187 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
30188 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
30189 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
30190 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30191 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
30192 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30193
30194 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
30195 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30196 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
30197 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
30198 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
30199 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
30200 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
30201 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
30202 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
30203 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
30204
30205 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
30206 .cindex "CSA verification"
30207 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
30208 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
30209 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
30210
30211 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
30212 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30213 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30214 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30215 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
30216 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30217 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30218 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
30219 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
30220 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
30221
30222 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
30223 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
30224 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
30225
30226 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
30227 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30228 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
30229 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
30230 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
30231 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
30232 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30233 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30234 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
30235 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
30236 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
30237 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
30238 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
30239 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
30240 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
30241
30242 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
30243 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
30244 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
30245 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
30246 .code
30247 deny senders = :
30248 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
30249 !verify = header_sender
30250 .endd
30251
30252 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
30253 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30254 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
30255 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
30256 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
30257 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30258 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30259 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
30260 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
30261 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
30262 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
30263 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
30264 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
30265 appropriate.
30266
30267 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
30268 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
30269 .code
30270 To: @
30271 .endd
30272 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
30273 common as they used to be.
30274
30275 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
30276 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30277 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
30278 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
30279 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
30280 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
30281 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
30282 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
30283 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
30284 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
30285 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
30286 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
30287 independently of this condition.
30288
30289 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
30290 option), this condition is always true.
30291
30292
30293 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
30294 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
30295 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
30296 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
30297 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
30298 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
30299 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
30300 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
30301 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
30302
30303 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
30304 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
30305
30306
30307 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
30308 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30309 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
30310 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
30311 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
30312 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
30313 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
30314 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
30315 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
30316 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
30317 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
30318 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
30319 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
30320 value for the child address.
30321
30322 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
30323 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30324 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
30325 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
30326 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
30327 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
30328 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
30329 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
30330 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
30331 original IP address.
30332
30333 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
30334 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
30335
30336 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
30337 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
30338
30339 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
30340 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30341 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
30342 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
30343 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
30344 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
30345 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
30346 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
30347 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
30348
30349 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
30350 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
30351 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
30352 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
30353 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
30354 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
30355 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
30356
30357 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
30358 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
30359 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
30360
30361 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
30362 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30363 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
30364 verified as a sender.
30365
30366 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
30367 (eg. is generated from the received message)
30368 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
30369 .code
30370 verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
30371 .endd
30372 .endlist
30373
30374
30375
30376 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
30377 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30378 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
30379 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30380 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
30381 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
30382 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
30383 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
30384 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
30385 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
30386 .code
30387 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
30388 dialups.mail-abuse.org
30389 .endd
30390 the following records are looked up:
30391 .code
30392 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30393 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
30394 .endd
30395 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
30396 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
30397 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
30398 use two separate conditions:
30399 .code
30400 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30401 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30402 .endd
30403 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
30404 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
30405 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
30406 processed.
30407
30408 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
30409 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
30410 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
30411 following special items in the list:
30412 .display
30413 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
30414 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
30415 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
30416 .endd
30417 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
30418 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
30419 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
30420 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
30421 .code
30422 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
30423 .endd
30424 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
30425 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
30426 .code
30427 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30428 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
30429 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30430 .endd
30431 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
30432 .cindex DNS TTL
30433 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
30434 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
30435 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
30436 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
30437 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
30438 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
30439
30440
30441
30442 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
30443 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
30444 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
30445 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
30446 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
30447 .code
30448 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
30449 .endd
30450 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
30451 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
30452 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
30453 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
30454
30455
30456
30457
30458 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
30459 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
30460 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
30461 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
30462 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
30463 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
30464 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
30465 .code
30466 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
30467 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30468 .endd
30469 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
30470 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
30471 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
30472 up by this example is
30473 .code
30474 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
30475 .endd
30476 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
30477 addresses. For example:
30478 .code
30479 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30480 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30481 .endd
30482 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
30483 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
30484
30485
30486
30487
30488 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
30489 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
30490 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
30491 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
30492 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
30493 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
30494 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
30495 either to double the separators like this:
30496 .code
30497 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
30498 .endd
30499 or to change the separator character, like this:
30500 .code
30501 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
30502 .endd
30503 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
30504 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
30505 occurs. Consider this condition:
30506 .code
30507 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
30508 .endd
30509 The DNS lookups that occur are:
30510 .code
30511 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
30512 a.domain.black.list.tld
30513 .endd
30514 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
30515 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
30516 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
30517 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
30518 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
30519 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
30520 error for a previous item.
30521
30522 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
30523 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
30524 .code
30525 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
30526 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
30527 .endd
30528 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
30529 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
30530 .code
30531 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
30532 $sender_address_domain \
30533 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
30534 see $dnslist_text.
30535 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
30536 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
30537 $sender_address_domain} }} }
30538 .endd
30539 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
30540 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
30541 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
30542 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
30543 .code
30544 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
30545 .endd
30546 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
30547 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
30548
30549 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
30550 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
30551
30552
30553
30554
30555 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
30556 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
30557 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
30558 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
30559 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
30560 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
30561 .display
30562 127.1.0.1 RBL
30563 127.1.0.2 DUL
30564 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
30565 127.1.0.4 RSS
30566 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
30567 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
30568 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
30569 .endd
30570 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
30571 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
30572 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
30573
30574
30575 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
30576 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
30577 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
30578 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
30579 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
30580 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
30581 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
30582 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
30583 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
30584 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
30585 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
30586 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
30587 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
30588 cases, for example:
30589 .code
30590 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
30591 .endd
30592 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
30593 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
30594 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
30595 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
30596 .code
30597 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
30598 .endd
30599 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
30600 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
30601
30602 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
30603 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
30604 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
30605 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
30606 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
30607 information.
30608
30609 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
30610 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
30611 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
30612 .code
30613 deny hosts = !+local_networks
30614 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
30615 at $dnslist_domain
30616 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
30617 .endd
30618
30619
30620
30621 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
30622 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
30623 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
30624 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
30625 For example,
30626 .code
30627 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
30628 .endd
30629 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
30630 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
30631 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
30632 describes how multiple records are handled.
30633
30634 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
30635 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
30636 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
30637 .code
30638 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30639 .endd
30640 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
30641 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
30642 first. For example:
30643 .code
30644 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
30645 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
30646 .endd
30647
30648 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
30649 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
30650 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
30651 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
30652 tested. For example:
30653 .code
30654 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
30655 .endd
30656 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
30657 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
30658 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
30659 .code
30660 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30661 .endd
30662 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
30663 an odd number.
30664
30665
30666
30667 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
30668 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
30669 condition. Whereas
30670 .code
30671 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30672 .endd
30673 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30674 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
30675 .code
30676 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30677 .endd
30678 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30679 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
30680 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
30681 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
30682
30683 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
30684 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
30685
30686 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
30687 previous example is precisely equivalent to
30688 .code
30689 deny dnslists = a.b.c
30690 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30691 .endd
30692 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
30693 Consider this example:
30694 .code
30695 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30696 list.dsbl.org : \
30697 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
30698 relays.ordb.org
30699 .endd
30700 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
30701 .code
30702 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30703 list.dsbl.org
30704 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
30705 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
30706 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
30707 .endd
30708 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
30709
30710
30711
30712
30713 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
30714 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
30715 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
30716 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
30717 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
30718 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
30719 .code
30720 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
30721 .endd
30722 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
30723 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
30724 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
30725 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
30726 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
30727 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
30728
30729 .ilist
30730 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
30731 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
30732 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30733 .next
30734 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
30735 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
30736 changed to:
30737 .code
30738 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
30739 .endd
30740 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30741 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
30742 .code
30743 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
30744 .endd
30745 for the condition to be true.
30746 .endlist
30747
30748 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
30749 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
30750 .ilist
30751 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
30752 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
30753 .code
30754 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
30755 .endd
30756 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30757 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30758 .next
30759 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
30760 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
30761 .code
30762 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
30763 .endd
30764 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30765 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
30766 .code
30767 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30768 .endd
30769 for the condition to be false.
30770 .endlist
30771 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
30772 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
30773
30774
30775
30776
30777 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
30778 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
30779 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
30780 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
30781 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
30782 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
30783 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
30784 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
30785 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
30786 lists.
30787
30788 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
30789 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
30790 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
30791 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
30792 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
30793 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
30794 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
30795 .code
30796 deny message = \
30797 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
30798 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
30799 dnslists = \
30800 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
30801 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30802 .endd
30803 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
30804 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
30805 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
30806 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
30807 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
30808 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
30809
30810 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
30811 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
30812 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
30813 .code
30814 deny dnslists = \
30815 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
30816 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
30817 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
30818 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30819 .endd
30820 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
30821 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
30822 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
30823
30824
30825
30826 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
30827 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
30828 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
30829 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
30830 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
30831 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
30832 .code
30833 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
30834 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30835 .endd
30836 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
30837 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
30838 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
30839 .code
30840 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
30841 .endd
30842 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
30843 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
30844
30845 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
30846 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
30847 .code
30848 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
30849 dnslists = some.list.example
30850 .endd
30851
30852 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
30853 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
30854 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
30855 .code
30856 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
30857 .endd
30858
30859 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
30860 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
30861 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
30862 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
30863 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
30864 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
30865 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
30866 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
30867 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
30868 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
30869 .display
30870 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
30871 .endd
30872 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
30873 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
30874
30875 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
30876 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
30877 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
30878 of &'p'&.
30879
30880 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
30881 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
30882 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
30883 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
30884 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
30885 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
30886 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
30887 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
30888 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
30889
30890 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
30891 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
30892 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
30893 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
30894
30895 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
30896 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
30897 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
30898 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
30899 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
30900 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
30901 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
30902 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
30903 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
30904 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
30905
30906 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
30907 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
30908 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
30909 ACL.
30910
30911 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
30912 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
30913 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
30914 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
30915 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
30916 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
30917
30918 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
30919 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
30920 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
30921 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
30922 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
30923 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
30924 the &%count=%& option.
30925
30926
30927 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
30928 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
30929 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
30930 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
30931 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
30932
30933 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
30934 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
30935 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
30936 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
30937
30938 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
30939 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
30940 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
30941 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
30942 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
30943 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
30944 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
30945
30946 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
30947 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30948 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
30949 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
30950 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
30951 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
30952 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
30953
30954 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
30955 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
30956 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
30957 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
30958 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
30959
30960 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
30961 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
30962 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
30963 multiple different commands.
30964
30965 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
30966 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
30967 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
30968 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
30969 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
30970
30971 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
30972
30973
30974 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
30975 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
30976 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
30977 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
30978 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
30979
30980 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
30981 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
30982
30983 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
30984 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
30985 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
30986 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
30987 new rate.
30988 .code
30989 acl_check_connect:
30990 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
30991 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30992 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30993 # ...
30994 acl_check_mail:
30995 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
30996 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30997 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30998 .endd
30999
31000 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
31001 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
31002 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
31003 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
31004 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
31005 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
31006 checks.
31007
31008 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
31009 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
31010 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
31011 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
31012 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
31013
31014
31015 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
31016 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
31017 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
31018 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
31019 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
31020 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
31021 rest of the ACL.
31022
31023 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
31024 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
31025 client's average rate of successfully sent email,
31026 .new
31027 up to the given limit.
31028 This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
31029 consists of refusing the message, and
31030 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
31031 If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
31032 likely not what is wanted.
31033 .wen
31034
31035 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
31036 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
31037 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
31038 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
31039 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
31040 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
31041 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
31042 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
31043 .code
31044 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
31045 .endd
31046
31047
31048 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
31049 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
31050 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
31051 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
31052 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
31053 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
31054 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
31055 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
31056 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
31057
31058 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
31059 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
31060 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
31061 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
31062 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
31063 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
31064
31065 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
31066 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
31067 rate.
31068
31069 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
31070 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
31071 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
31072 required increases with larger limits.
31073
31074 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
31075 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
31076 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
31077 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
31078 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
31079 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
31080 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
31081 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
31082 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
31083 as intended.
31084
31085
31086 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
31087 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
31088 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
31089 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
31090 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
31091 message. For example:
31092 .code
31093 # Log all senders' rates
31094 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
31095 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
31096
31097 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
31098 # at the decimal point.
31099 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
31100 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
31101 $sender_rate_limit }s
31102
31103 # Keep authenticated users under control
31104 deny authenticated = *
31105 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
31106
31107 # System-wide rate limit
31108 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
31109 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
31110
31111 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
31112 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
31113 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
31114 messages per $sender_rate_period
31115 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
31116 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
31117 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
31118 .endd
31119 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
31120 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
31121 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
31122 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
31123 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
31124 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
31125 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
31126
31127
31128
31129 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
31130 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
31131 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
31132 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
31133 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
31134 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
31135 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
31136 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
31137 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
31138 .code
31139 verify = sender/callout
31140 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
31141 .endd
31142 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
31143 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
31144 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
31145 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
31146 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
31147 The available options are as follows:
31148
31149 .ilist
31150 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
31151 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
31152 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
31153 .next
31154 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
31155 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
31156 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
31157 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
31158 .next
31159 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
31160 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
31161 .next
31162 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
31163 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
31164 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
31165 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
31166 .endlist
31167
31168 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
31169 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
31170 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
31171 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31172 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
31173 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
31174 coding like this:
31175 .code
31176 warn !verify = sender
31177 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
31178 .endd
31179 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
31180 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
31181 verification failure.
31182
31183 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
31184 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
31185
31186 .ilist
31187 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
31188 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
31189 .next
31190 &%route%&: Routing failed.
31191 .next
31192 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
31193 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
31194 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
31195 .next
31196 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
31197 .next
31198 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
31199 .endlist
31200
31201 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
31202 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
31203
31204 .new
31205 The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
31206 address verification to:
31207
31208 .ilist
31209 &%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
31210 .endlist
31211 .wen
31212
31213
31214
31215
31216 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
31217 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
31218 .cindex "callout" "verification"
31219 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
31220 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
31221 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
31222 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
31223 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
31224 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
31225 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
31226 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
31227 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
31228 sender's domain.
31229
31230 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
31231 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
31232 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
31233 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
31234 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
31235 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
31236
31237 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
31238 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
31239 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
31240 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
31241 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
31242
31243 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
31244 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
31245 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
31246 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
31247 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
31248 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
31249 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
31250 supplies a host list.
31251 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
31252
31253 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
31254 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
31255 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
31256 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
31257 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
31258 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
31259 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
31260
31261 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
31262 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
31263 following SMTP commands are sent:
31264 .display
31265 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
31266 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
31267 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
31268 &`QUIT`&
31269 .endd
31270 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
31271 set to &"lmtp"&.
31272
31273 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
31274 settings.
31275
31276 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
31277 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
31278 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
31279 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
31280 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
31281 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
31282
31283 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
31284 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
31285 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
31286 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
31287 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
31288
31289 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
31290 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
31291 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
31292 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
31293 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
31294
31295
31296
31297
31298 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
31299 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
31300 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
31301 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
31302 .code
31303 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
31304 .endd
31305 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
31306 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
31307 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
31308
31309
31310 .vlist
31311 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
31312 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
31313 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
31314 For example:
31315 .code
31316 verify = sender/callout=5s
31317 .endd
31318 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
31319 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
31320 the &%connect%& parameter.
31321
31322
31323 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31324 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
31325 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
31326 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
31327 .code
31328 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
31329 .endd
31330 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
31331
31332 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
31333 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
31334 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
31335 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
31336 updated in this circumstance.
31337
31338 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
31339 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
31340 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
31341 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
31342 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
31343 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
31344
31345
31346 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31347 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
31348 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
31349 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
31350 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
31351 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
31352 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
31353 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
31354 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
31355 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
31356 .code
31357 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
31358 .endd
31359 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
31360
31361
31362 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31363 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
31364 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
31365 For example:
31366 .code
31367 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
31368 .endd
31369 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
31370 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
31371 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
31372 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
31373 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
31374
31375
31376 .vitem &*no_cache*&
31377 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
31378 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
31379 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
31380
31381 .vitem &*postmaster*&
31382 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
31383 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
31384 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
31385 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
31386 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
31387 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
31388 made, until the cache record expires.
31389
31390 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31391 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
31392 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
31393 For example:
31394 .code
31395 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
31396 .endd
31397 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
31398 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
31399 .code
31400 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
31401 .endd
31402 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
31403 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
31404 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
31405 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
31406
31407
31408 .vitem &*random*&
31409 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
31410 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
31411 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
31412 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
31413 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
31414 .code
31415 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
31416 .endd
31417 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
31418 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
31419 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
31420 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
31421 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
31422
31423 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
31424 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
31425 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31426 .code
31427 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
31428 .endd
31429 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31430 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
31431 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
31432 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
31433 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
31434
31435 .vitem &*use_sender*&
31436 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31437 .code
31438 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
31439 .endd
31440 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
31441 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
31442 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
31443 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
31444 usefulness of callout caching.
31445
31446 .vitem &*hold*&
31447 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31448 .code
31449 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
31450 .endd
31451 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
31452 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
31453 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
31454 when that is used for the connections.
31455 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
31456 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
31457 if the use_sender option is used,
31458 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
31459 and if no other callouts intervene.
31460 .endlist
31461
31462 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
31463 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
31464 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
31465 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
31466 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
31467 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
31468 these circumstances.
31469
31470 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
31471 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
31472 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
31473 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
31474 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
31475 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
31476 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
31477
31478 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
31479 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
31480 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
31481 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
31482
31483
31484
31485
31486 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
31487 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
31488 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
31489 .cindex "caching" "callout"
31490 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
31491 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
31492 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
31493 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
31494 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
31495 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
31496
31497 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
31498 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
31499 is not available.
31500
31501 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
31502 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
31503 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
31504
31505 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
31506 commands up to and including
31507 .code
31508 MAIL FROM:<>
31509 .endd
31510 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
31511 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
31512 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
31513 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
31514 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
31515 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
31516 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
31517
31518 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
31519 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
31520 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
31521 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
31522 will eventually be noticed.
31523
31524 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
31525 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
31526 behaviour will be the same.
31527
31528
31529
31530 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
31531 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
31532 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
31533 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
31534 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
31535 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
31536 you might see:
31537 .code
31538 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
31539 250 OK
31540 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
31541 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
31542 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
31543 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
31544 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
31545 550 Sender verification failed
31546 .endd
31547 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
31548 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
31549 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
31550 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
31551 example:
31552 .code
31553 verify = sender/no_details
31554 .endd
31555
31556 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
31557 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
31558 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
31559 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
31560 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
31561 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
31562 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
31563
31564 .ilist
31565 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
31566 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
31567 verification also fails.
31568 .next
31569 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
31570 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
31571 .endlist
31572
31573 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
31574 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
31575 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
31576 .code
31577 A.Wol: aw123
31578 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
31579 .endd
31580 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
31581 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
31582 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
31583 verification to succeed.
31584
31585 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
31586 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
31587 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
31588 option. For example:
31589 .code
31590 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
31591 .endd
31592 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
31593 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
31594
31595 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
31596 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
31597 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
31598 address and a report is output for each of them.
31599
31600
31601
31602 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
31603 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
31604 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
31605 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
31606 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
31607 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
31608 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
31609 .code
31610 verify = csa
31611 .endd
31612 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
31613 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
31614 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
31615 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
31616 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
31617 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
31618
31619 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
31620 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
31621 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
31622 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
31623
31624 .ilist
31625 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
31626 .next
31627 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
31628 .next
31629 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
31630 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
31631 .next
31632 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
31633 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
31634 .endlist
31635
31636 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
31637 use for the DNS query. The default is:
31638 .code
31639 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
31640 .endd
31641 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
31642 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
31643 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
31644 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
31645 meaningful to say:
31646 .code
31647 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
31648 .endd
31649 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
31650 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
31651 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
31652
31653 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
31654 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
31655 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
31656 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
31657 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
31658 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
31659 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
31660 of legitimate HELO domains.
31661
31662 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
31663 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
31664 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
31665 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
31666 lookup such as:
31667 .code
31668 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
31669 .endd
31670 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
31671 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
31672 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
31673
31674
31675
31676
31677 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
31678 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
31679 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
31680 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
31681 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
31682 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
31683 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
31684 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
31685
31686 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
31687 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
31688 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
31689 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
31690 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
31691 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
31692 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
31693 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
31694
31695 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
31696 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
31697 like this:
31698 .code
31699 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
31700 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
31701 }{$value}}
31702 .endd
31703 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
31704 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
31705 use this:
31706 .code
31707 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
31708 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
31709 senders = :
31710 recipients = +batv_senders
31711
31712 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
31713 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
31714 senders = :
31715 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
31716 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
31717 !condition = $prvscheck_result
31718 .endd
31719 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
31720 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
31721 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
31722 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
31723 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
31724
31725 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
31726 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
31727 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
31728 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
31729 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
31730 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
31731 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
31732
31733 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
31734 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
31735 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
31736 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
31737 .code
31738 batv_redirect:
31739 driver = redirect
31740 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
31741 .endd
31742 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
31743 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
31744 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
31745 local addresses.
31746
31747 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
31748 can be used:
31749 .code
31750 external_smtp_batv:
31751 driver = smtp
31752 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
31753 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
31754 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
31755 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
31756 {$value}fail}}}
31757 .endd
31758 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
31759
31760
31761
31762 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
31763 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
31764 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
31765 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
31766 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
31767 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
31768 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
31769 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
31770 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
31771 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
31772
31773 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
31774 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
31775 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
31776 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
31777 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
31778 same host is fulfilling both functions,
31779 . ///
31780 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
31781 . ///
31782 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
31783 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
31784 system to arbitrary domains.
31785
31786
31787 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
31788 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
31789 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
31790 example, suppose you want to do the following:
31791
31792 .ilist
31793 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
31794 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
31795 &'my.dom2.example'&.
31796 .next
31797 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
31798 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
31799 .next
31800 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
31801 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
31802 .endlist
31803
31804
31805 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
31806 .code
31807 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
31808 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
31809 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
31810 .endd
31811 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
31812 command:
31813 .code
31814 acl_check_rcpt:
31815 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
31816 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
31817 .endd
31818 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
31819 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
31820 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
31821 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
31822 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
31823 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
31824 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
31825
31826
31827
31828 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
31829 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
31830 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
31831 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
31832 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
31833 .ecindex IIDacl
31834
31835
31836
31837 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31838 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31839
31840 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
31841 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
31842 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
31843 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
31844 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
31845 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
31846 specification.
31847
31848 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
31849 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
31850 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
31851 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
31852 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
31853
31854 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
31855 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
31856 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
31857
31858 .ilist
31859 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
31860 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
31861 .next
31862 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
31863 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
31864 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
31865 .next
31866 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
31867 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
31868 .next
31869 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
31870 conditions.
31871 .next
31872 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
31873 .endlist
31874
31875 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
31876 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
31877 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
31878 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
31879 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
31880 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
31881
31882 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
31883 temporarily created in a file called:
31884 .display
31885 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
31886 .endd
31887 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
31888 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
31889 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
31890 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
31891 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
31892 .code
31893 control = no_mbox_unspool
31894 .endd
31895 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
31896 same directory by default.
31897
31898
31899
31900 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
31901 .cindex "virus scanning"
31902 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
31903 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
31904 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
31905 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
31906 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
31907 in memory and thus are much faster.
31908
31909 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
31910 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
31911
31912 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
31913 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
31914 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
31915 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
31916 .display
31917 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
31918 .endd
31919 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
31920 .code
31921 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
31922 .endd
31923 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
31924 before use.
31925 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
31926 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
31927 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
31928
31929 .vlist
31930 .vitem &%avast%&
31931 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
31932 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
31933 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
31934 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
31935 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
31936 This scanner type takes one option,
31937 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31938 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31939 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31940 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31941 A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
31942 Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
31943 the daemon as options before the main scan command.
31944
31945 .cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
31946 If &`pass_unscanned`&
31947 is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
31948 decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
31949 care.
31950
31951 For example:
31952 .code
31953 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
31954 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
31955 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
31956 .endd
31957 If you omit the argument, the default path
31958 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
31959 is used.
31960 If you use a remote host,
31961 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
31962 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
31963 For information about available commands and their options you may use
31964 .code
31965 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
31966 FLAGS
31967 SENSITIVITY
31968 PACK
31969 .endd
31970
31971 If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
31972 permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
31973 written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
31974
31975 .vitem &%aveserver%&
31976 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31977 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
31978 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
31979 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
31980 example:
31981 .code
31982 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
31983 .endd
31984
31985
31986 .vitem &%clamd%&
31987 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
31988 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
31989 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
31990 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
31991 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
31992
31993 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
31994 a UNIX socket specification,
31995 a TCP socket specification,
31996 or a (global) option.
31997
31998 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
31999 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
32000 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
32001 and the second a port number,
32002 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
32003 These per-server options are supported:
32004 .code
32005 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32006 .endd
32007
32008 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32009 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
32010
32011 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
32012
32013 Examples:
32014 .code
32015 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
32016 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
32017 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
32018 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
32019 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
32020 .endd
32021 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
32022 &`local`&
32023 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
32024 to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
32025 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
32026 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
32027
32028 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
32029 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
32030 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
32031 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
32032 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
32033 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
32034 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
32035 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
32036 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
32037 .code
32038 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
32039 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
32040 (Connection refused)
32041 .endd
32042
32043 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
32044 contributing the code for this scanner.
32045
32046 .vitem &%cmdline%&
32047 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
32048 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
32049 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
32050 type takes 3 mandatory options:
32051
32052 .olist
32053 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
32054 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
32055
32056 .next
32057 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
32058 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
32059 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
32060 the &"trigger"& expression.
32061
32062 .next
32063 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
32064 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
32065 &"name"& expression.
32066 .endlist olist
32067
32068 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
32069 .code
32070 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
32071 .endd
32072 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
32073 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
32074 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
32075 configuration setting:
32076 .code
32077 av_scanner = cmdline:\
32078 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
32079 found in file:'(.+)'
32080 .endd
32081 .vitem &%drweb%&
32082 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
32083 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
32084 takes one option,
32085 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32086 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32087 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32088 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32089 For example:
32090 .code
32091 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
32092 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
32093 .endd
32094 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
32095 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
32096
32097 .vitem &%f-protd%&
32098 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
32099 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
32100 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
32101 (or port-range).
32102 For example:
32103 .code
32104 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
32105 .endd
32106 If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
32107
32108 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
32109 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
32110 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
32111 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
32112 For example:
32113 .code
32114 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
32115 .endd
32116 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
32117
32118 .vitem &%fsecure%&
32119 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
32120 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
32121 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
32122 .code
32123 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
32124 .endd
32125 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
32126 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
32127
32128 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
32129 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32130 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
32131 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
32132 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
32133 For example:
32134 .code
32135 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
32136 .endd
32137 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
32138
32139 .vitem &%mksd%&
32140 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
32141 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
32142 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
32143 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
32144 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
32145 provided that mksd has
32146 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
32147 .code
32148 av_scanner = mksd:2
32149 .endd
32150 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
32151
32152 .vitem &%sock%&
32153 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
32154 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
32155 running on the local machine.
32156 There are four options:
32157 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
32158 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
32159 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
32160 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
32161 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
32162 For example:
32163 .code
32164 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
32165 .endd
32166 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
32167 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
32168 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
32169 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
32170 specify an empty element to get this.
32171
32172 .vitem &%sophie%&
32173 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
32174 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
32175 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
32176 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
32177 client communication. For example:
32178 .code
32179 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
32180 .endd
32181 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
32182 the option.
32183 .endlist
32184
32185 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
32186 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
32187 ACL.
32188
32189 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
32190 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
32191 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
32192 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
32193 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
32194 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
32195 message.
32196
32197 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
32198 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
32199 The first element can then be one of
32200
32201 .ilist
32202 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
32203 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
32204 recommended usage.
32205 .next
32206 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
32207 the condition fails immediately.
32208 .next
32209 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
32210 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
32211 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
32212 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
32213 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
32214 .endlist
32215
32216 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
32217 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
32218 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
32219
32220 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
32221 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
32222 For example:
32223 .code
32224 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
32225 .endd
32226 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
32227
32228 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32229 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32230 is set to record the actual address used.
32231
32232 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
32233 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
32234 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
32235 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
32236 logging data.
32237
32238 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
32239 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
32240
32241 Here is a very simple scanning example:
32242 .code
32243 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32244 malware = *
32245 .endd
32246 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
32247 .code
32248 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32249 malware = */defer_ok
32250 .endd
32251 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
32252 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
32253 .code
32254 av_scanner = $acl_m0
32255 .endd
32256 in the main Exim configuration.
32257 .code
32258 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32259 set acl_m0 = sophie
32260 malware = *
32261
32262 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32263 set acl_m0 = aveserver
32264 malware = *
32265 .endd
32266
32267
32268 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
32269 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
32270 .cindex "spam scanning"
32271 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
32272 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
32273 score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
32274 &url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
32275 installation, you can use CPAN by running:
32276 .code
32277 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
32278 .endd
32279 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
32280 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
32281 nicely, however.
32282
32283 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
32284 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
32285 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
32286 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
32287 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
32288 configuration as follows (example):
32289 .code
32290 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
32291 .endd
32292 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
32293 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
32294 iptables firewall, consider setting
32295 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
32296 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
32297 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
32298 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
32299 soon.
32300
32301 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
32302 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
32303 file name instead of an address/port pair:
32304 .code
32305 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
32306 .endd
32307 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
32308 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
32309 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
32310 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
32311 .code
32312 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
32313 192.168.2.11 783 : \
32314 192.168.2.12 783
32315 .endd
32316 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
32317 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
32318 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
32319 condition defers.
32320
32321 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
32322 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
32323 and changeable in the usual way; take care to not double the separator.
32324
32325 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
32326 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
32327 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
32328 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
32329
32330 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
32331 are options.
32332 The supported options are:
32333 .code
32334 pri=<priority> Selection priority
32335 weight=<value> Selection bias
32336 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
32337 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32338 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
32339 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
32340 .endd
32341
32342 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
32343 higher values being tried first.
32344 The default priority is 1.
32345
32346 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
32347 Within a priority set
32348 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
32349 The default value for selection bias is 1.
32350
32351 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
32352 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
32353 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
32354 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
32355
32356 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
32357 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
32358
32359 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
32360 The default value is two minutes.
32361
32362 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32363 a failed connect is made.
32364 The default is to not retry.
32365
32366 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
32367 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
32368 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
32369 expansion.
32370
32371 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32372 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32373 is set to record the actual address used.
32374
32375 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
32376 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
32377 .code
32378 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32379 spam = joe
32380 .endd
32381 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
32382 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
32383 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
32384 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
32385 However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
32386
32387 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
32388 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
32389 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
32390 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
32391 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
32392 are not set.
32393 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
32394 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
32395 after the first),
32396 or the use of PRDR,
32397 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
32398 are needed to use this feature.
32399
32400 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
32401 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
32402 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
32403
32404
32405 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
32406 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
32407 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
32408 example:
32409 .code
32410 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32411 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
32412 spam = nobody
32413 .endd
32414
32415 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
32416 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
32417 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
32418 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
32419
32420 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
32421 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
32422 variables.
32423 Except for &$spam_report$&,
32424 these variables are saved with the received message so are
32425 available for use at delivery time.
32426
32427 .vlist
32428 .vitem &$spam_score$&
32429 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
32430 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
32431
32432 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
32433 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
32434 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
32435 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
32436 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
32437
32438 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
32439 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
32440 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
32441 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
32442 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
32443 spam bar is 50 characters.
32444
32445 .vitem &$spam_report$&
32446 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
32447 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
32448 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
32449 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
32450 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
32451 unencoded in headers.
32452
32453 .vitem &$spam_action$&
32454 Either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
32455 spam score versus threshold.
32456 .endlist
32457
32458 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
32459 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
32460 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
32461
32462 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
32463 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
32464 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
32465 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
32466 spam condition, like this:
32467 .code
32468 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32469 spam = joe/defer_ok
32470 .endd
32471 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
32472
32473 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
32474 condition:
32475 .code
32476 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
32477 warn spam = nobody:true
32478 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
32479 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
32480
32481 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
32482 # is over threshold
32483 warn spam = nobody
32484 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
32485
32486 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
32487 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
32488 spam = nobody:true
32489 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
32490 .endd
32491
32492
32493
32494 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
32495 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
32496 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
32497 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
32498 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
32499 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
32500 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
32501 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
32502 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
32503 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
32504 cases.
32505
32506 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
32507 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
32508 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
32509 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
32510 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
32511 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
32512 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
32513
32514 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
32515 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
32516 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
32517 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
32518 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
32519
32520 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
32521 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
32522 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
32523 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
32524 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
32525 syntax is:
32526 .display
32527 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
32528 .endd
32529 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
32530 the value can be:
32531
32532 .olist
32533 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
32534 .next
32535 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
32536 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
32537 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
32538 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
32539 .next
32540 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
32541 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
32542 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
32543 the full path and file name.
32544 .next
32545 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
32546 filename, and the default path is then used.
32547 .endlist
32548 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
32549 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
32550 a file with its original, proposed filename using
32551 .code
32552 decode = $mime_filename
32553 .endd
32554 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
32555 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
32556 automatically unlinked.
32557
32558 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
32559 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
32560 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
32561 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
32562 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
32563
32564 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
32565 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
32566 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
32567
32568 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
32569 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
32570 available in the MIME ACL:
32571
32572 .vlist
32573 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
32574 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
32575 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
32576 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
32577 contains the empty string.
32578
32579 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
32580 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
32581 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
32582 .code
32583 us-ascii
32584 gb2312 (Chinese)
32585 iso-8859-1
32586 .endd
32587 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
32588 case-insensitively.
32589
32590 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
32591 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
32592 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
32593 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
32594 only used for display purposes.
32595
32596 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
32597 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
32598 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
32599
32600 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
32601 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
32602 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
32603
32604 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
32605 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32606 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
32607 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
32608 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
32609
32610 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
32611 This variable contains the normalized content of the
32612 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
32613 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
32614
32615 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
32616 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
32617 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
32618 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
32619 .code
32620 text/plain
32621 text/html
32622 application/octet-stream
32623 image/jpeg
32624 audio/midi
32625 .endd
32626 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
32627 empty string.
32628
32629 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
32630 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32631 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
32632 containing the decoded data.
32633 .endlist
32634
32635 .cindex "RFC 2047"
32636 .vlist
32637 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
32638 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
32639 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
32640 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
32641 RFC2047
32642 or RFC2231
32643 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
32644 If no filename was
32645 found, this variable contains the empty string.
32646
32647 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
32648 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
32649 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
32650 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
32651
32652 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
32653 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
32654 follows:
32655
32656 .olist
32657 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
32658
32659 .next
32660 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
32661 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
32662
32663 .next
32664 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
32665 and the rest are attachments.
32666
32667 .next
32668 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
32669 .endlist olist
32670
32671 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
32672 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
32673 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
32674 .code
32675 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
32676 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
32677 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
32678 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
32679 .endd
32680 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
32681 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
32682 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
32683 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
32684 want to carry out specific actions on them.
32685
32686 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
32687 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
32688 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
32689 decoding is fully recursive.
32690
32691 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
32692 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
32693 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
32694 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
32695 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
32696 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
32697 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
32698 .endlist
32699
32700
32701
32702 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
32703 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
32704 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
32705 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
32706 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
32707
32708 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
32709 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
32710 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
32711 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
32712 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
32713
32714 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
32715 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
32716 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
32717 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
32718 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
32719 32K characters are checked.
32720
32721 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
32722 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
32723 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
32724 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
32725 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
32726 .code
32727 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
32728 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
32729 .endd
32730 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
32731 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
32732 matching regular expression.
32733 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
32734 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
32735
32736 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
32737 CPU-intensive.
32738
32739 .ecindex IIDcosca
32740
32741
32742
32743
32744 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32745 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32746
32747 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
32748 "Local scan function"
32749 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
32750 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
32751 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
32752 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
32753 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
32754
32755 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
32756 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
32757 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
32758 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
32759 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
32760
32761 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
32762 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
32763 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
32764 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
32765
32766 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
32767 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
32768 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
32769 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
32770
32771 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
32772 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
32773 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
32774 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
32775 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
32776 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
32777 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
32778 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
32779 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
32780
32781
32782
32783 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
32784 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
32785 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
32786 function is before building Exim, by setting
32787 .new
32788 both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
32789 .wen
32790 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
32791 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
32792 directory, so you might set
32793 .code
32794 HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
32795 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
32796 .endd
32797 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
32798 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
32799 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
32800 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
32801 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
32802 _src/local_scan.c_.
32803
32804 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
32805 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
32806 .code
32807 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32808 .endd
32809 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
32810
32811
32812
32813
32814 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
32815 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
32816 You must include this line near the start of your code:
32817 .code
32818 #include "local_scan.h"
32819 .endd
32820 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
32821 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
32822 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
32823 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
32824 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
32825 strings and pointers to character strings:
32826 .code
32827 #define CS (char *)
32828 #define CCS (const char *)
32829 #define CSS (char **)
32830 #define US (unsigned char *)
32831 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
32832 #define USS (unsigned char **)
32833 .endd
32834 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
32835 .code
32836 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
32837 .endd
32838 The arguments are as follows:
32839
32840 .ilist
32841 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
32842 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
32843 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
32844
32845 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
32846 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
32847 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
32848 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
32849 case this changes in some future version.
32850 .next
32851 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
32852 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
32853 .endlist
32854
32855 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
32856
32857 .vlist
32858 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
32859 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
32860 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
32861 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
32862 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
32863 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
32864
32865 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
32866 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32867 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
32868
32869 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
32870 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32871 queued without immediate delivery.
32872
32873 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
32874 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
32875 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
32876 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
32877 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
32878 used.
32879
32880 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
32881 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
32882 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
32883 problem"& is used.
32884
32885 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32886 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
32887 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
32888 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
32889 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
32890 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
32891 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32892
32893 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32894 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
32895 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32896 .endlist
32897
32898 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
32899 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
32900 &%-oe%& command line options.
32901
32902
32903
32904 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
32905 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
32906 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
32907 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
32908 want to do this, you must have the line
32909 .code
32910 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32911 .endd
32912 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
32913 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
32914 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
32915 to define them.
32916
32917 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
32918 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
32919 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
32920 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
32921 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
32922 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
32923 .code
32924 static int my_integer_option = 42;
32925 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
32926
32927 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
32928 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
32929 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
32930 };
32931
32932 int local_scan_options_count =
32933 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
32934 .endd
32935 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
32936 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
32937 .code
32938 begin local_scan
32939 my_integer = 99
32940 my_string = some string of text...
32941 .endd
32942 The available types of option data are as follows:
32943
32944 .vlist
32945 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
32946 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
32947 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
32948 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
32949 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
32950 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
32951 values.)
32952
32953 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
32954 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
32955 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
32956 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
32957
32958 .vitem &*opt_int*&
32959 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
32960 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
32961 Exim.
32962
32963 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
32964 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
32965 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
32966 printed with the suffix K or M.
32967
32968 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
32969 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
32970 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
32971 always output in octal.
32972
32973 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
32974 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
32975 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
32976
32977 .vitem &*opt_time*&
32978 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
32979 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
32980 .endlist
32981
32982 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
32983 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
32984
32985
32986
32987 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
32988 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
32989 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
32990 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
32991 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
32992 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
32993 C variables are as follows:
32994
32995 .vlist
32996 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
32997 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
32998 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
32999
33000 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
33001 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
33002 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33003
33004 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
33005 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
33006 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
33007 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
33008
33009 .ilist
33010 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
33011 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
33012 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
33013
33014 .next
33015 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
33016 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
33017 of debugging bits.
33018 .endlist ilist
33019
33020 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
33021 selected, you should use code like this:
33022 .code
33023 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33024 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33025 .endd
33026 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
33027 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
33028 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
33029
33030 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
33031 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
33032 discussed below.
33033
33034 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
33035 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
33036
33037 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
33038 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
33039
33040 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
33041 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
33042 &%-bh%& command line option.
33043
33044 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
33045 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
33046 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
33047
33048 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
33049 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
33050 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
33051 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
33052
33053 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
33054 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
33055 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
33056
33057 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
33058 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
33059
33060 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
33061 The number of accepted recipients.
33062
33063 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
33064 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
33065 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
33066 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
33067 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
33068 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
33069 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
33070 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
33071 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
33072 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
33073 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
33074 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
33075
33076 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
33077 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
33078
33079 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
33080 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
33081 locally-submitted messages.
33082
33083 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
33084 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
33085 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
33086
33087 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
33088 The name of the sending host, if known.
33089
33090 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
33091 The port on the sending host.
33092
33093 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
33094 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
33095
33096 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
33097 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
33098
33099 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
33100 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
33101 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
33102 .endlist
33103
33104
33105 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
33106 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
33107 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
33108 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
33109 their type to *.
33110
33111
33112 .vlist
33113 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
33114 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
33115
33116 .vitem &*int&~type*&
33117 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
33118 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
33119 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
33120 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
33121 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
33122 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
33123
33124 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
33125 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
33126 internal newlines.
33127
33128 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
33129 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
33130 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
33131 .endlist
33132
33133
33134
33135 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
33136 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
33137
33138 .vlist
33139 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
33140 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
33141
33142 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
33143 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
33144 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
33145 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
33146
33147 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
33148 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
33149 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
33150 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
33151 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
33152 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
33153 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
33154 is NULL for all recipients.
33155 .endlist
33156
33157
33158
33159 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
33160 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
33161 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
33162 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
33163 release:
33164
33165 .vlist
33166 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
33167 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
33168
33169 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
33170 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
33171 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
33172 for the process in &%newumask%&.
33173
33174 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
33175 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
33176 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
33177 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
33178 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
33179
33180 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
33181
33182 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
33183 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
33184 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
33185 return value is as follows:
33186
33187 .ilist
33188 >= 0
33189
33190 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
33191 ending status.
33192
33193 .next
33194 < 0 and > &--256
33195
33196 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
33197 signal number.
33198
33199 .next
33200 &--256
33201
33202 The process timed out.
33203 .next
33204 &--257
33205
33206 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
33207 .endlist
33208
33209 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
33210 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
33211 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
33212 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
33213 forks a subprocess that is running
33214 .code
33215 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
33216 .endd
33217 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
33218 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
33219 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
33220 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
33221
33222 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
33223 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
33224 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
33225 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
33226
33227
33228 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
33229 *sender_authentication)*&
33230 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
33231 that it runs is:
33232 .display
33233 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
33234 .endd
33235 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
33236
33237
33238 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33239 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
33240 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
33241 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
33242 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
33243 .code
33244 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33245 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33246 .endd
33247
33248 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
33249 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
33250 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
33251 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
33252 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
33253 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
33254 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
33255 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
33256
33257 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
33258 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
33259 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
33260 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
33261 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
33262 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
33263
33264 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33265 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
33266 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
33267 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
33268
33269 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
33270 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
33271 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
33272 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
33273 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
33274 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
33275 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
33276 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
33277 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
33278 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
33279 .code
33280 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
33281 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
33282 .endd
33283 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
33284 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
33285
33286
33287 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
33288 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
33289 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
33290 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
33291 match the specification, the function does nothing.
33292
33293
33294 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33295 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
33296 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
33297 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
33298 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
33299 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
33300 .code
33301 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
33302 .endd
33303 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
33304 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
33305 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
33306 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
33307 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
33308 zero-terminated.
33309
33310 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
33311 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
33312 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
33313 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
33314 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
33315 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
33316 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
33317 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
33318
33319 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
33320 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
33321 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
33322 .display
33323 &`OK `& match succeeded
33324 &`FAIL `& match failed
33325 &`DEFER `& match deferred
33326 .endd
33327 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
33328 inability to contact a database.
33329
33330 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33331 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
33332 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
33333 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
33334 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33335
33336 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33337 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
33338 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
33339 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
33340 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33341
33342 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
33343 uschar&~*list)*&"
33344 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
33345 expected to be
33346 .code
33347 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
33348 .endd
33349 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
33350 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
33351 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
33352 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
33353 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
33354 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
33355 failed.
33356
33357 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
33358 *format,&~...)*&"
33359 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
33360 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
33361 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
33362 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
33363 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
33364 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
33365
33366
33367 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
33368 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
33369 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
33370 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
33371
33372 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
33373 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
33374 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
33375 value afterwards. For example:
33376 .code
33377 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
33378 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
33379 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
33380 .endd
33381
33382 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
33383 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
33384 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
33385 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
33386 address.
33387 .endlist
33388
33389
33390 .cindex "RFC 2047"
33391 .vlist
33392 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
33393 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
33394 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
33395 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
33396 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
33397 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
33398 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
33399 binary string is returned with an error message.
33400
33401 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
33402 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
33403 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
33404
33405 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
33406 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
33407 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
33408 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
33409 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
33410
33411 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
33412 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
33413 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
33414
33415 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
33416 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
33417 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
33418 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
33419 with translation.
33420
33421
33422 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
33423 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
33424 below.
33425
33426 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33427 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
33428 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
33429 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
33430 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
33431 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
33432 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
33433 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
33434 is involved.
33435
33436 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
33437 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
33438
33439 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
33440 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
33441 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
33442 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
33443 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
33444 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
33445 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
33446 .code
33447 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
33448 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
33449 .endd
33450 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
33451 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
33452 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
33453 multiple output lines.
33454
33455 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
33456 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
33457 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
33458 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
33459 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
33460 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
33461 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
33462 is an error.
33463
33464 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
33465 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
33466 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
33467 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33468
33469 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
33470 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
33471 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33472
33473 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
33474 See below.
33475
33476 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
33477 See below.
33478
33479 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
33480 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
33481 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
33482 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
33483 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
33484 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
33485 more discussion.
33486 .endlist
33487
33488
33489
33490 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
33491 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
33492 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
33493 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
33494 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
33495 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
33496 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
33497 terminates.
33498
33499 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
33500 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
33501 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
33502 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
33503
33504 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
33505 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
33506 .code
33507 store_pool = POOL_PERM
33508 .endd
33509 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
33510 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
33511 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
33512 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
33513
33514 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
33515 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
33516 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
33517 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
33518 &%store_pool%&.
33519 .ecindex IIDlosca
33520
33521
33522
33523
33524 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33525 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33526
33527 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
33528 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
33529 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
33530 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
33531 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
33532 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
33533 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
33534 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
33535
33536 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
33537 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
33538 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
33539 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
33540 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
33541
33542 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
33543 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
33544 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
33545 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
33546 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
33547 prevent it happening on retries.
33548
33549 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33550 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33551 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
33552 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
33553 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
33554 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
33555 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
33556 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
33557
33558
33559 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
33560 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
33561 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
33562 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
33563 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
33564 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
33565 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
33566 .code
33567 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
33568 system_filter_user = exim
33569 .endd
33570 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
33571 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
33572 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
33573 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
33574 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
33575 by the &%reply%& command.
33576
33577
33578 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
33579 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
33580 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
33581 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
33582
33583 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
33584 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
33585
33586
33587
33588 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
33589 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
33590 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
33591 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
33592 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
33593 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
33594 they cause errors.
33595
33596 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
33597 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
33598 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
33599 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
33600 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
33601 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
33602 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
33603
33604 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
33605 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
33606 succeed, it will not be tried again.
33607 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
33608 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
33609
33610 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
33611 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
33612 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
33613 to which users' filter files can refer.
33614
33615
33616
33617 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
33618 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
33619 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
33620 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
33621 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
33622
33623
33624
33625 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
33626 .cindex "freezing messages"
33627 .cindex "message" "freezing"
33628 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
33629 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
33630 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
33631 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
33632 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
33633 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
33634 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
33635 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
33636 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
33637 .code
33638 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
33639 .endd
33640 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
33641
33642 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
33643 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
33644 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
33645 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
33646 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
33647 run.
33648
33649 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
33650 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
33651 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
33652 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
33653
33654 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
33655 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
33656 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
33657 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
33658 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
33659 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
33660 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
33661 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
33662 message. For example:
33663 .code
33664 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
33665 because it contains attachments that we are \
33666 not prepared to receive."
33667 .endd
33668
33669 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
33670 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
33671 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
33672 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
33673 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
33674 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
33675 use, for example
33676 .code
33677 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
33678 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
33679 .endd
33680 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
33681 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
33682 generated by the filter.
33683
33684 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
33685 &%defer%&,
33686 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
33687 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
33688 as
33689 .code
33690 mail ...
33691 freeze
33692 .endd
33693 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
33694 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
33695 take place.
33696
33697
33698
33699 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
33700 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
33701 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
33702 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
33703 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
33704 .code
33705 headers add <string>
33706 headers remove <string>
33707 .endd
33708 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
33709 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
33710 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
33711 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
33712 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
33713
33714 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
33715 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
33716 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
33717 example:
33718 .code
33719 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
33720 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
33721 X-header-2: ...."
33722 .endd
33723 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
33724 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
33725 space after input continuations is ignored.
33726
33727 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
33728 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
33729 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
33730 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
33731 header with the same name, they are all removed.
33732
33733 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
33734 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
33735 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
33736 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
33737 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
33738 used for all recipients of the message.
33739
33740 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
33741 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
33742 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
33743 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
33744 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
33745 until the message is actually being written (see section
33746 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
33747
33748 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
33749 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
33750 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
33751 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
33752 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
33753 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
33754 modified more than once.
33755
33756 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
33757 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
33758 For example:
33759 .code
33760 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
33761 headers remove "Subject"
33762 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
33763 headers remove "Old-Subject"
33764 .endd
33765
33766
33767
33768 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
33769 .cindex "envelope sender"
33770 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
33771 .code
33772 errors_to <some address>
33773 .endd
33774 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
33775 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
33776 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
33777 might use
33778 .code
33779 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
33780 .endd
33781 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
33782 address if its delivery failed.
33783
33784
33785
33786 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
33787 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33788 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33789 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
33790 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
33791 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
33792 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
33793 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
33794 which implements such a filter:
33795 .code
33796 central_filter:
33797 check_local_user
33798 driver = redirect
33799 domains = +local_domains
33800 file = /central/filters/$local_part
33801 no_verify
33802 allow_filter
33803 allow_freeze
33804 .endd
33805 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
33806 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
33807 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
33808 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
33809
33810 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
33811 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
33812 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
33813 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
33814 normal way.
33815 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
33816 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
33817 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
33818
33819
33820
33821
33822
33823
33824 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33825 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33826
33827 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
33828 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
33829 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
33830 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
33831 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
33832 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
33833 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
33834 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
33835
33836 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
33837 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
33838 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
33839 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
33840 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
33841
33842 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
33843 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
33844 loopback interface specially in any way.
33845
33846 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
33847 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
33848
33849
33850
33851
33852 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
33853 .cindex "message" "submission"
33854 .cindex "submission mode"
33855 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
33856 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
33857 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
33858 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
33859 .code
33860 control = submission
33861 .endd
33862 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
33863 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
33864 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
33865 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
33866 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
33867 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
33868 .code
33869 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
33870 control = submission
33871 .endd
33872 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
33873 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
33874 is used to separate options. For example:
33875 .code
33876 control = submission/sender_retain
33877 .endd
33878 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
33879 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
33880 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
33881 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
33882 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
33883 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
33884 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
33885
33886 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
33887 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
33888 example:
33889 .code
33890 control = submission/domain=some.domain
33891 .endd
33892 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
33893 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
33894 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
33895 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
33896 .code
33897 accept authenticated = *
33898 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
33899 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
33900 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
33901 .endd
33902 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
33903 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
33904 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
33905 .code
33906 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
33907 .endd
33908 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
33909 line would be:
33910 .code
33911 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
33912 .endd
33913 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
33914 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
33915 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
33916 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
33917
33918 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
33919 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
33920 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
33921 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
33922 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
33923 spoof another's address.
33924
33925 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
33926 .cindex "line endings"
33927 .cindex "carriage return"
33928 .cindex "linefeed"
33929 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
33930 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
33931 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
33932 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
33933 use CRLF or just CR.
33934
33935 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
33936 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
33937 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
33938 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
33939 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
33940 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
33941 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
33942 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
33943 follows:
33944
33945 .ilist
33946 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
33947 .next
33948 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
33949 is ignored.
33950 .next
33951 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
33952 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
33953 terminator.
33954 .next
33955 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
33956 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
33957 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
33958 people trying to play silly games.
33959 .next
33960 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
33961 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
33962 line.
33963 .endlist
33964
33965
33966
33967
33968
33969 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
33970 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
33971 .cindex "address" "qualification"
33972 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
33973 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
33974 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
33975 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
33976 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
33977
33978 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
33979 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
33980 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
33981 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
33982 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
33983
33984 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
33985 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
33986 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
33987 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
33988 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
33989 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
33990 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
33991 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
33992
33993
33994
33995
33996 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
33997 .cindex "&""From""& line"
33998 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
33999 .cindex "sender" "address"
34000 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
34001 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
34002 .cindex "envelope sender"
34003 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34004 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
34005 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
34006 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
34007 .code
34008 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
34009 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
34010 .endd
34011 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
34012 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
34013 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
34014 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
34015 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
34016 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
34017 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
34018 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
34019 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
34020
34021 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
34022 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
34023 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
34024 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
34025 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
34026 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
34027 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
34028
34029 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
34030 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
34031 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
34032
34033 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
34034 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
34035 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
34036 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
34037
34038
34039
34040 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
34041 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
34042 .cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
34043 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
34044 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
34045 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
34046 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
34047 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
34048
34049 .blockquote
34050 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
34051 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
34052 .endblockquote
34053
34054 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
34055 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
34056 follows:
34057
34058 .ilist
34059 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
34060 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
34061 .next
34062 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
34063 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
34064 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
34065 .next
34066 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
34067 also removed.
34068 .next
34069 For a locally-submitted message,
34070 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
34071 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
34072 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
34073 included in log lines in this case.
34074 .next
34075 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
34076 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
34077 .endlist
34078
34079
34080
34081
34082 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
34083 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
34084 includes the header line:
34085 .code
34086 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
34087 .endd
34088
34089 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
34090 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
34091 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
34092 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
34093 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
34094 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
34095
34096
34097 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
34098 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
34099 .cindex "header lines" "Date:"
34100 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
34101 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
34102 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
34103
34104 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
34105 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
34106 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
34107 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
34108 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
34109 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
34110 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
34111 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
34112 messages.
34113
34114
34115 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
34116 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
34117 .cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
34118 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
34119 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
34120 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
34121 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
34122 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
34123 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
34124 messages.
34125
34126
34127 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
34128 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
34129 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
34130 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34131 .cindex "message" "submission"
34132 .cindex "submission mode"
34133 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
34134 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
34135
34136 .ilist
34137 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
34138 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
34139 .next
34140 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34141 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
34142 .olist
34143 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34144 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34145 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34146 .next
34147 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
34148 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34149 .next
34150 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34151 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34152 .endlist
34153 .endlist
34154
34155 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
34156
34157 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
34158 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
34159 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
34160 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34161 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
34162 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
34163 &%qualify_domain%&.
34164
34165 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
34166 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
34167 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
34168 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34169
34170
34171 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
34172 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
34173 .cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
34174 .cindex "message" "submission"
34175 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
34176 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
34177 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
34178 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
34179 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
34180 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
34181 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
34182 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
34183 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
34184 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
34185
34186
34187 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
34188 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
34189 .cindex "header lines" "Received:"
34190 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
34191 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
34192 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
34193
34194 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
34195 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
34196 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
34197 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
34198
34199 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
34200 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
34201 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
34202
34203
34204 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
34205 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
34206 .cindex "header lines" "References:"
34207 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
34208 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
34209 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
34210 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
34211 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
34212 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
34213 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
34214 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
34215 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
34216
34217
34218
34219 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
34220 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
34221 .cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
34222 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
34223 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
34224 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
34225 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
34226 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
34227 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
34228
34229
34230
34231 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
34232 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
34233 .cindex "message" "submission"
34234 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
34235 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
34236 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
34237 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
34238 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34239 control setting.
34240
34241 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
34242 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34243 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
34244 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
34245 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
34246 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
34247 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
34248 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
34249 line is added to the message.
34250
34251 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
34252 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
34253 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
34254 options true at the same time.
34255
34256 .cindex "submission mode"
34257 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
34258 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
34259 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
34260 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
34261
34262 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34263 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
34264 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
34265 created as follows:
34266
34267 .ilist
34268 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34269 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34270 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34271 .next
34272 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
34273 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34274 .next
34275 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34276 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34277 .endlist
34278
34279 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
34280 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
34281 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
34282 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
34283
34284 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
34285 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
34286 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
34287 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
34288
34289
34290
34291 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
34292 "SECTheadersaddrem"
34293 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
34294 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
34295 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
34296 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
34297 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
34298 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
34299 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
34300
34301 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
34302 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
34303 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
34304 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
34305 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
34306 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
34307
34308 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
34309 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
34310 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
34311
34312 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
34313 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
34314 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
34315 .code
34316 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
34317 X-added-second: another added header line
34318 .endd
34319 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
34320
34321 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
34322 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
34323 Each header-line is separately expanded.
34324
34325 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
34326 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
34327 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
34328 not part of the names. For example:
34329 .code
34330 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
34331 .endd
34332
34333 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
34334 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
34335 Each item is separately expanded.
34336 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
34337 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
34338 will act as list separators.
34339
34340 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
34341 items are expanded at routing time,
34342 and then associated with all addresses that are
34343 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
34344 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
34345 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
34346
34347 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
34348 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
34349 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
34350 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
34351
34352 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
34353 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
34354 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
34355 requirements.
34356
34357 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
34358 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
34359 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
34360 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
34361 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
34362 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
34363 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
34364
34365 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
34366 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
34367 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
34368 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
34369
34370 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
34371 the following consequences:
34372
34373 .ilist
34374 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
34375 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
34376 to it, at all times.
34377 .next
34378 Header lines that are added by a router's
34379 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
34380 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
34381 .next
34382 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
34383 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
34384 .next
34385 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
34386 a later router or by a transport.
34387 .next
34388 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
34389 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
34390 .code
34391 headers_remove = subject
34392 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
34393 .endd
34394 .endlist
34395
34396 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
34397 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
34398
34399
34400
34401
34402
34403 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
34404 .cindex "address" "constructed"
34405 .cindex "constructed address"
34406 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
34407 the form
34408 .display
34409 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
34410 .endd
34411 For example:
34412 .code
34413 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
34414 .endd
34415 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
34416 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
34417 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
34418 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
34419 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
34420 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
34421 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
34422 there is no password file entry.
34423
34424 .cindex "RFC 2047"
34425 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
34426 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
34427 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
34428 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
34429 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
34430 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
34431 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
34432 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
34433
34434
34435
34436 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
34437 .cindex "case of local parts"
34438 .cindex "local part" "case of"
34439 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
34440 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
34441 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
34442 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
34443 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
34444 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
34445 router option.
34446
34447 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
34448 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
34449 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
34450 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
34451 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
34452 .code
34453 correct_case:
34454 driver = redirect
34455 domains = +local_domains
34456 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
34457 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
34458 @$domain
34459 .endd
34460 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
34461 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
34462 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
34463 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
34464 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
34465
34466
34467
34468 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
34469 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
34470 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
34471 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
34472 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
34473 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
34474 empty components for compatibility.
34475
34476
34477
34478 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
34479 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
34480 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
34481 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
34482 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
34483 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
34484
34485 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
34486 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
34487 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
34488 example, a header such as
34489 .code
34490 To: hare@teaparty
34491 .endd
34492 might get rewritten as
34493 .code
34494 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
34495 .endd
34496 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
34497 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
34498 been routed.
34499
34500 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
34501 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
34502 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
34503 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
34504 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
34505 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
34506 .ecindex IIDmesproc
34507
34508
34509
34510 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34511 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34512
34513 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
34514 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
34515 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
34516 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
34517 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
34518 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
34519 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
34520
34521 .ilist
34522 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
34523 .next
34524 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
34525 .next
34526 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
34527 .endlist
34528
34529 For mail delivery, the following are available:
34530
34531 .ilist
34532 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
34533 .next
34534 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
34535 &"lmtp"&);
34536 .next
34537 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
34538 transport);
34539 .next
34540 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
34541 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
34542 .endlist
34543
34544 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
34545 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
34546 used to contain the envelope information.
34547
34548
34549
34550 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
34551 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
34552 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
34553 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
34554 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
34555 .cindex "EHLO"
34556 .cindex "HELO"
34557 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34558 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
34559 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
34560 processing is the same in both cases.
34561
34562 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
34563 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
34564 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
34565 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
34566 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
34567 .cindex "transport" "filter"
34568 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
34569 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
34570 suppressed.
34571
34572 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
34573 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
34574 required for the transaction.
34575
34576 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
34577 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
34578 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
34579 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
34580 is called for verification.
34581
34582 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
34583 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
34584 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
34585
34586 .cindex "carriage return"
34587 .cindex "linefeed"
34588 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34589 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
34590 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34591 line terminator.
34592
34593 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
34594 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
34595 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
34596 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
34597 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
34598 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
34599 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
34600 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
34601 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
34602
34603 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
34604 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
34605 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
34606 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
34607
34608 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
34609 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
34610 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
34611 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
34612
34613 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34614 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
34615 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
34616 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
34617 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
34618 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
34619 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
34620 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
34621 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
34622 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
34623
34624 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
34625 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
34626
34627 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
34628 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
34629 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
34630 square bracket of the IP address.
34631
34632
34633
34634
34635 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
34636 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
34637 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
34638 .cindex "host" "error"
34639 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
34640 message errors, and recipient errors.
34641
34642 .vlist
34643 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
34644 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
34645 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
34646
34647 .ilist
34648 Connection refused or timed out,
34649 .next
34650 Any error response code on connection,
34651 .next
34652 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
34653 .next
34654 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
34655 .next
34656 I/O errors at any time,
34657 .next
34658 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
34659 the &"."& at the end of the data.
34660 .endlist ilist
34661
34662 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
34663 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
34664 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
34665 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
34666 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
34667 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
34668 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
34669 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
34670
34671 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
34672 .cindex "message" "error"
34673 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
34674 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
34675 message errors are:
34676
34677 .ilist
34678 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
34679 the data,
34680 .next
34681 Timeout after MAIL,
34682 .next
34683 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
34684 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
34685 connection at any other time.
34686 .endlist ilist
34687
34688 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
34689 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
34690 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
34691 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
34692 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
34693 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
34694 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
34695 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
34696 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
34697 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
34698
34699 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
34700 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
34701 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
34702 response to MAIL.
34703
34704 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
34705 .cindex "recipient" "error"
34706 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
34707 recipient errors are:
34708
34709 .ilist
34710 Any error response to RCPT,
34711 .next
34712 Timeout after RCPT.
34713 .endlist
34714
34715 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
34716 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
34717 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
34718 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
34719 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
34720 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
34721 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
34722 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
34723 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
34724 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
34725 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
34726 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
34727 the retry clock is reset.
34728
34729 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
34730 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
34731 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
34732 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
34733 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
34734 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
34735 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
34736 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
34737 recipient's retry time.
34738 .endlist
34739
34740 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
34741 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
34742 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
34743 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
34744 until the next delivery attempt.
34745
34746 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
34747 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
34748 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
34749 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
34750 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
34751 is created.
34752
34753 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
34754 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
34755 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
34756 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
34757 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
34758 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
34759 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
34760
34761 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
34762 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
34763 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
34764 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
34765 then to be treated as a host error.
34766
34767 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
34768 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
34769 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
34770 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
34771 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
34772
34773
34774
34775
34776 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
34777 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
34778 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
34779 .cindex "inetd"
34780 .cindex "daemon"
34781 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
34782 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
34783 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
34784 .code
34785 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
34786 .endd
34787 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
34788 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
34789 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
34790 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
34791 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
34792 stream and exits with an error code.
34793
34794 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
34795 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
34796 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
34797 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
34798
34799 .cindex "carriage return"
34800 .cindex "linefeed"
34801 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34802 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
34803 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34804 line terminator.
34805 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
34806 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
34807 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
34808
34809 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
34810 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
34811 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
34812 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
34813 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
34814 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
34815 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
34816 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
34817
34818 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34819 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
34820 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
34821 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
34822 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
34823 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
34824 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
34825 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
34826 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
34827
34828 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
34829 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
34830 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
34831
34832 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
34833 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
34834 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
34835 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
34836 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
34837
34838 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
34839 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
34840 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
34841 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
34842 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
34843 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
34844 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
34845
34846 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
34847 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
34848 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
34849 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
34850 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
34851
34852 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
34853 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
34854 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
34855 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
34856 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
34857 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
34858 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
34859 a delivery process.
34860
34861 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
34862 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
34863 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
34864 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
34865 however, available with &'inetd'&.
34866
34867 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
34868 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
34869 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
34870 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
34871
34872 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
34873 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
34874 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
34875
34876
34877
34878 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
34879 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
34880 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
34881 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
34882 the error response to the last command. The default value for
34883 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
34884 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
34885 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
34886
34887
34888 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
34889 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
34890 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
34891 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
34892 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
34893 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
34894 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
34895 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
34896 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
34897 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
34898 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
34899
34900
34901
34902 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
34903 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
34904 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
34905 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
34906 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
34907 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
34908 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
34909 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
34910
34911 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
34912 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
34913 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
34914 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
34915 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
34916 counted.
34917
34918 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
34919 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
34920 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
34921
34922 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
34923 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
34924 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
34925 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
34926 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
34927
34928
34929
34930
34931 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
34932 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
34933 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
34934 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
34935
34936 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
34937 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
34938 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
34939 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
34940 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
34941 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
34942 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
34943 SMTP response codes.
34944
34945 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
34946 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
34947 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
34948 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
34949 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
34950 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
34951 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
34952 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
34953 RCPT failures.
34954
34955
34956
34957 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
34958 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
34959 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
34960 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
34961 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
34962 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
34963 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
34964
34965 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
34966 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
34967 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
34968 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
34969 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
34970 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
34971 argument. For example,
34972 .code
34973 ETRN #brigadoon
34974 .endd
34975 runs the command
34976 .code
34977 exim -R brigadoon
34978 .endd
34979 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
34980 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
34981 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
34982 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
34983 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
34984
34985 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
34986 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
34987 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
34988 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
34989 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
34990 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
34991 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
34992 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
34993
34994 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
34995 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
34996 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
34997 whatever the form of its argument. For
34998 example:
34999 .code
35000 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
35001 $sender_host_address
35002 .endd
35003 .vindex "&$domain$&"
35004 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
35005 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
35006 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
35007 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
35008 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
35009 for it to change them before running the command.
35010
35011
35012
35013 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
35014 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
35015 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
35016 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
35017 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
35018 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
35019 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
35020 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
35021 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
35022 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
35023 runs for RCPT commands:
35024 .code
35025 accept hosts = :
35026 .endd
35027 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
35028
35029
35030
35031 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
35032 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
35033 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
35034 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
35035 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
35036 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
35037 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
35038 envelope along with the message.
35039
35040 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
35041 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
35042 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
35043 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
35044 can be used to specify it.
35045
35046 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
35047 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
35048 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
35049 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
35050 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
35051
35052 .vindex "&$host$&"
35053 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
35054 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
35055 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
35056 router:
35057 .code
35058 begin routers
35059 route_append:
35060 driver = manualroute
35061 transport = smtp_appendfile
35062 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
35063
35064 begin transports
35065 smtp_appendfile:
35066 driver = appendfile
35067 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
35068 batch_max = 1000
35069 use_bsmtp
35070 user = exim
35071 .endd
35072 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
35073 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
35074 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
35075
35076
35077
35078 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
35079 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
35080 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
35081 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
35082 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
35083 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
35084 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
35085 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
35086 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
35087 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
35088
35089 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
35090 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
35091
35092 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
35093 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
35094 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
35095 make some use of automatically, for example:
35096 .code
35097 554 Unexpected end of file
35098 Transaction started in line 10
35099 Error detected in line 14
35100 .endd
35101 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
35102 file, for example:
35103 .code
35104 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
35105 The error message was:
35106
35107 501 '>' missing at end of address
35108
35109 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
35110 The error was detected in line 12.
35111 The SMTP command at fault was:
35112
35113 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
35114
35115 1 previous message was successfully processed.
35116 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
35117 .endd
35118 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
35119 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
35120 accepted.
35121 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
35122 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
35123
35124
35125
35126 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35127 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35128
35129 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
35130 "Customizing messages"
35131 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
35132 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
35133 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
35134 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
35135 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
35136
35137 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
35138 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
35139 option. Exim also adds the line
35140 .code
35141 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
35142 .endd
35143 to all warning and bounce messages,
35144
35145
35146 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
35147 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
35148 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
35149 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
35150 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
35151 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
35152 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
35153
35154 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
35155 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
35156 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
35157 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
35158 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
35159 item.
35160
35161 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
35162 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
35163 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
35164 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
35165 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
35166 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
35167 option, rounded to a whole number.
35168
35169 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
35170
35171 .ilist
35172 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35173 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35174 .next
35175 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
35176 failing addresses with their error messages.
35177 .next
35178 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
35179 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
35180 .next
35181 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
35182 The fields exist for back-compatibility
35183 .endlist
35184
35185 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
35186 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
35187 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
35188 .code
35189 Subject: Mail delivery failed
35190 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35191 {: returning message to sender}}
35192 ****
35193 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35194
35195 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35196 {that you sent }{sent by
35197
35198 <$sender_address>
35199
35200 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
35201 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
35202 ****
35203 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
35204 ****
35205 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
35206 ------
35207 ****
35208 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
35209 only the first
35210 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
35211 ****
35212 .endd
35213 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
35214 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
35215 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
35216 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
35217 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
35218 text sections:
35219
35220 .ilist
35221 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35222 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35223 .next
35224 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
35225 the delayed addresses.
35226 .next
35227 The third item then ends the message.
35228 .endlist
35229
35230 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
35231 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
35232 .code
35233 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
35234 $warn_message_delay
35235 ****
35236 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35237
35238 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
35239 {that you sent }{sent by
35240
35241 <$sender_address>
35242
35243 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
35244 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
35245
35246 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
35247 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
35248 The date of the message is: $h_date
35249
35250 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
35251 ****
35252 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
35253 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
35254 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
35255 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
35256 the message will be returned to you.
35257 .endd
35258 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
35259 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
35260 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
35261 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
35262 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
35263 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
35264 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
35265 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
35266 handled them.
35267
35268
35269
35270
35271 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35272 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35273
35274 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
35275 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
35276 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
35277
35278
35279
35280 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
35281 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
35282 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
35283 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
35284 routing explicitly:
35285 .code
35286 send_to_smart_host:
35287 driver = manualroute
35288 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
35289 transport = remote_smtp
35290 .endd
35291 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
35292 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
35293 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
35294 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
35295 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
35296
35297
35298
35299
35300 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
35301 .cindex "mailing lists"
35302 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
35303 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
35304 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
35305
35306 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
35307 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
35308 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
35309 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
35310 .code
35311 lists:
35312 driver = redirect
35313 domains = lists.example
35314 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35315 forbid_pipe
35316 forbid_file
35317 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35318 no_more
35319 .endd
35320 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
35321 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
35322 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
35323 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
35324
35325 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
35326 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
35327 a mailing list.
35328
35329 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
35330 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
35331 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
35332 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
35333 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
35334
35335 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
35336 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
35337 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
35338 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
35339 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
35340 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
35341 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
35342 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
35343 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
35344
35345
35346
35347 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
35348 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
35349 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
35350 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
35351 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
35352 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
35353 addresses are not rigorously checked.
35354
35355 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
35356 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
35357 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
35358 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
35359 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
35360
35361
35362
35363 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
35364 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
35365 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
35366 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
35367 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
35368 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
35369 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
35370 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
35371 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
35372 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
35373
35374 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
35375 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
35376 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
35377 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
35378 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
35379 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
35380 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
35381 pre-existing messages.
35382
35383 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
35384 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
35385 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
35386 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
35387 one level of expansion anyway.
35388
35389
35390
35391 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
35392 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
35393 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
35394 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
35395 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
35396 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
35397
35398 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
35399 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
35400 .code
35401 lists_request:
35402 driver = redirect
35403 domains = lists.example
35404 local_part_suffix = -request
35405 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
35406 no_more
35407
35408 lists_post:
35409 driver = redirect
35410 domains = lists.example
35411 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
35412 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
35413 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35414 forbid_pipe
35415 forbid_file
35416 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35417 no_more
35418
35419 lists_closed:
35420 driver = redirect
35421 domains = lists.example
35422 allow_fail
35423 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
35424 .endd
35425 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
35426 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
35427 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
35428 mailing list.
35429
35430 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
35431 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
35432 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
35433 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
35434 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
35435 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
35436 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
35437 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
35438 &"unrouteable address"& error.
35439
35440 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
35441 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
35442 the address, giving a suitable error message.
35443
35444
35445
35446
35447 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
35448 .cindex "VERP"
35449 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
35450 .cindex "envelope sender"
35451 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
35452 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
35453 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
35454 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
35455 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
35456 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
35457
35458 .oindex &%errors_to%&
35459 .oindex &%return_path%&
35460 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
35461 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
35462 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
35463 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
35464 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
35465 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
35466 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
35467 .code
35468 verp_smtp:
35469 driver = smtp
35470 max_rcpt = 1
35471 return_path = \
35472 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35473 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35474 .endd
35475 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
35476 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
35477 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
35478 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
35479 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
35480 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
35481 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
35482 rewritten as
35483 .code
35484 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
35485 .endd
35486 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
35487 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
35488 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
35489 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
35490 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
35491 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
35492
35493 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
35494 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
35495 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
35496 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
35497 .code
35498 dnslookup:
35499 driver = dnslookup
35500 domains = ! +local_domains
35501 transport = \
35502 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35503 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
35504 no_more
35505 .endd
35506 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
35507 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
35508 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
35509 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
35510 address.
35511
35512 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
35513 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
35514 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
35515 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
35516 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
35517 .code
35518 verp_dnslookup:
35519 driver = dnslookup
35520 domains = ! +local_domains
35521 transport = remote_smtp
35522 errors_to = \
35523 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
35524 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35525 no_more
35526 .endd
35527 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
35528 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
35529 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
35530 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
35531 them.
35532
35533 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
35534 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
35535 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
35536 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
35537 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
35538 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
35539 used).
35540
35541
35542
35543
35544
35545
35546 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
35547 .cindex "virtual domains"
35548 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
35549 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
35550 meanings:
35551
35552 .ilist
35553 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
35554 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
35555 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
35556 .next
35557 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
35558 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
35559 have login accounts on that host.
35560 .endlist
35561
35562 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
35563 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
35564 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
35565 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
35566 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
35567 to a router of this form:
35568 .code
35569 virtual:
35570 driver = redirect
35571 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
35572 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
35573 no_more
35574 .endd
35575 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
35576 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
35577 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
35578 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
35579 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
35580 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
35581
35582 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
35583 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
35584 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
35585 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
35586
35587 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
35588 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
35589 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
35590 .code
35591 my_domains:
35592 driver = accept
35593 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
35594 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
35595 transport = my_mailboxes
35596 .endd
35597 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
35598 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
35599 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
35600 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
35601 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
35602 follows:
35603 .code
35604 my_mailboxes:
35605 driver = appendfile
35606 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
35607 user = mail
35608 .endd
35609 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
35610 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
35611
35612 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
35613 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
35614 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
35615 information about the domains.
35616
35617
35618
35619 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
35620 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
35621 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
35622 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
35623 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
35624 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
35625 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
35626 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
35627 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
35628 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
35629 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
35630 example, consider this router:
35631 .code
35632 userforward:
35633 driver = redirect
35634 check_local_user
35635 file = $home/.forward
35636 local_part_suffix = -*
35637 local_part_suffix_optional
35638 allow_filter
35639 .endd
35640 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
35641 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
35642 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
35643 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
35644 .code
35645 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
35646 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
35647 endif
35648 .endd
35649 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
35650 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
35651 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
35652 control over which suffixes are valid.
35653
35654 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
35655 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
35656 another MTA:
35657 .code
35658 userforward:
35659 driver = redirect
35660 check_local_user
35661 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
35662 local_part_suffix = -*
35663 local_part_suffix_optional
35664 allow_filter
35665 .endd
35666 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
35667 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
35668 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
35669 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
35670 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
35671
35672
35673
35674 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
35675 .cindex "vacation processing"
35676 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
35677 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
35678 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
35679 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
35680 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
35681
35682 .ilist
35683 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
35684 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
35685 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
35686 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
35687 .code
35688 spqr, vacation-spqr
35689 .endd
35690 .next
35691 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
35692 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
35693 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
35694 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
35695 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
35696 message.
35697 .endlist
35698
35699 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
35700 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
35701
35702
35703
35704 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
35705 .cindex "message" "copying every"
35706 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
35707 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
35708 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
35709 each day's messages.
35710
35711 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
35712 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
35713 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
35714 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
35715
35716
35717
35718 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
35719 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
35720 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
35721 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
35722 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
35723 permanently connected.
35724
35725 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
35726 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
35727 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
35728
35729
35730 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
35731 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
35732 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
35733 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
35734 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
35735 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
35736 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
35737 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
35738
35739 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
35740 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
35741 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
35742 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
35743 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
35744 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
35745 if required.
35746
35747 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
35748 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
35749 intermittent host. For example:
35750 .code
35751 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
35752 .endd
35753 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
35754 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
35755 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
35756 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
35757 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
35758 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
35759 immediately.
35760
35761 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
35762 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
35763 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
35764 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
35765 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
35766 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
35767 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
35768
35769
35770
35771 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
35772 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
35773 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
35774 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
35775 delivered immediately.
35776
35777 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35778 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
35779 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
35780 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
35781 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
35782 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
35783 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
35784 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
35785 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
35786 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
35787 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
35788 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
35789 single SMTP connection.
35790
35791
35792
35793 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35794 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35795
35796 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
35797 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
35798 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
35799 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
35800 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
35801 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
35802 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
35803 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
35804 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
35805 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
35806 messages this way.
35807
35808 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
35809 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
35810 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
35811 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
35812 email is not desirable.
35813
35814 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
35815 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
35816 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
35817 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
35818 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
35819 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
35820 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
35821
35822 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
35823 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
35824 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
35825 before sending a message to the smart host.
35826
35827 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
35828 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
35829 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
35830
35831 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
35832 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
35833 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
35834 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
35835 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
35836 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
35837 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
35838
35839 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
35840 following ways:
35841
35842 .ilist
35843 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
35844 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
35845 .next
35846 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
35847 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
35848 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
35849 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
35850 successful, a zero return code is given.
35851 .next
35852 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
35853 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
35854 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
35855 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
35856 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
35857 are.
35858 .next
35859 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
35860 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
35861 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
35862 .next
35863 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
35864 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
35865 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
35866 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
35867 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
35868 .next
35869 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
35870 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
35871 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
35872 .next
35873 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
35874 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
35875 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
35876 are ever generated.
35877 .next
35878 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
35879 .next
35880 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
35881 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
35882 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
35883 .endlist
35884
35885 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
35886 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
35887 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
35888 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
35889 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
35890 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
35891
35892
35893
35894
35895 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35896 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35897
35898 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
35899 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
35900 .cindex "log" "types of"
35901 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
35902 and the panic log:
35903
35904 .ilist
35905 .cindex "main log"
35906 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
35907 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
35908 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
35909 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
35910 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
35911 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
35912 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
35913 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
35914 .next
35915 .cindex "reject log"
35916 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
35917 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
35918 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
35919 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
35920 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
35921 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
35922 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
35923 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
35924 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
35925 false.
35926 .next
35927 .cindex "panic log"
35928 .cindex "system log"
35929 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
35930 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
35931 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
35932 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
35933 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
35934 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
35935 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
35936 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
35937 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
35938 .endlist
35939
35940 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
35941 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
35942 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
35943 .code
35944 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
35945 by QUIT
35946 .endd
35947 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
35948 ways of changing this:
35949
35950 .ilist
35951 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
35952 you set
35953 .code
35954 timezone = UTC
35955 .endd
35956 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
35957 .next
35958 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
35959 example:
35960 .code
35961 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
35962 .endd
35963 .endlist
35964
35965 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35966 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35967 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
35968 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
35969 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
35970 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
35971
35972
35973
35974
35975 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
35976 .cindex "log" "destination"
35977 .cindex "log" "to file"
35978 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
35979 .cindex "syslog"
35980 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
35981 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
35982 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
35983 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
35984 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
35985 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
35986 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
35987
35988 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
35989 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
35990 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
35991 references to the host name:
35992 .code
35993 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
35994 .endd
35995 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
35996 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
35997 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
35998 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
35999 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
36000 log at all.
36001
36002 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
36003 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
36004 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
36005 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
36006 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
36007 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
36008 implying the use of a default path.
36009
36010 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
36011 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
36012 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
36013 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
36014 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
36015 equivalent to the setting:
36016 .code
36017 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
36018 .endd
36019 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
36020 or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
36021 that is where the logs are written.
36022
36023 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
36024 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
36025
36026 Here are some examples of possible settings:
36027 .display
36028 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
36029 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
36030 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
36031 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
36032 .endd
36033 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
36034 error is logged.
36035
36036
36037
36038 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
36039 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36040 .cindex "cycling logs"
36041 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36042 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
36043 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
36044 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
36045 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
36046 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
36047 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
36048
36049 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
36050 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
36051 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
36052 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
36053 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
36054 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
36055 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
36056 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
36057 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
36058 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
36059 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
36060 renamed.
36061
36062
36063
36064 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
36065 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
36066 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
36067 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
36068 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
36069 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
36070 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
36071 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
36072 .code
36073 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
36074 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
36075 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
36076 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
36077 .endd
36078 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
36079 examples of names generated by the above examples:
36080 .code
36081 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
36082 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
36083 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
36084 /var/log/exim/main.200212
36085 .endd
36086 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
36087 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
36088 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
36089 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
36090
36091 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
36092 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
36093 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
36094 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
36095 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
36096 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
36097 log names:
36098 .code
36099 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36100 /var/log/exim-panic.log
36101 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36102 /var/log/exim/panic
36103 .endd
36104
36105
36106 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
36107 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
36108 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
36109 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
36110 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
36111 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
36112 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
36113 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
36114 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
36115 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
36116 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
36117 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
36118 the time and host name to each line.
36119 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
36120
36121 .ilist
36122 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
36123 .next
36124 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
36125 .next
36126 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
36127 .endlist
36128
36129 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
36130 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
36131 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
36132 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
36133
36134 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
36135 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
36136 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
36137 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
36138 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
36139 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
36140 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
36141 RFC 3164, you should set
36142 .code
36143 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
36144 .endd
36145 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
36146 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
36147
36148 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
36149 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
36150 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
36151 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
36152 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
36153 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
36154 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
36155 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
36156 name, and pid as added by syslog:
36157 .code
36158 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
36159 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
36160 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
36161 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
36162 [5/5] mple>)
36163 .endd
36164 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
36165 (LOG_NOTICE):
36166 .code
36167 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
36168 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
36169 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
36170 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
36171 [5\18] .example>)
36172 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
36173 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
36174 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
36175 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
36176 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
36177 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
36178 [12\18] F From: <>
36179 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
36180 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
36181 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
36182 [16\18] le>
36183 [17\18] B Bcc:
36184 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
36185 .endd
36186 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
36187 without modification.
36188
36189 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
36190 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
36191 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
36192 where it is.
36193
36194
36195
36196 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
36197 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
36198 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
36199 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
36200 timestamp. The flags are:
36201 .display
36202 &`<=`& message arrival
36203 &`(=`& message fakereject
36204 &`=>`& normal message delivery
36205 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
36206 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
36207 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
36208 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
36209 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
36210 .endd
36211
36212
36213 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
36214 .cindex "log" "reception line"
36215 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36216 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
36217 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
36218 .code
36219 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
36220 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
36221 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
36222 .endd
36223 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
36224 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
36225 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
36226 .code
36227 R=<message id>
36228 .endd
36229 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
36230
36231 .cindex "HELO"
36232 .cindex "EHLO"
36233 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
36234 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
36235 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
36236 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
36237 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
36238 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
36239 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
36240 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
36241 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
36242 name in parentheses.
36243
36244 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
36245 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
36246 the log containing text like these examples:
36247 .code
36248 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
36249 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
36250 .endd
36251 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
36252 on.
36253
36254 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
36255 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
36256 of Exim.
36257
36258 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
36259 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
36260 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
36261 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
36262 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
36263 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
36264 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
36265 suite that was used.
36266
36267 .cindex log protocol
36268 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
36269 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
36270 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
36271 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
36272 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
36273 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
36274 authenticator name.
36275
36276 .cindex "size" "of message"
36277 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
36278 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
36279 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
36280 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
36281 other).
36282
36283 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36284 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36285
36286
36287
36288 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
36289 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
36290 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36291 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
36292 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
36293 to fit it on the page:
36294 .code
36295 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
36296 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
36297 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
36298 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
36299 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
36300 .endd
36301 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
36302 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
36303 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
36304 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
36305 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
36306
36307 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
36308 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
36309 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
36310 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
36311
36312 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
36313 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
36314 .display
36315 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
36316 .endd
36317 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
36318 parentheses afterwards.
36319
36320 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
36321 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
36322 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
36323 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
36324 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
36325 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36326 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
36327 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
36328 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36329 TLS cipher information is still available.
36330
36331 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
36332 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
36333 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
36334 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
36335 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
36336
36337 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
36338 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
36339
36340 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36341 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36342
36343
36344 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
36345 .cindex "discarded messages"
36346 .cindex "message" "discarded"
36347 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
36348 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
36349 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
36350 .code
36351 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
36352 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
36353 .endd
36354 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
36355 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
36356 .code
36357 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
36358 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
36359 .endd
36360
36361
36362 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
36363 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
36364 .code
36365 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
36366 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
36367 .endd
36368 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
36369 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
36370 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
36371 .code
36372 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
36373 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
36374 .endd
36375 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
36376 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
36377 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
36378
36379
36380
36381 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
36382 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
36383 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
36384 following form is logged:
36385 .code
36386 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
36387 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
36388 .endd
36389 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
36390 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
36391 .code
36392 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
36393 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
36394 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
36395 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
36396 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
36397 .endd
36398 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
36399 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
36400 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
36401 flagged with &`**`&.
36402
36403
36404
36405 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
36406 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
36407 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
36408 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
36409 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
36410
36411
36412
36413 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
36414 A line of the form
36415 .code
36416 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
36417 .endd
36418 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
36419 at the end of its processing.
36420
36421
36422
36423
36424 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
36425 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
36426 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
36427 the following table:
36428 .display
36429 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
36430 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
36431 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36432 &`CV `& certificate verification status
36433 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36434 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
36435 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
36436 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36437 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
36438 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
36439 &`H `& host name and IP address
36440 &`I `& local interface used
36441 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
36442 &`id `& message id for incoming message
36443 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
36444 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
36445 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
36446 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
36447 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
36448 &`Q `& alternate queue name
36449 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
36450 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
36451 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
36452 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
36453 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
36454 &`S `& size of message in bytes
36455 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
36456 &`ST `& shadow transport name
36457 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
36458 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
36459 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
36460 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
36461 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
36462 .endd
36463
36464
36465 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
36466 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
36467 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
36468
36469 .ilist
36470 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
36471 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
36472 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
36473 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
36474 during the first delivery attempt.
36475 .next
36476 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
36477 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
36478 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
36479 .next
36480 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
36481 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
36482 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
36483 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
36484 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
36485 doing.
36486 .next
36487 .cindex "error" "ignored"
36488 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
36489 message:
36490 .olist
36491 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
36492 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
36493 .next
36494 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
36495 failed. The delivery was discarded.
36496 .next
36497 A delivery set up by a router configured with
36498 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
36499 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
36500 .code
36501 errors_to = <>
36502 .endd
36503 failed. The delivery was discarded.
36504 .endlist olist
36505 .next
36506 .cindex DKIM "log line"
36507 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
36508 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
36509 .endlist ilist
36510
36511
36512
36513
36514
36515 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
36516 .cindex "log" "selectors"
36517 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
36518 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
36519 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
36520 example:
36521 .code
36522 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
36523 .endd
36524 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
36525 selection marked by asterisks:
36526 .display
36527 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
36528 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
36529 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
36530 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
36531 &` arguments `& command line arguments
36532 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
36533 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
36534 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
36535 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
36536 &`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
36537 &` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
36538 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
36539 &` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36540 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
36541 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
36542 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
36543 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
36544 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
36545 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
36546 &` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
36547 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
36548 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
36549 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
36550 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
36551 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
36552 &` pid `& Exim process id
36553 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
36554 &` receive_time `& time taken to receive message
36555 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
36556 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
36557 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
36558 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
36559 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
36560 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
36561 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
36562 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
36563 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
36564 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
36565 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
36566 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
36567 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
36568 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
36569 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
36570 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
36571 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
36572 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
36573 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
36574 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
36575 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
36576 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
36577
36578 &` all `& all of the above
36579 .endd
36580 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
36581 section &<<SECID99>>&
36582
36583 More details on each of these items follows:
36584
36585 .ilist
36586 .cindex "8BITMIME"
36587 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
36588 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
36589 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
36590 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
36591 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
36592 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
36593 .next
36594 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
36595 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
36596 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
36597 this log selector is set.
36598 .next
36599 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
36600 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
36601 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
36602 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
36603 such users cannot access the log).
36604 .next
36605 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
36606 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
36607 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
36608 parentheses between them.
36609 .next
36610 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
36611 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
36612 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
36613 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
36614 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
36615 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
36616 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
36617 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
36618 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
36619 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
36620 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
36621 between the caller and Exim.
36622 .next
36623 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
36624 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
36625 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
36626 .next
36627 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
36628 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
36629 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
36630 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
36631 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
36632 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
36633 .next
36634 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
36635 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
36636 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
36637 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36638 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
36639 .next
36640 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
36641 .cindex "size" "of message"
36642 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
36643 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
36644 .next
36645 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
36646 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
36647 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
36648 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
36649 .next
36650 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
36651 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
36652 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
36653 .next
36654 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
36655 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
36656 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
36657 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
36658 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
36659 .next
36660 .cindex log dnssec
36661 .cindex dnssec logging
36662 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
36663 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
36664 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
36665 It does not cover helo-name verification.
36666 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
36667 .next
36668 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
36669 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
36670 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
36671 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
36672 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
36673 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
36674 .next
36675 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
36676 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
36677 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
36678 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
36679 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
36680 .next
36681 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
36682 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
36683 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
36684 client's ident port times out.
36685 .next
36686 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
36687 .cindex "log" "local interface"
36688 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
36689 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36690 .cindex "interface" "logging"
36691 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
36692 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
36693 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
36694 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, to
36695 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
36696 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36697 .next
36698 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
36699 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
36700 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
36701 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
36702 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
36703 on a proxied connection
36704 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
36705 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
36706 .next
36707 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
36708 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
36709 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
36710 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
36711 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
36712 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
36713 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
36714 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
36715 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
36716 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
36717 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
36718 .next
36719 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
36720 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
36721 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
36722 .next
36723 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
36724 .cindex millisecond logging
36725 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
36726 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
36727 appended to the seconds value.
36728 .next
36729 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
36730 .cindex "log" "local interface"
36731 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
36732 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36733 .cindex "interface" "logging"
36734 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
36735 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
36736 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
36737 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36738 .next
36739 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
36740 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
36741 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
36742 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
36743 containing => tags) following the IP address.
36744 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
36745 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
36746 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
36747 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
36748 local port is a random ephemeral port.
36749 .next
36750 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
36751 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36752 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
36753 immediately after the time and date.
36754 .next
36755 .cindex "log" "queue run"
36756 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
36757 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
36758 .next
36759 .cindex "log" "queue time"
36760 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
36761 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
36762 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
36763 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
36764 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
36765 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
36766 message has been successfully received.
36767 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36768 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
36769 .next
36770 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
36771 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
36772 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
36773 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
36774 .next
36775 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
36776 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
36777 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
36778 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36779 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
36780 .next
36781 .cindex "log" "recipients"
36782 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
36783 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
36784 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
36785 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
36786 has taken place.
36787 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
36788 in the list.
36789 .next
36790 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
36791 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
36792 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
36793 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
36794 .next
36795 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
36796 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
36797 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
36798 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
36799 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
36800 .next
36801 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
36802 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
36803 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
36804 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
36805 attempt.
36806 .next
36807 .cindex "log" "return path"
36808 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
36809 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
36810 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
36811 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
36812 .next
36813 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
36814 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
36815 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
36816 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
36817 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
36818 .next
36819 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
36820 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
36821 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
36822 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
36823 detail is lost.
36824 .next
36825 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
36826 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
36827 it is too big.
36828 .next
36829 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
36830 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
36831 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
36832 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
36833 it.
36834 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
36835 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
36836 .next
36837 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
36838 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
36839 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
36840 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
36841 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
36842 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
36843 response.
36844 .next
36845 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
36846 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
36847 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
36848 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
36849 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
36850 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
36851 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
36852 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
36853 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
36854 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
36855
36856 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
36857 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
36858 reset if the daemon is restarted.
36859 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
36860 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
36861 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
36862 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
36863 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
36864 .next
36865 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
36866 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
36867 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
36868 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
36869 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
36870 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
36871 .next
36872 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
36873 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
36874 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
36875 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
36876 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
36877 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
36878 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
36879 already have their own log lines.
36880
36881 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
36882 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
36883 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
36884 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
36885 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
36886 the same logging options.
36887
36888 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
36889 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
36890 .code
36891 C=EHLO,QUIT
36892 .endd
36893 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
36894 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
36895 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
36896 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
36897 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
36898 .next
36899 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
36900 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
36901 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
36902 was accepted or used.
36903 .next
36904 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
36905 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
36906 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
36907 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
36908 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
36909 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
36910 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
36911 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
36912 .next
36913 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
36914 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
36915 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
36916 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
36917 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
36918 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
36919 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
36920 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
36921 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
36922 .next
36923 .cindex "log" "subject"
36924 .cindex "subject, logging"
36925 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
36926 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
36927 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
36928 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
36929 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
36930 .next
36931 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
36932 .cindex log DANE
36933 .cindex DANE logging
36934 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
36935 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
36936 verified
36937 using a CA trust anchor,
36938 &`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
36939 and &`CV=no`& if not.
36940 .next
36941 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
36942 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
36943 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36944 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
36945 .next
36946 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
36947 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
36948 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36949 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
36950 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
36951 .next
36952 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
36953 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
36954 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
36955 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
36956 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
36957 .next
36958 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
36959 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
36960 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
36961 .endlist
36962
36963
36964 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
36965 .cindex "message" "log file for"
36966 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
36967 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
36968 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
36969 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
36970 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
36971 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
36972 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
36973 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
36974 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
36975 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
36976 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
36977
36978 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
36979 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
36980 &%message_logs%& option false.
36981 .ecindex IIDloggen
36982
36983
36984
36985
36986 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36987 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36988
36989 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
36990 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
36991 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
36992 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
36993 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
36994
36995 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
36996 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
36997 "list what Exim processes are doing"
36998 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
36999 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
37000 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
37001 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
37002 various criteria"
37003 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
37004 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
37005 "extract statistics from the log"
37006 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
37007 "check address acceptance from given IP"
37008 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
37009 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
37010 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
37011 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
37012 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
37013 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
37014 .endtable
37015
37016 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
37017 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
37018 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
37019
37020
37021
37022
37023 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
37024 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
37025 .cindex "process, querying"
37026 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
37027 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
37028 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
37029 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
37030 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
37031 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
37032 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
37033 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
37034 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
37035
37036 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
37037 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
37038 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
37039
37040
37041 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
37042 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
37043 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
37044 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
37045 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
37046 options:
37047 .display
37048 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
37049 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
37050 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
37051 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
37052 .endd
37053 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
37054 .code
37055 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
37056 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
37057 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
37058 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
37059 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
37060 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
37061 .endd
37062 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
37063 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
37064
37065
37066
37067 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
37068 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
37069 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
37070 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
37071 .code
37072 exim -bpu
37073 .endd
37074 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
37075 .code
37076 exim -bp
37077 .endd
37078 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
37079 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
37080
37081 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
37082 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
37083
37084 .vlist
37085 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
37086 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37087 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
37088 .code
37089 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
37090 .endd
37091 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
37092 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37093 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
37094
37095 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
37096 Match against the size field.
37097
37098 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37099 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
37100
37101 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37102 Match messages that are older than the given time.
37103
37104 .vitem &*-z*&
37105 Match only frozen messages.
37106
37107 .vitem &*-x*&
37108 Match only non-frozen messages.
37109 .endlist
37110
37111 The following options control the format of the output:
37112
37113 .vlist
37114 .vitem &*-c*&
37115 Display only the count of matching messages.
37116
37117 .vitem &*-l*&
37118 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
37119 the default.
37120
37121 .vitem &*-i*&
37122 Display message ids only.
37123
37124 .vitem &*-b*&
37125 Brief format &-- one line per message.
37126
37127 .vitem &*-R*&
37128 Display messages in reverse order.
37129
37130 .vitem &*-a*&
37131 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
37132 .endlist
37133
37134 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
37135
37136
37137
37138 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
37139 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
37140 .cindex "queue" "summary"
37141 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
37142 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
37143 running a command such as
37144 .code
37145 exim -bp | exiqsumm
37146 .endd
37147 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
37148 it, as in the following example:
37149 .code
37150 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
37151 .endd
37152 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
37153 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
37154 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
37155 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
37156
37157 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
37158 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
37159 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
37160 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
37161 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
37162 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
37163 sender.
37164
37165 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
37166 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
37167 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
37168 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
37169 level"& addresses).
37170
37171
37172
37173
37174 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
37175 "SECTextspeinf"
37176 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
37177 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
37178 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
37179 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
37180 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
37181 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
37182 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
37183 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
37184 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
37185 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
37186 .display
37187 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
37188 .endd
37189 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
37190
37191 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
37192 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
37193 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
37194
37195 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
37196 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
37197 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
37198 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
37199 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
37200
37201 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
37202 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
37203 regular expression.
37204
37205 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
37206 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
37207
37208 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
37209 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
37210 normally.
37211
37212 Example of &%-M%&:
37213 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
37214 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
37215 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
37216 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
37217 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
37218 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
37219 search term.
37220
37221 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
37222 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
37223 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
37224 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
37225 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
37226
37227
37228 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
37229 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
37230 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
37231 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
37232 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
37233 the &%--help%& option.
37234
37235
37236 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
37237 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
37238 .cindex "cycling logs"
37239 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
37240 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
37241 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
37242 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
37243 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
37244 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
37245 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
37246 .ilist
37247 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
37248 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
37249 .next
37250 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
37251 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
37252 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
37253 configuration.
37254 .endlist
37255
37256 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
37257 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
37258 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
37259 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
37260 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
37261 logs are handled similarly.
37262
37263 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
37264 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
37265 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
37266 any existing log files.
37267
37268 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
37269 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
37270 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
37271 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
37272 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
37273 .code
37274 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
37275 .endd
37276 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
37277 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
37278
37279
37280
37281 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
37282 .cindex "statistics"
37283 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
37284 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
37285 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
37286 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
37287 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
37288
37289 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
37290 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
37291 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
37292 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
37293 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
37294 .code
37295 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
37296 .endd
37297 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
37298 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
37299 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
37300 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
37301 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
37302 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
37303 also produced per user.
37304
37305 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
37306 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
37307 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
37308 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
37309 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
37310
37311 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
37312 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
37313 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
37314 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
37315 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
37316 an entirely separate message.
37317
37318 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
37319 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
37320 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
37321 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
37322 least one address that failed.
37323
37324 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
37325 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
37326 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
37327 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
37328 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
37329 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
37330 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
37331
37332 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
37333 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
37334 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
37335
37336 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
37337 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
37338 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
37339 .code
37340 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
37341 .endd
37342
37343 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
37344 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
37345 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
37346 .cindex "checking access"
37347 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
37348 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
37349 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
37350 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
37351 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
37352 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
37353
37354 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
37355 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
37356 .code
37357 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
37358 .endd
37359 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
37360 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
37361 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
37362 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
37363 .code
37364 Rejected:
37365 550 Relay not permitted
37366 .endd
37367 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
37368 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
37369 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
37370 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
37371 you can use:
37372 .code
37373 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
37374 -f himself@there.example
37375 .endd
37376 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
37377 mandatory arguments.
37378
37379 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
37380 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
37381 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
37382
37383
37384
37385 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
37386 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
37387 .cindex "building DBM files"
37388 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
37389 .cindex "lower casing"
37390 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
37391 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
37392 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
37393 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
37394 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
37395 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
37396
37397 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
37398 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
37399 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
37400 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
37401 files.
37402
37403 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
37404 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
37405 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
37406 well.
37407
37408 .cindex "USE_DB"
37409 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
37410 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
37411 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
37412 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
37413 .code
37414 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
37415 .endd
37416 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
37417 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
37418
37419 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
37420 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
37421 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
37422 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
37423 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
37424 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
37425
37426 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
37427 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
37428 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
37429 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
37430 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
37431 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
37432 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
37433 return code is 2.
37434
37435
37436
37437
37438 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
37439 .cindex "retry" "times"
37440 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
37441 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
37442 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
37443 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
37444 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
37445 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
37446 output. For example:
37447 .code
37448 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
37449 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
37450 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
37451 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
37452 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
37453 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
37454 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
37455 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
37456 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
37457 past final cutoff time
37458 .endd
37459 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
37460 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
37461 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
37462 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
37463 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
37464 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
37465 run very often.
37466
37467 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
37468 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
37469 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
37470 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
37471 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
37472 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
37473
37474
37475
37476 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
37477 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
37478 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
37479 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
37480 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
37481 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
37482 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
37483
37484 .ilist
37485 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
37486 .next
37487 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
37488 for remote hosts
37489 .next
37490 &'callout'&: the callout cache
37491 .next
37492 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
37493 .next
37494 &'misc'&: other hints data
37495 .endlist
37496
37497 The &'misc'& database is used for
37498
37499 .ilist
37500 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
37501 .next
37502 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
37503 &(smtp)& transport)
37504 .next
37505 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
37506 in a transport)
37507 .endlist
37508
37509
37510
37511 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
37512 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
37513 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
37514 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
37515 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
37516 .code
37517 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
37518 .endd
37519 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
37520 .code
37521 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
37522 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
37523 .endd
37524 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
37525 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
37526 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
37527 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
37528 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
37529 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
37530 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
37531 and a textual description of the error.
37532
37533 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
37534 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
37535 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
37536 exceeded.
37537
37538 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
37539 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
37540 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
37541 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
37542 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
37543 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
37544 cross-references.
37545
37546
37547
37548 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
37549 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
37550 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
37551 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
37552 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
37553 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
37554 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
37555 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
37556 updated sufficiently often.
37557
37558 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
37559 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
37560 the retry database:
37561 .code
37562 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
37563 .endd
37564 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
37565 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
37566 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
37567 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
37568 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
37569 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
37570 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
37571 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
37572 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
37573 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
37574 whenever it removes information from the database.
37575
37576 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
37577 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
37578 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
37579 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
37580 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
37581
37582 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
37583 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
37584 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
37585 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
37586 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
37587 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
37588 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
37589 tidied.
37590
37591 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
37592 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
37593
37594
37595
37596
37597 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
37598 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
37599 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
37600 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
37601 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
37602 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
37603 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
37604 displayed.
37605
37606 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
37607 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
37608 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
37609 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
37610 by new data, for example:
37611 .code
37612 > 4 951102:1000
37613 .endd
37614 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
37615 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
37616 used as optional separators.
37617
37618
37619
37620
37621 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
37622 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
37623 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
37624 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
37625 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
37626 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
37627 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
37628 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
37629 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
37630 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
37631 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
37632 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
37633 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
37634
37635 .vlist
37636 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
37637 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
37638
37639 .vitem &%-flock%&
37640 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
37641 supports it.
37642
37643 .vitem &%-interval%&
37644 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
37645 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
37646
37647 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
37648 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
37649
37650 .vitem &%-mbx%&
37651 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
37652
37653 .vitem &%-q%&
37654 Suppress verification output.
37655
37656 .vitem &%-retries%&
37657 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
37658 the lock (default 10).
37659
37660 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
37661 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
37662 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
37663 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
37664 subsequently sees.
37665
37666 .vitem &%-timeout%&
37667 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
37668 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
37669 default), a non-blocking call is used.
37670
37671 .vitem &%-v%&
37672 Generate verbose output.
37673 .endlist
37674
37675 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
37676 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
37677 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
37678 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
37679 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
37680 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
37681 more than 30 minutes old.
37682
37683 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
37684 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
37685 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
37686 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
37687 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
37688 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
37689
37690 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
37691 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
37692 suppresses all output except error messages.
37693
37694 A command such as
37695 .code
37696 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
37697 .endd
37698 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
37699 .display
37700 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
37701 <&'some commands'&>
37702 &`End`&
37703 .endd
37704 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
37705 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
37706 such as
37707 .code
37708 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
37709 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
37710 .endd
37711 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
37712 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
37713 .ecindex IIDutils
37714
37715
37716 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37717 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37718
37719 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
37720 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
37721 .cindex "X-windows"
37722 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
37723 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
37724 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
37725 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
37726 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
37727 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
37728 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
37729 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
37730
37731
37732
37733 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
37734 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
37735 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
37736 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
37737 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
37738 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
37739 parameters are for.
37740
37741 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
37742 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
37743 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
37744 .code
37745 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
37746 .endd
37747 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
37748 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
37749 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
37750 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
37751 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
37752
37753 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
37754 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
37755 .code
37756 Eximon*background: gray94
37757 .endd
37758 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
37759 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
37760 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
37761 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
37762 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
37763 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
37764 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
37765 .code
37766 xrdb -merge <<End
37767 Eximon*highlight: gray
37768 End
37769 .endd
37770 .cindex "admin user"
37771 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
37772 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
37773
37774 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
37775 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
37776 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
37777 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
37778 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
37779
37780 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
37781 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
37782 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
37783 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
37784 different parts of the display.
37785
37786
37787
37788
37789 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
37790 .cindex "stripchart"
37791 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
37792 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37793 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
37794 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
37795 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
37796 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
37797 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
37798 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
37799 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37800
37801 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
37802 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
37803 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
37804 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
37805
37806 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
37807 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
37808 to a single partition.
37809
37810 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
37811 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
37812 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
37813 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
37814 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
37815 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37816 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37817
37818
37819
37820
37821 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
37822 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
37823 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
37824 .cindex "window size"
37825 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
37826 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
37827 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
37828 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
37829 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
37830 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
37831
37832 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
37833 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
37834 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
37835 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
37836
37837 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
37838 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
37839 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
37840 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
37841 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
37842 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37843
37844 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
37845 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
37846 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37847
37848
37849
37850 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
37851 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
37852 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
37853 the main log is maintained.
37854 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
37855 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
37856 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
37857 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
37858 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
37859
37860 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
37861 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
37862 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
37863 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
37864 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
37865 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
37866 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
37867 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
37868 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
37869 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
37870 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37871
37872 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
37873 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
37874 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
37875 It cannot go further back up the log.
37876
37877 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
37878 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
37879 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
37880 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
37881 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
37882 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
37883
37884 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
37885 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
37886 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
37887 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
37888 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
37889 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
37890
37891 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
37892 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
37893 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
37894 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
37895 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
37896 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
37897 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
37898 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
37899 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
37900 window.
37901
37902
37903
37904 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
37905 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
37906 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
37907 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
37908 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
37909 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
37910 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
37911 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
37912 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
37913 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
37914
37915 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
37916 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
37917 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
37918 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
37919 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
37920 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
37921 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
37922
37923 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
37924 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
37925 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
37926 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
37927 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
37928 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
37929 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
37930
37931 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
37932 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
37933 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
37934 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
37935
37936 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
37937 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
37938 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
37939 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
37940 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
37941 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
37942 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
37943 not shown.
37944
37945 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
37946 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
37947
37948 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
37949 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
37950 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
37951 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
37952 display is updated.
37953
37954
37955
37956 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
37957 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
37958 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
37959 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
37960 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
37961 any selected text.
37962
37963 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
37964 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
37965 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
37966 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
37967 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
37968 .code
37969 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
37970 .endd
37971 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
37972 follows:
37973
37974 .ilist
37975 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
37976 in a new text window.
37977 .next
37978 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
37979 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
37980 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
37981 .next
37982 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
37983 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
37984 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
37985 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
37986 .next
37987 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
37988 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
37989 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
37990 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
37991 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
37992 .next
37993 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
37994 that the message be frozen.
37995 .next
37996 .cindex "thawing messages"
37997 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
37998 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
37999 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
38000 that the message be thawed.
38001 .next
38002 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
38003 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
38004 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
38005 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
38006 .next
38007 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
38008 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
38009 message.
38010 .next
38011 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
38012 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38013 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38014 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38015 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
38016 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
38017 which case no action is taken.
38018 .next
38019 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
38020 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38021 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38022 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38023 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
38024 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
38025 case no action is taken.
38026 .next
38027 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
38028 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
38029 .next
38030 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
38031 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
38032 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
38033 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
38034 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
38035 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
38036 the address is qualified with that domain.
38037 .endlist
38038
38039 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
38040 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
38041 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
38042 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
38043 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
38044 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
38045 if no output is generated.
38046
38047 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
38048 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
38049 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
38050 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
38051
38052 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
38053 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
38054 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
38055 .ecindex IIDeximon
38056
38057
38058
38059
38060
38061 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38062 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38063
38064 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
38065 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
38066 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
38067 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
38068
38069 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
38070 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
38071 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
38072 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
38073 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
38074 its security as compared with other MTAs.
38075
38076 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
38077 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
38078 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
38079 as soon as possible.
38080
38081
38082 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
38083 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
38084 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
38085 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
38086 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
38087 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
38088
38089 .ilist
38090 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
38091 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
38092 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
38093 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
38094 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
38095 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
38096
38097 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
38098 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
38099 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
38100 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
38101 .next
38102
38103 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
38104 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
38105 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
38106 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
38107 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
38108 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
38109 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
38110 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
38111 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
38112 separate commands.
38113
38114 .next
38115 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
38116 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
38117 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
38118 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
38119 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
38120 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
38121 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
38122 .next
38123 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
38124 is disabled.
38125 .next
38126 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
38127 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
38128 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
38129 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
38130 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
38131 .endlist
38132
38133
38134
38135 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
38136 .cindex "setuid"
38137 .cindex "root privilege"
38138 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
38139 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
38140 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
38141 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
38142 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
38143 is required for two things:
38144
38145 .ilist
38146 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
38147 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
38148 not required.
38149 .next
38150 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
38151 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
38152 configuration.
38153 .endlist
38154
38155 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
38156 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
38157 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
38158 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
38159 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
38160 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
38161 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
38162 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
38163
38164 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
38165 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
38166 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
38167
38168 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
38169 uid and gid in the following cases:
38170
38171 .ilist
38172 .oindex "&%-C%&"
38173 .oindex "&%-D%&"
38174 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
38175 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
38176 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
38177 the calling process.
38178 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
38179 option may not be used at all.
38180 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
38181 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
38182 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
38183 .next
38184 .oindex "&%-be%&"
38185 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
38186 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
38187 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
38188 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
38189 calling process.
38190 .next
38191 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
38192 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
38193 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
38194 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
38195 testing address verification
38196 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
38197 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
38198 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
38199 option).
38200 .next
38201 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
38202 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
38203 .endlist
38204
38205 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
38206
38207 .ilist
38208 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
38209 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
38210 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
38211 will be used during message reception.
38212 .next
38213 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
38214 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
38215 .next
38216 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
38217 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
38218 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
38219 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
38220 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
38221 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
38222 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
38223 generating bounce and warning messages.
38224
38225 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
38226 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
38227 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
38228 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
38229 .next
38230 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
38231 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
38232 .endlist
38233
38234
38235
38236
38237 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
38238 .cindex "privilege, running without"
38239 .cindex "unprivileged running"
38240 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
38241 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
38242 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
38243 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
38244 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
38245 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
38246 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
38247 to any other uid.
38248
38249 .cindex SIGHUP
38250 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
38251 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
38252 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
38253 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
38254
38255 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
38256 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
38257 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
38258 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
38259 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
38260
38261 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
38262 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
38263 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
38264 effect.
38265
38266 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
38267 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
38268 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
38269
38270 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
38271 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
38272 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
38273 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
38274 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
38275 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
38276 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
38277 address this problem at this time.
38278
38279 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
38280 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
38281 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
38282 be used in the most straightforward way.
38283
38284 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
38285 number of restrictions on what you can do:
38286
38287 .ilist
38288 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
38289 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
38290 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
38291 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
38292 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
38293 .next
38294 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
38295 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
38296 .next
38297 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
38298 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
38299 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
38300 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
38301 .next
38302 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
38303 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
38304
38305 .olist
38306 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
38307 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
38308 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
38309 .next
38310 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
38311 owned by the Exim user.
38312 .next
38313 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
38314 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
38315 mailboxes need to be created manually.
38316 .endlist olist
38317 .endlist ilist
38318
38319
38320 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
38321 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
38322 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
38323 gives more security at essentially no cost.
38324
38325 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
38326 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
38327
38328
38329
38330
38331 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
38332 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
38333 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
38334
38335
38336
38337 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
38338 .cindex "security" "local commands"
38339 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
38340 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
38341 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
38342 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
38343 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
38344
38345 .ilist
38346 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
38347 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
38348 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
38349 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
38350 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
38351 .next
38352 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
38353 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
38354 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
38355 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
38356 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
38357 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
38358 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
38359 .next
38360 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
38361 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
38362 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
38363 .next
38364 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
38365 taint checking might apply to their usage.
38366 .next
38367 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
38368 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
38369 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
38370 .next
38371 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
38372 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
38373 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
38374 of opaque strings.
38375 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
38376 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
38377 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
38378 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
38379 .endlist
38380
38381
38382
38383
38384 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
38385 .cindex "security" "data sources"
38386 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
38387 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
38388 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
38389 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
38390 are some issues to be aware of:
38391
38392 .ilist
38393 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
38394 .next
38395 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
38396 .next
38397 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
38398 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
38399 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
38400 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
38401 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
38402 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
38403 data.
38404 .next
38405 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
38406 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
38407 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
38408 .next
38409 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
38410 expected to yield one result.
38411 .endlist
38412
38413
38414
38415
38416 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
38417 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
38418 .cindex "IP source routing"
38419 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
38420 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
38421 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
38422 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
38423
38424
38425
38426 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
38427 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
38428 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
38429
38430
38431
38432
38433 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
38434 .cindex "trusted users"
38435 .cindex "admin user"
38436 .cindex "privileged user"
38437 .cindex "user" "trusted"
38438 .cindex "user" "admin"
38439 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
38440 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
38441 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
38442 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
38443 permit a remote host to be specified.
38444
38445 .oindex "&%-f%&"
38446 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
38447 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
38448 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
38449 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
38450 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
38451 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
38452
38453 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
38454 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
38455 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
38456 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
38457 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
38458
38459 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
38460 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
38461 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
38462 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
38463 includes the contents of files on the spool.
38464
38465 .oindex "&%-M%&"
38466 .oindex "&%-q%&"
38467 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
38468 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
38469 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
38470 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
38471 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
38472 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
38473
38474 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
38475 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
38476 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
38477 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
38478 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
38479 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
38480 files.
38481
38482 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
38483 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
38484 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
38485 This affects most of the checking options,
38486 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
38487
38488
38489 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
38490 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
38491 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
38492 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
38493 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
38494 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
38495
38496
38497
38498 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
38499 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
38500 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
38501 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
38502 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
38503 this.
38504
38505
38506
38507 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
38508 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
38509 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
38510 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
38511 converted output.
38512
38513
38514
38515 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
38516 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
38517 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
38518 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
38519 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
38520
38521
38522
38523 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
38524 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
38525 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
38526 loading it.
38527
38528
38529 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
38530 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
38531 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
38532 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
38533 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
38534 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
38535 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
38536
38537 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
38538 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
38539 string.
38540
38541
38542
38543 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
38544 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
38545 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
38546 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
38547
38548
38549
38550 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
38551 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
38552 enough to hold the result.
38553 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
38554
38555
38556
38557
38558 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38559 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38560
38561 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
38562 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
38563 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
38564 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
38565 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
38566 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
38567 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
38568 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
38569 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
38570 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
38571 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
38572 themselves are recoverable.
38573
38574 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
38575 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
38576 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
38577
38578 .ilist
38579 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
38580 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
38581 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
38582 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
38583 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
38584 .next
38585 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
38586 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
38587 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
38588 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
38589 .next
38590 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
38591 .next
38592 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
38593 signature.
38594 .endlist
38595 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
38596
38597 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
38598 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
38599 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
38600 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
38601 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
38602 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
38603 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
38604 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
38605 attempt.
38606
38607 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
38608 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
38609 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
38610 relics of crashes and can be removed.
38611
38612 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
38613 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
38614 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
38615 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
38616 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
38617 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
38618 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
38619 normally the Exim user.
38620
38621 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
38622 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
38623 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
38624 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
38625 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
38626 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
38627 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
38628 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
38629
38630 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
38631 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
38632 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
38633 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
38634
38635 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
38636 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
38637
38638 .vlist
38639 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38640 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
38641 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
38642 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
38643 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
38644 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
38645 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
38646 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
38647 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
38648 newlines.
38649
38650 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38651 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
38652 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
38653 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38654 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38655 character. It may contain internal newlines.
38656
38657 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38658 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
38659 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
38660 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38661 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38662 character. It may contain internal newlines.
38663
38664 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
38665 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
38666 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
38667
38668 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
38669 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
38670 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
38671 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
38672 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38673
38674 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
38675 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
38676 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
38677 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
38678 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38679
38680 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
38681 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
38682 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
38683
38684 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
38685 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
38686 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
38687
38688 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38689 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
38690 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
38691
38692 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38693 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
38694 present if the number is greater than zero.
38695
38696 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
38697 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
38698 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
38699
38700 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
38701 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
38702 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
38703
38704 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38705 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
38706 command.
38707
38708 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38709 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
38710 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
38711 messages.
38712
38713 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
38714 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
38715 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
38716 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
38717
38718 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
38719 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
38720 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
38721
38722 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38723 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
38724 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
38725 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
38726 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
38727 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
38728
38729 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
38730 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
38731 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
38732 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
38733 supplied by the remote host, if any.
38734
38735 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38736 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
38737 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
38738 generated messages.
38739
38740 .vitem &%-local%&
38741 The message is from a local sender.
38742
38743 .vitem &%-localerror%&
38744 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
38745
38746 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
38747 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
38748 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
38749 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
38750
38751 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
38752 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
38753 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
38754
38755 .vitem &%-N%&
38756 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
38757 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
38758 &%-N%& is assumed.
38759
38760 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
38761 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
38762 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
38763
38764 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
38765 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
38766 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
38767
38768 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
38769 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
38770 of &$spam_score_int$&.
38771
38772 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
38773 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
38774 rather than Unix-format.
38775 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
38776 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
38777
38778 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
38779 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
38780 certificate was verified by the server.
38781
38782 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
38783 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
38784 name of the cipher suite that was used.
38785
38786 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
38787 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
38788 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
38789 certificate.
38790 .endlist
38791
38792 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
38793 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
38794 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
38795 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
38796 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
38797 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
38798 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
38799 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
38800 addresses are complete.
38801
38802 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
38803 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
38804 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
38805 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
38806 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
38807 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
38808 .code
38809 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
38810 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
38811 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38812 .endd
38813 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
38814 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
38815 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
38816 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
38817 example:
38818 .code
38819 4
38820 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38821 darcy@austen.fict.example
38822 rdo@foundation
38823 alice@wonderland.fict.example
38824 .endd
38825 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
38826 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
38827 line is of the following form:
38828 .display
38829 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
38830 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
38831 .endd
38832 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
38833 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
38834 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
38835 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
38836 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
38837 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
38838 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
38839 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
38840
38841
38842 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
38843 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
38844 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
38845 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
38846 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
38847 following:
38848
38849 .table2 50pt
38850 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
38851 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
38852 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
38853 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
38854 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
38855 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
38856 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
38857 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
38858 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
38859 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
38860 .endtable
38861
38862 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
38863 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
38864 typical set of headers:
38865 .code
38866 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
38867 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38868 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
38869 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
38870 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
38871 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
38872 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
38873 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38874 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
38875 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38876 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38877 .endd
38878 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
38879 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
38880 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
38881 .ecindex IIDforspo1
38882 .ecindex IIDforspo2
38883 .ecindex IIDforspo3
38884
38885 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
38886 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
38887 an ASCII newline character.
38888 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
38889 can have an alternate format.
38890 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
38891 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
38892 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
38893 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
38894 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
38895 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
38896
38897 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38898 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38899
38900 .chapter "DKIM and SPF" "CHAPdkim" &&&
38901 "DKIM and SPF Support"
38902 .cindex "DKIM"
38903
38904 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
38905
38906 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
38907 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
38908 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
38909 DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
38910
38911 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
38912 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
38913 any original DKIM signature.
38914
38915 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
38916 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
38917
38918 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
38919 .olist
38920 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
38921 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
38922 (including transport filters)
38923 except cutthrough delivery.
38924 .next
38925 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
38926 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
38927 different signature contexts.
38928 .endlist
38929
38930 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
38931 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
38932 Exim's standard controls.
38933
38934 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
38935 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
38936
38937 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
38938 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
38939 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
38940 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
38941 .code
38942 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
38943 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
38944 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
38945 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
38946 .endd
38947
38948 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
38949 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
38950 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
38951 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
38952 senders).
38953
38954
38955 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
38956 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
38957
38958 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
38959 Note that RFC 8301 says:
38960 .code
38961 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
38962
38963 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
38964 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
38965 .endd
38966
38967 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
38968 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
38969 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
38970 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
38971 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
38972
38973 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
38974 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
38975
38976 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
38977 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
38978 After expansion, this can be a list.
38979 Each element in turn is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
38980 while expanding the remaining signing options.
38981 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
38982 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
38983
38984 .option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
38985 This sets the key selector string.
38986 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
38987 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
38988 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
38989 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
38990 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
38991 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
38992
38993 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
38994 This sets the private key to use.
38995 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
38996 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
38997 The result can either
38998 .ilist
38999 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
39000 .next
39001 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
39002 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
39003 .next
39004 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
39005 the private key
39006 .next
39007 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
39008 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
39009 is set.
39010 .endlist
39011
39012 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
39013 .code
39014 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
39015 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
39016 .endd
39017 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
39018 for the DNS TXT record.
39019 See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
39020
39021 Under GnuTLS:
39022 .code
39023 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
39024 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
39025 .endd
39026
39027 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39028 .code
39029 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39030 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39031 .endd
39032
39033 Support for EC keys is being developed under
39034 &url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-dcrup-dkim-crypto/).
39035 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
39036 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
39037 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
39038 for some transition period.
39039 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39040 for EC keys.
39041
39042 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
39043 .code
39044 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
39045 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
39046 .endd
39047
39048 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
39049 .code
39050 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
39051 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
39052 .endd
39053
39054 Note that the format
39055 of Ed25519 keys in DNS has not yet been decided; this release supports
39056 both of the leading candidates at this time, a future release will
39057 probably drop support for whichever proposal loses.
39058
39059 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
39060 Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
39061 .ilist
39062 &`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
39063 .next
39064 &`sha256`& &-- the default
39065 .next
39066 &`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
39067 .endlist
39068
39069 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39070 .code
39071 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39072 .endd
39073
39074 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
39075 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
39076 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
39077 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
39078 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
39079 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
39080
39081 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
39082 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
39083 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
39084 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
39085 only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
39086
39087 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
39088 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
39089 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
39090 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
39091 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
39092 variables here.
39093
39094 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
39095 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
39096 list of header names.
39097 Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
39098 in the message signature.
39099 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
39100 whether or not each header is present in the message.
39101 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
39102 "_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
39103
39104 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
39105 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
39106 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
39107
39108 A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
39109 If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
39110 will be signed.
39111 If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
39112 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
39113 name will be appended.
39114
39115 .new
39116 .option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
39117 This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
39118 If not set, no such information will be included.
39119 Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the current time
39120 for the expiry tag
39121 (eg. 1209600 for two weeks);
39122 both creation (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included.
39123
39124 RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
39125 .wen
39126
39127
39128 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
39129 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
39130
39131 .new
39132 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
39133 messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
39134 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
39135 Performing verification sets up information used by the
39136 &$authresults$& expansion item.
39137 .wen
39138
39139 .new The results of that verification are then made available to the
39140 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, &new(which can examine and modify them).
39141 By default, this ACL is called once for each
39142 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
39143 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
39144 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
39145 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
39146 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
39147
39148 To evaluate the &new(verification result) in the ACL
39149 a large number of expansion variables
39150 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
39151 runtime of the ACL.
39152
39153 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
39154 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
39155 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
39156 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
39157
39158 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
39159 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
39160 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
39161 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
39162 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
39163 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
39164 it defaults as:
39165 .code
39166 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
39167 .endd
39168 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
39169 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
39170 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
39171 .code
39172 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
39173 .endd
39174 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
39175 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
39176 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
39177 .code
39178 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
39179 .endd
39180
39181 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
39182 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
39183
39184 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
39185 for each matching signature.
39186
39187
39188 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
39189 available (from most to least important):
39190
39191
39192 .vlist
39193 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
39194 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
39195 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
39196 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
39197
39198 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
39199 Within the DKIM ACL,
39200 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
39201 .ilist
39202 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
39203 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39204 .next
39205 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
39206 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39207 .next
39208 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
39209 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39210 .next
39211 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
39212 .endlist
39213
39214 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39215 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
39216 hash-method or key-size:
39217 .code
39218 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
39219 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
39220 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
39221 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
39222 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
39223 set dkim_verify_status = fail
39224 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
39225 .endd
39226
39227 After all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
39228 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
39229
39230 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
39231 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
39232 "fail" or "invalid". One of
39233 .ilist
39234 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
39235 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
39236 .next
39237 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
39238 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
39239 .next
39240 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
39241 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
39242 means that the message body was modified in transit.
39243 .next
39244 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
39245 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
39246 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
39247 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
39248 .endlist
39249
39250 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39251
39252 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
39253 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
39254 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
39255 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39256
39257 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
39258 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
39259 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
39260 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39261
39262 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
39263 The key record selector string.
39264
39265 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
39266 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
39267 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
39268 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
39269 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39270 for EC keys.
39271
39272 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39273 .code
39274 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39275
39276 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
39277 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
39278 .endd
39279
39280 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39281 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39282
39283 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
39284 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39285
39286 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
39287 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39288
39289 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
39290 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
39291 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
39292 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
39293 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
39294 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
39295
39296 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
39297 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
39298 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
39299 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
39300 .new
39301 &*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
39302 is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
39303 A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
39304 shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
39305 .wen
39306
39307 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
39308 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
39309 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
39310
39311 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
39312 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
39313 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
39314 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
39315 integer size comparisons against this value.
39316 Note that Exim does not check this value.
39317
39318 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
39319 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
39320
39321 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
39322 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
39323
39324 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
39325 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
39326
39327 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
39328 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39329 in the key record.
39330
39331 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
39332 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39333 in the key record.
39334
39335 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
39336 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
39337
39338 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
39339 Number of bits in the key.
39340
39341 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39342 .code
39343 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
39344 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
39345 .endd
39346
39347 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39348 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39349 As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
39350
39351 .endlist
39352
39353 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
39354
39355 .vlist
39356 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
39357 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
39358 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
39359 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
39360 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
39361
39362 .code
39363 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
39364 warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
39365 sender_domains = gmail.com
39366 dkim_signers = gmail.com
39367 dkim_status = none
39368 .endd
39369
39370 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
39371 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
39372
39373 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
39374 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
39375 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
39376 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
39377
39378 .code
39379 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
39380 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
39381 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
39382 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
39383 .endd
39384
39385 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
39386 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
39387 for more information of what they mean.
39388 .endlist
39389
39390
39391
39392
39393 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
39394 .cindex SPF verification
39395
39396 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
39397 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
39398 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.openspf.org).
39399
39400 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
39401 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
39402
39403 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
39404 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
39405 &url(http://www.libspf2.org/).
39406 There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
39407 publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
39408
39409 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
39410 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
39411 Performing verification sets up information used by the
39412 &$authresults$& expansion item.
39413
39414
39415 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
39416 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
39417 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
39418 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
39419 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
39420 Valid strings are:
39421 .vlist
39422 .vitem &%pass%&
39423 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
39424
39425 .vitem &%fail%&
39426 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
39427 domain in the envelope-from address.
39428
39429 .vitem &%softfail%&
39430 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
39431 is a forgery.
39432
39433 .vitem &%none%&
39434 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
39435
39436 .vitem &%neutral%&
39437 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
39438 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
39439 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
39440
39441 .vitem &%permerror%&
39442 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
39443 You may deny messages when this occurs.
39444
39445 .vitem &%temperror%&
39446 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
39447 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
39448 .endlist
39449
39450 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
39451 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
39452 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
39453 short-circuit fashion.
39454
39455 Example:
39456 .code
39457 deny spf = fail
39458 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
39459 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
39460 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
39461 Please see http://www.openspf.org/Why?scope=\
39462 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
39463 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
39464 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
39465 ip=$sender_host_address
39466 .endd
39467
39468 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
39469 variables:
39470
39471 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
39472 .vlist
39473 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
39474 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
39475 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
39476 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
39477 it for logging purposes.
39478
39479 .vitem &$spf_received$&
39480 .vindex &$spf_received$&
39481 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
39482 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
39483 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
39484 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
39485
39486 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
39487 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
39488
39489 .vitem &$spf_result$&
39490 .vindex &$spf_result$&
39491 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
39492 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
39493 temperror.
39494
39495 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
39496 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
39497 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
39498 and required in order to obtain a result.
39499
39500 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
39501 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
39502 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
39503 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
39504 .endlist
39505
39506
39507 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
39508 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
39509 .cindex SPF "best guess"
39510 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
39511 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
39512 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
39513 capability.
39514 Refer to &url(http://www.openspf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
39515 for a description of what it means.
39516
39517 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
39518 of the spf one. For example:
39519
39520 .code
39521 deny spf_guess = fail
39522 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
39523 .endd
39524
39525 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
39526 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
39527 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
39528 reject message.
39529
39530 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
39531 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
39532
39533 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
39534 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
39535 &%spf_guess%& option.
39536 For example, the following:
39537
39538 .code
39539 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
39540 .endd
39541
39542 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
39543
39544
39545 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
39546 .cindex lookup spf
39547 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
39548 address as the key and an IP address as the database:
39549
39550 .code
39551 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
39552 .endd
39553
39554 The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
39555 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
39556 Currently, only IPv4 addresses are supported.
39557
39558
39559
39560
39561 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39562 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39563
39564 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
39565 "Proxy support"
39566 .cindex "proxy support"
39567 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
39568
39569 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
39570 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
39571
39572
39573 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
39574 .cindex proxy inbound
39575 .cindex proxy "server side"
39576 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
39577 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
39578
39579 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
39580 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
39581 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
39582 in Local/Makefile.
39583
39584 It was built on specifications from:
39585 (&url(http://haproxy.1wt.eu/download/1.5/doc/proxy-protocol.txt)).
39586 That URL was revised in May 2014 to version 2 spec:
39587 (&url(http://git.1wt.eu/web?p=haproxy.git;a=commitdiff;h=afb768340c9d7e50d8e)).
39588
39589 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
39590 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
39591 to distribute load.
39592 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
39593 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
39594 There is no logging if a host passes or
39595 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
39596 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
39597
39598 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
39599 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
39600 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
39601 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
39602 automatically determines which version is in use.
39603
39604 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
39605 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
39606 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
39607 Exim and the proxy server.
39608
39609 The following expansion variables are usable
39610 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
39611 of the proxy):
39612 .display
39613 &'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
39614 &'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
39615 &'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
39616 &'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
39617 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
39618 .endd
39619 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
39620 there was a protocol error.
39621
39622 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
39623 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
39624 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
39625 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
39626 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
39627 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
39628 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
39629 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
39630 A possible solution is:
39631 .display
39632 # Set max number of connections per host
39633 LIMIT = 5
39634 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
39635 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
39636
39637 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
39638 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
39639 .endd
39640
39641
39642
39643 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
39644 .cindex proxy outbound
39645 .cindex proxy "client side"
39646 .cindex proxy SOCKS
39647 .cindex SOCKS proxy
39648 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
39649 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
39650 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
39651 Local/Makefile.
39652
39653 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
39654 on an smtp transport.
39655 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
39656 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
39657 Each proxy specifier is a list
39658 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
39659 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
39660
39661 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
39662 The list of options is in the following table:
39663 .display
39664 &'auth '& authentication method
39665 &'name '& authentication username
39666 &'pass '& authentication password
39667 &'port '& tcp port
39668 &'tmo '& connection timeout
39669 &'pri '& priority
39670 &'weight '& selection bias
39671 .endd
39672
39673 More details on each of these options follows:
39674
39675 .ilist
39676 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
39677 .cindex proxy authentication
39678 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
39679 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
39680 for access to the proxy.
39681 Default is &"none"&.
39682 .next
39683 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
39684 Default is empty.
39685 .next
39686 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
39687 Default is empty.
39688 .next
39689 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
39690 Default is 1080.
39691 .next
39692 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
39693 Default is 5.
39694 .next
39695 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
39696 higher values being tried first.
39697 The default priority is 1.
39698 .next
39699 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
39700 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
39701 weighted by this value.
39702 The default value for selection bias is 1.
39703 .endlist
39704
39705 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
39706 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
39707 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
39708
39709 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
39710 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
39711 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
39712 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
39713
39714 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39715 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39716
39717 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
39718 "Internationalisation""
39719 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
39720 .cindex EAI
39721 .cindex i18n
39722 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
39723
39724 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
39725 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
39726 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
39727
39728 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
39729 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
39730 requirement, upon libidn2.
39731
39732 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
39733 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
39734 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
39735 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
39736 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
39737 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
39738
39739 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
39740 international handling for the message is enabled and
39741 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
39742
39743 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
39744 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
39745 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
39746 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
39747
39748 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
39749 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
39750 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
39751 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
39752
39753 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
39754 components expanded to a-label form,
39755 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
39756 form of the name.
39757
39758 .cindex log protocol
39759 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
39760 .cindex i18n logging
39761 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
39762 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
39763
39764 The following expansion operators can be used:
39765 .code
39766 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
39767 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
39768 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
39769 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
39770 .endd
39771
39772 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
39773 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
39774 The RCPT ACL
39775 may use the following modifier:
39776 .display
39777 control = utf8_downconvert
39778 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
39779 .endd
39780 This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
39781 a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
39782 Message Submission Agent context.
39783 If a value is appended it may be:
39784 .display
39785 &`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
39786 &`0 `& no downconversion
39787 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
39788 .endd
39789
39790 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
39791 is initially set to -1.
39792
39793
39794 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
39795 Configurations supporting these should inspect
39796 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
39797
39798 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
39799 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
39800 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
39801
39802 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
39803 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
39804
39805
39806
39807 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
39808 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
39809 the following expansion operator can be used:
39810 .code
39811 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
39812 .endd
39813
39814 The string is converted from the charset specified by
39815 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
39816 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
39817 to the
39818 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
39819 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
39820 (which has to be a single character)
39821 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
39822 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
39823
39824 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
39825 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
39826
39827 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
39828 by many other IMAP servers.
39829
39830 Examples:
39831 .display
39832 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
39833 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
39834 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
39835 .endd
39836
39837 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
39838 must be representable in UTF-16.
39839
39840
39841 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39842 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39843
39844 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
39845 "Events"
39846 .cindex events
39847
39848 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
39849 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
39850 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
39851 processing actions.
39852
39853 Most installations will never need to use Events.
39854 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
39855 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39856
39857 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
39858 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
39859 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
39860
39861 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
39862 An example might look like:
39863 .cindex logging custom
39864 .code
39865 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
39866 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
39867 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
39868 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
39869 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
39870 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
39871 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
39872 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
39873 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
39874 } {}}
39875 .endd
39876
39877 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
39878 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
39879 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
39880
39881 The current list of events is:
39882 .display
39883 &`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
39884 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
39885 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
39886 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
39887 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
39888 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
39889 &`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
39890 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
39891 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
39892 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
39893 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
39894 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
39895 .endd
39896 New event types may be added in future.
39897
39898 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
39899 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
39900 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
39901
39902 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
39903 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
39904 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
39905
39906 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
39907 should define the event action.
39908
39909 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
39910 with the event type:
39911 .display
39912 &`dane:fail `& failure reason
39913 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
39914 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
39915 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
39916 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
39917 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
39918 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
39919 .endd
39920
39921 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
39922
39923 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
39924 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
39925 the course of its processing:
39926 .ilist
39927 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
39928 transport call
39929 .next
39930 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
39931 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
39932 .endlist
39933 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
39934 a useful way of writing to the main log.
39935
39936 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
39937 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
39938 following will be forced:
39939 .display
39940 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
39941 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
39942 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
39943 .endd
39944 All other message types ignore the result string, and
39945 no other use is made of it.
39946
39947 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
39948 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
39949 the target system.
39950
39951 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
39952 chain element received on the connection.
39953 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
39954 loaded locally.
39955
39956 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39957 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39958
39959 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
39960 "Adding drivers or lookups"
39961 .cindex "adding drivers"
39962 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
39963 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
39964 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
39965 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
39966
39967 .olist
39968 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
39969 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
39970 .next
39971 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
39972 .display
39973 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
39974 .endd
39975 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
39976 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
39977 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
39978 .next
39979 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
39980 .code
39981 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
39982 .endd
39983 .next
39984 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
39985 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
39986 .next
39987 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
39988 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
39989 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
39990 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
39991 simple form that most lookups have.
39992 .next
39993 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
39994 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
39995 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
39996 .next
39997 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
39998 &_src_&.
39999 .next
40000 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
40001 as for other drivers and lookups.
40002 .endlist
40003
40004 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
40005 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
40006 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
40007 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
40008 searched using a binary chop procedure.
40009
40010 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
40011 the interface that is expected.
40012
40013
40014
40015
40016 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40017 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40018
40019 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40020 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
40021 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
40022 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
40023 . processors.
40024 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40025
40026 .literal xml
40027 <?sdop
40028 format="newpage"
40029 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
40030 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
40031 ?>
40032 .literal off
40033
40034 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
40035 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
40036 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
40037
40038
40039 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40040 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////